Chevrolet Automobile 2010 Equinox User Manual

2010 Chevrolet Equinox Owner Manual M  
Keys, Doors and Windows . . . 1-1  
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Additional Storage Features . . . 3-1  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Keys and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Vehicle Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Exterior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Interior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Lighting Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Instruments and Controls . . . . 4-1  
Instrument Panel Overview. . . . 4-4  
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Information Displays . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . 4-34  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Audio Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Rear Seat Infotainment . . . . . . . 6-33  
Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-42  
Seats and Restraints . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1  
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . 7-1  
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
iii  
Motors of Canada Limitedfor  
Chevrolet Motor Division wherever it  
appears in this manual.  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for  
quick reference.  
GENERAL MOTORS, GM, the  
GM Emblem, CHEVROLET, the  
CHEVROLET Emblem, the name  
Equinox and the Equinox Emblem  
are registered trademarks of  
General Motors LLC.  
Manufactured under license from  
Dolby Laboratories. Dolby and the  
double-D symbol are trademarks of  
Dolby Laboratories. Copyright  
1992-1997 Dolby Laboratories. All  
rights reserved.  
Manufactured under license under  
U.S. Patent #'s: 5,451,942;  
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762;  
6,487,535 & other U.S. and  
worldwide patents issued &  
pending. DTS and DTS Digital  
Surround are registered trademarks  
and the DTS logos and Symbol are  
trademarks of DTS, Inc. ©  
This manual describes features that  
may or may not be on your specific  
vehicle either because they are  
options that you did not purchase  
or due to changes subsequent to  
the printing of this owner manual.  
Please refer to the purchase  
documentation relating to your  
specific vehicle to confirm each of  
the features found on your vehicle.  
For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
substitute the name General  
This product incorporates copyright  
protection technology that is  
protected by U.S. patents and other  
intellectual property rights. Use of  
this copyright protection technology  
must be authorized by Macrovision,  
and is intended for home and other  
limited viewing uses only unless  
otherwise authorized by  
1996-2007 DTS, Inc. All Rights  
Reserved.  
Macrovision. Reverse engineering  
or disassembly is prohibited.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 25798562 C Third Printing  
© 2010 General Motors. All Rights Reserved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv  
Introduction  
Canadian Vehicle Owners Danger, Warnings, and  
Cautions  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
Warning messages found on vehicle  
A French language copy of this  
labels and in this manual describe  
manual can be obtained from your  
hazards and what to do to avoid or  
dealer or from:  
Made for iPodmeans that an  
electronic accessory has been  
designed to connect specifically  
to iPod and has been certified by  
the developer to meet Apple  
performance standards. iPod is a  
trademark of Apple Computer, Inc.,  
registered in the U.S. and other  
countries.  
reduce them.  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de  
ce guide en français auprès du  
Danger indicates a hazard with a  
high level of risk which will result in  
concessionnaire ou à l'adresse  
serious injury or death.  
suivante:  
Warning or Caution indicates a  
Helm, Incorporated  
hazard that could result in injury or  
P.O. Box 07130  
death.  
Detroit, MI 48207  
1-800-551-4123  
Numéro de poste 6438 de langue  
française  
www.helminc.com  
WARNING  
{
These mean there is something  
that could hurt you or other  
people.  
Using this Manual  
To quickly locate information about  
the vehicle, use the Index in the  
back of the manual. It is an  
alphabetical list of what is in the  
manual and the page number where  
it can be found.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
v
Notice: This means there is  
something that could result in  
property or vehicle damage. This  
would not be covered by the  
vehicle's warranty.  
M : This symbol is shown when  
you need to see your owner manual  
for additional instructions or  
information.  
I : Cruise Control  
d : Electronic Stability  
Control (ESC)  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
. : Fuel Gauge  
* : This symbol is shown when  
you need to see a service manual  
for additional instructions or  
information.  
+ : Fuses  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Here are some additional symbols  
that may be found on the vehicle  
and what they mean. For more  
information on the symbol, refer to  
the index.  
Changer  
A circle with a slash through it is a  
safety symbol which means Do  
Not,” “Do not do thisor Do not let  
this happen.”  
j : LATCH System Child  
Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
Symbols  
} : Power  
The vehicle has components and  
labels that use symbols instead of  
text. Symbols are shown along with  
the text describing the operation or  
information relating to a specific  
component, control, message,  
gauge, or indicator.  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi  
Introduction  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Interior Mirrors  
1-1  
Doors  
Keys, Doors and  
Windows  
Liftgate (Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Liftgate (Power) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . 1-15  
Automatic Dimming Rearview  
Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Vehicle Security  
Windows  
Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Anti-Theft Alarm System . . . . . 1-12  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Immobilizer Operation . . . . . . . 1-13  
Keys and Locks  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Exterior Mirrors  
Roof  
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-2  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Keys and Locks  
Keys  
WARNING  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with  
the ignition key is dangerous for  
many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even  
killed. They could operate the  
power windows or other controls  
or even make the vehicle move.  
The windows will function with the  
keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed  
if caught in the path of a closing  
window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The key, that is part of the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter,  
can be used for the ignition and all  
locks.  
Press the button on the RKE  
transmitter to extend the key.  
Press the button and the key  
blade to retract the key.  
See your dealer if a new key is  
needed.  
Notice: If you ever lock your keys  
in the vehicle, you may have to  
damage the vehicle to get in. Be  
sure you have spare keys.  
If you are locked out of the vehicle,  
see Roadside Assistance Program  
on page 126 or OnStar® System  
on page 439  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-3  
.
.
Check the transmitter's battery.  
See Battery Replacementlater  
in this section.  
Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System  
See Radio Frequency Statement on  
page 1216 for information  
regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC)  
Rules and RSS-210/211 of Industry  
Canada.  
If the transmitter is still not  
working correctly, see your  
dealer or a qualified technician  
for service.  
Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter will work up to 60 m  
(195 feet) away from the vehicle.  
Changes or modifications to  
this system by other than an  
authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
RKE without Remote Start Shown  
The following may be available:  
If there is a decrease in the RKE  
operating range:  
There are other conditions which  
can affect the performance of the  
transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 13.  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all doors.  
The turn signal indicators may flash  
and/or the horn may sound to  
.
Check the distance. The  
transmitter may be too far  
from the vehicle.  
indicate locking, see Remote  
Lock Feedbackunder Vehicle  
Personalization on page 434. If a  
.
Check the location. Other  
vehicles or objects may be  
blocking the signal.  
passenger door is open when Q is  
pressed, all doors lock. If the driver  
door is open when Q is pressed, all  
doors lock except the driver door.  
These settings can be modified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-4  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
See Unlocked Door Anti Lock Out”  
under Vehicle Personalization on  
Programming Transmitters to  
the Vehicle  
V (Remote Liftgate Release):  
First press K, then press and hold  
V to unlock the liftgate. For  
vehicles with the power liftgate,  
page 434  
.
Only RKE transmitters programmed  
to this vehicle will work. If a  
Pressing Q may also arm the  
theft-deterrent system. See  
Anti-Theft Alarm System on  
transmitter is lost or stolen, a  
replacement can be purchased and  
programmed through your dealer.  
When the replacement transmitter is  
programmed to this vehicle, all  
remaining transmitters must also be  
reprogrammed. Any lost or stolen  
transmitters will no longer work  
once the new transmitter is  
press and hold V until the liftgate  
begins to move to open the liftgate.  
page 112  
.
7 (Vehicle Locator/Panic  
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the  
driver door or all doors, see  
Remote Door Unlockunder  
Vehicle Personalization on  
page 434. The turn signal  
indicators flash to indicate unlocking  
has occurred. For more information  
see Remote Unlock Light  
Alarm): Press and release one  
time to locate the vehicle. The  
exterior lamps flash and the horn  
chirps. Press and hold 7 for at least  
two seconds to sound the panic  
alarm. The horn sounds and the  
programmed.  
turn signals flash until 7 is pressed  
again or the key is placed in the  
ignition and turned to ON/RUN.  
Battery Replacement  
Feedbackunder Vehicle  
Replace the battery if the Replace  
Battery in Remote Keymessage  
displays in the DIC. See Replace  
Battery in Remote Keyunder Key  
and Lock Messages on page 431.  
Personalization on page 434  
.
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): For  
vehicles with this feature, first press  
Q then press and hold / to start  
the engine from outside the vehicle  
using the RKE transmitter. See  
Remote Vehicle Start on page 15  
for additional information.  
Pressing K may also disarm the  
theft-deterrent system. See  
Anti-Theft Alarm System on  
page 112  
.
The battery is not rechargeable.  
See your dealer to replace the  
battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-5  
There are other conditions which  
can affect the performance of the  
transmitter, see Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 13  
for additional information.  
Extending Engine Run Time  
Remote Vehicle Start  
The vehicle may have this feature  
that allows you to start the engine  
from outside the vehicle.  
For a 10-minute extension, repeat  
Steps 1 and 2 while the engine is  
still running. The remote start can  
be extended once.  
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): This  
button will be on the RKE  
transmitter if the vehicle has remote  
start. To enable and disable remote  
start, see Remote Vehicle Start”  
under Vehicle Personalization on  
Starting the Engine Using Remote  
Start  
When the remote start is extended,  
the second 10 minutes will start  
immediately.  
To start the engine using the remote  
start feature:  
For example, if the engine has been  
running for five minutes, and  
10 minutes are added, the engine  
1. Press Q on the RKE transmitter.  
page 434  
.
2. Press and hold / for about  
two seconds. The turn signal  
lamps will briefly flash to confirm  
the vehicle has been started.  
The parking lamps will turn on  
and remain on as long as the  
engine is running. The vehicle's  
doors will be locked.  
will run for a total of 15 minutes.  
Vehicles with an automatic climate  
control system will default to a  
heating or cooling mode depending  
on the outside temperature during a  
remote start. Once the key is turned  
to ON/RUN, the system will turn on  
at the setting the vehicle was last  
set to.  
A maximum of two remote starts or  
remote start attempts are allowed  
between ignition cycles.  
The vehicle's ignition switch must  
be turned to ON/RUN and then back  
to LOCK/OFF using the key, before  
the remote start procedure can be  
used again.  
3. The key must be inserted and  
turned to ON/RUN before  
driving.  
Laws in some local communities  
may restrict the use of remote  
starters. For example, some laws  
require a person using remote  
start to have the vehicle in view.  
Check local regulations for any  
requirements.  
The engine will shut off after  
10 minutes unless a time  
extension is done or the key is  
inserted and turned to ON/RUN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-6  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
.
The oil pressure is low.  
Shutting the Engine Off After a  
Remote Start  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
.
Two remote vehicle starts have  
already been used.  
.
To shut off the engine:  
Young children who get into  
unlocked vehicles may be  
unable to get out. A child can  
be overcome by extreme heat  
and can suffer permanent  
injuries or even death from  
heat stroke. Always lock the  
vehicle whenever leaving it.  
.
.
.
The vehicle is not in P (Park).  
Press / until the parking lamps  
turn off.  
Door Locks  
Turn on the hazard warning  
flashers.  
WARNING  
{
Insert the key and turn it to ON/  
RUN and then back to  
LOCK/OFF.  
Unlocked doors can be  
dangerous.  
.
Outsiders can easily enter  
through an unlocked door  
when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your  
doors can help prevent this  
from happening.  
.
Conditions in Which Remote Start  
Will Not Work  
Passengers, especially  
children, can easily open the  
doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. The chance of being  
thrown out of the vehicle in a  
crash is increased if the  
doors are not locked. So, all  
passengers should wear  
safety belts properly and the  
doors should be locked  
whenever the vehicle is  
driven.  
The remote vehicle start feature will  
not operate if:  
.
The key is in the ignition.  
To lock or unlock a door from the  
outside of the vehicle, use the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter. Pull the handle once  
from the inside to unlock the door,  
and a second time to open it.  
.
The hood or doors are not  
closed.  
.
The hazard warning flashers  
are on.  
.
There is an emission control  
system malfunction.  
(Continued)  
.
The engine coolant temperature  
is too high.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Safety Locks  
1-7  
When locking the doors with the  
Power Door Locks  
power lock switch and a door or the  
liftgate is open, the doors will lock  
five seconds after the last door is  
closed. You will hear three chimes  
to signal that the delayed locking  
feature is in use.  
Rear door security locks prevent  
passengers from opening the rear  
doors from the inside.  
Press (C) to activate the safety  
locks. Once activated, the LED light,  
changes to amber.  
Pressing the power lock switch  
Pressing the button again  
deactivates the safety locks.  
twice or Q on the RKE transmitter  
twice will override the delayed  
locking feature and immediately lock  
all the doors.  
See Power Door Locks on  
page 17  
.
This feature will not operate if the  
key is in the ignition.  
A. Door Unlock  
B. Door Lock  
C. Safety Lock  
This feature can be programmed.  
See Delayed Door Lockunder  
Vehicle Personalization on  
page 434  
.
The power door lock switches are  
located on the instrument panel.  
.
Press (A) to unlock the doors.  
.
Remove the key from the  
ignition and press (B) to lock  
the doors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-8  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Do not press the touchpad while  
closing the liftgate. This will cause  
the liftgate to be unlatched.  
Doors  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that  
brings in only outside air and  
set the fan speed to the  
highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
Liftgate (Manual)  
Always close the liftgate before  
driving.  
WARNING  
{
Liftgate (Power)  
Exhaust gases can enter the  
vehicle if it is driven with the  
liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with  
any objects that pass through the  
seal between the body and the  
trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon  
Monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Power Liftgate Operation  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 834.  
WARNING  
{
Exhaust gases can enter the  
vehicle if it is driven with the  
liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with  
any objects that pass through the  
seal between the body and the  
trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon  
Monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Notice: If you open the liftgate  
without checking for overhead  
obstructions such as a garage  
door, you could damage the  
liftgate or the liftgate glass.  
Always check to make sure the  
area above and behind the liftgate  
is clear before opening it.  
If the vehicle must be driven with  
the liftgate, or trunk/hatch open:  
.
Close all of the windows.  
.
Press the touchpad located in the  
handle of the liftgate, above the  
license plate, and lift up to open.  
Fully open the air outlets on  
or under the instrument  
panel.  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-9  
be in P (Park) to use the power  
feature. The taillamps flash when  
the power liftgate moves.  
WARNING (Continued)  
If the vehicle must be driven with  
the liftgate, or trunk/hatch open:  
WARNING  
{
.
Close all of the windows.  
You or others could be injured if  
caught in the path of the power  
liftgate. Make sure there is no one  
in the way of the liftgate as it is  
opening and closing.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on  
or under the instrument  
panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that  
brings in only outside air and  
set the fan speed to the  
highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
Notice: If you open the liftgate  
without checking for overhead  
obstructions such as a garage  
door, you could damage the  
liftgate or the liftgate glass.  
Always check to make sure the  
area above and behind the liftgate  
is clear before opening it.  
Choose the power liftgate mode by  
turning the dial on the switch until  
the indicator lines up with the  
desired position. The vehicle must  
be in P (Park).  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with  
a power liftgate, disable the  
power liftgate function.  
The three modes are:  
MAX : The liftgate power opens to  
the full open height.  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 834.  
The power liftgate has three modes  
of operation. Mode selection is  
controlled by the interior mode  
switch.  
3/4 : The liftgate power opens to a  
reduced open height that can be set  
by the vehicle operator. Use this  
setting to prevent the liftgate from  
opening into overhead obstructions  
such as a garage door or roof  
On vehicles with a power liftgate,  
the switch is located on the  
overhead console. The vehicle must  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-10  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
.
Pressing the touchpad switch on  
the liftgate outside handle to  
open the liftgate.  
mounted cargo during power  
operation. The liftgate can still be  
fully opened manually.  
for the system to hold it open.  
If movement is stopped below that  
minimum the liftgate closes.  
OFF: The liftgate only operates  
manually in this position.  
Do not force the liftgate open or  
closed during a power cycle.  
Manual operation of a liftgate that  
also has power operation requires  
more effort than with a standard  
manual liftgate.  
The power liftgate may be  
temporarily disabled under extreme  
temperatures or low battery  
conditions. If this occurs, the liftgate  
can still be operated manually.  
In either the MAX or the 3/4 mode,  
the liftgate can be power opened  
and closed by:  
If you shift the transmission out of  
P (Park) while the power function is  
in progress, the liftgate power  
function will continue to completion.  
If you shift the transmission out of  
P (Park) and accelerate before the  
power liftgate latch is closed, the  
liftgate may reverse to the open  
position. Cargo could fall out of the  
vehicle. Always make sure the  
power liftgate is closed and latched  
before you drive away.  
.
First pressing K and then  
pressing and holding V on the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter until the liftgate starts  
moving. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System Operation  
Press and release & on the  
liftgate adjacent to the latch to close  
the liftgate.  
Pressing any button, or the  
on page 13  
.
touchpad switch while the liftgate is  
moving stops it. Pressing the button  
or RKE switch again reverses the  
direction. The touch pad switch will  
stop the liftgate from moving. There  
is a minimum distance that the  
power liftgate must already be open  
.
Pressing the power liftgate  
button on the center of the mode  
switch, located on the overhead  
console.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-11  
If you power open the liftgate and  
the liftgate support struts have lost  
pressure, the turn signals flash and  
a chime sounds. The liftgate stays  
open temporarily, then slowly  
Your vehicle has pinch sensors  
When power opened with the  
3/4 mode selected, the liftgate  
stops at the new set position.  
located on the side edges of the  
liftgate. If an object is caught  
between the liftgate and the body  
and presses against this sensor, the  
liftgate will reverse direction and  
open fully. The liftgate will remain  
open until it is activated again or  
closed manually.  
There is a minimum that the power  
liftgate must already be open for the  
system to hold it open. The liftgate  
cannot be set to stop below that  
minimum.  
closes. See your dealer for service  
before using the liftgate.  
Obstacle Detection Features  
Manual Operation of Power  
Liftgate  
If the liftgate encounters an obstacle  
during a power open or close cycle,  
a warning chime will sound and the  
liftgate will automatically reverse  
direction to the full closed or open  
position. After removing the  
obstruction, the power liftgate  
operation can be used again. If the  
liftgate encounters multiple  
obstacles on the same power cycle,  
the power function will deactivate.  
The Manually Close Power Liftgate”  
warning message in the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) will  
Setting the Power Liftgate  
3/4 Mode  
To change the liftgate to manual  
operation, turn the mode switch to  
the OFF position.  
To change the liftgate stop position:  
1. Turn the liftgate switch to the  
3/4 mode position and power  
open the liftgate.  
With the power liftgate disabled and  
all of the doors unlocked, the liftgate  
can be manually opened and  
closed. Manual operation of a  
liftgate that also has power  
2. Stop the liftgate movement at  
the desired height by pressing  
any switch.  
operation requires more effort than  
with a standard manual liftgate.  
3. Press and hold the button on the  
liftgate adjacent to the latch until  
the turn signals flash and a beep  
sounds to indicate that the new  
setting is recorded.  
To open the liftgate, press the  
touchpad on the handle on the  
outside of the liftgate, and lift the  
gate open. To close the liftgate, use  
the pull cup to lower the liftgate  
and close. With the power liftgate  
display. After removing the  
obstructions, the liftgate will resume  
normal power operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-12  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
disabled the liftgate electric latch will  
still power latch once contact is  
made with the striker. Always close  
the liftgate before driving.  
Disarming the System  
Vehicle Security  
To disarm the system, do one of the  
following:  
Vehicle theft is big business,  
especially in some cities. This  
vehicle has theft-deterrent features,  
however, they do not make it  
impossible to steal.  
.
Press K on the RKE transmitter.  
If the RKE button is pressed while  
power operation is disabled, the turn  
signals flash and the liftgate will  
not move.  
.
Turn the ignition to ON/RUN.  
.
Allow the alarm to time out after  
Anti-Theft Alarm System  
This vehicle has an anti-theft alarm  
system.  
about 30 seconds and reset  
itself.  
The liftgate has an electric latch.  
If the battery is disconnected or has  
low voltage, the liftgate will not  
open. The liftgate will resume  
operation when the battery is  
reconnected and charged.  
The alarm automatically disarms.  
If the system is armed and any door  
Arming the System  
is unlocked without pressing K on  
the RKE transmitter the alarm  
sounds.  
To arm the system, either:  
.
Press Q on the RKE transmitter.  
.
Or, lock the vehicle using the  
key in the driver door.  
How to Detect a Tamper  
Condition  
The alarm automatically arms after  
about 30 seconds. The security  
light, located on the instrument  
panel, flashes.  
If K is pressed and the horn  
sounds, an attempted break-in has  
occurred while the system was  
armed.  
Press V on the RKE transmitter to  
open the liftgate without setting off  
the alarm. The system rearms when  
the liftgate is closed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-13  
If the alarm has been activated, the  
Theft Attemptedmessage will  
appear on the DIC. See Key and  
Lock Messages on page 431 for  
additional information.  
The system is automatically  
disarmed when the vehicle is  
If the engine does not start and the  
security light stays on there is a  
problem with the system. Turn the  
ignition off and try again.  
started with the correct key. The key  
uses a transponder that matches  
an immobilizer control unit in the  
vehicle and automatically disarms  
the system. Only the correct key  
starts the vehicle. The vehicle may  
not start if the key is damaged.  
If the engine still does not start, and  
the key appears to be undamaged  
or the light continues to stay on, try  
another ignition key. If the engine  
does not start with the other key, the  
vehicle needs service. If the vehicle  
does start, the first key may be  
damaged. See your dealer who can  
service the theft-deterrent system  
and have a new key made.  
Immobilizer  
See Radio Frequency Statement on  
page 1216 for information  
regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC)  
Rules and RSS-210/211 of Industry  
Canada.  
Immobilizer Operation  
This vehicle has a passive  
theft-deterrent system.  
Do not leave the key or device that  
disarms or deactivates the theft  
deterrent system in the vehicle.  
The security light, located in the  
instrument panel cluster, comes on  
if there is a problem with arming or  
disarming the theft-deterrent  
system.  
The system does not have to be  
manually armed or disarmed.  
The vehicle is automatically  
immobilized when the key is  
removed from the ignition.  
When trying to start the vehicle, the  
security light comes on briefly when  
the ignition is turned on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-14  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
To adjust the mirrors:  
Power Mirrors  
Exterior Mirrors  
1. Move the selector switch to  
L (left) or R (right) to choose the  
driver or passenger mirror.  
Convex Mirrors  
2. Press the arrows on the control  
pad to move each mirror to the  
desired direction.  
WARNING  
{
A convex mirror can make things,  
like other vehicles, look farther  
away than they really are. If you  
cut too sharply into the right lane,  
you could hit a vehicle on the  
right. Check the inside mirror or  
glance over your shoulder before  
changing lanes.  
3. Adjust each outside mirror so  
that the side of the vehicle and  
the area behind are seen.  
4. Return the selector switch to the  
middle position.  
Controls for the outside power  
mirrors are located on the  
driver door.  
Heated Mirrors  
For vehicles with heated mirrors:  
The passenger side mirror is convex  
shaped. A convex mirror's surface is  
curved so more can be seen from  
the driver seat.  
< (Rear Window Defogger):  
Press to heat the mirrors.  
See Rear Window Defoggerunder  
Automatic Climate Control System  
on page 73 for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-15  
Park Tilt Mirrors  
Automatic Dimming  
Rearview Mirror  
The vehicle may have an automatic  
dimming inside rearview mirror.  
Vehicles with OnStar® have three  
additional control buttons located at  
the bottom of the mirror. See your  
dealer for more information on the  
system and how to subscribe to  
OnStar. See the OnStar owner's  
guide for more information about the  
services OnStar provides.  
Interior Mirrors  
If the vehicle has the memory  
package, the outside mirrors have  
a park tilt feature. This feature  
autiomatically tilts the outside  
mirrors to a preselected position  
when the vehicle is in R (Reverse).  
This allows the driver to view the  
curb for parallel parking.  
Manual Rearview Mirror  
Hold the inside rearview mirror in  
the center to move it for a clearer  
view of behind your vehicle. Adjust  
the mirror to avoid glare from the  
headlamps behind you. Push the  
tab forward for daytime use and pull  
it for nighttime use.  
Vehicles with OnStar® have three  
additional control buttons located at  
the bottom of the mirror. See your  
dealer for more information on the  
system and how to subscribe to  
OnStar. See the OnStar owner's  
guide for more information about the  
services OnStar provides.  
The passenger and driver mirrors  
return to their original position  
when the vehicle is shifted out of  
R (Reverse), or the ignition is turned  
off or to OFF/LOCK.  
O : Press to turn automatic  
dimming on or off.  
This feature can be turned on or  
off through the Driver Information  
Center (DIC). See Vehicle  
Personalization on page 434 for  
more information.  
If the vehicle has a rear vision  
camera (RVC) the O button for  
turning the automatic dimming  
feature on or off will not be  
available. See Rear Vision Camera  
(RVC) on page 849 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-16  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Automatic Dimming Mirror  
Operation  
Windows  
Automatic dimming reduces the  
glare from the headlamps of the  
vehicle behind you. The dimming  
feature comes on and the indicator  
light comes on each time the vehicle  
is started.  
WARNING  
{
Leaving children, helpless adults,  
or pets in a vehicle with the  
windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the  
extreme heat and suffer  
permanent injuries or even death  
from heat stroke. Never leave a  
child, a helpless adult, or a pet  
alone in a vehicle, especially with  
the windows closed in warm or  
hot weather.  
Cleaning the Mirror  
Do not spray glass cleaner directly  
on the mirror. Use a soft towel  
dampened with water.  
Power Windows  
WARNING  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with  
the keys is dangerous for many  
reasons, children or others could  
be badly injured or even killed.  
They could operate the power  
windows or other controls or even  
make the vehicle move. The  
windows will function and they  
could be seriously injured or killed  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-17  
The driver door also has switches  
Programming the Power  
Windows  
WARNING (Continued)  
that control the passenger and rear  
windows. The power windows work  
when the ignition is in ACC/  
ACCESSORY, ON/RUN or when  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is  
active. See Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP) on page 829.  
if caught in the path of a closing  
window. Do not leave keys in a  
vehicle with children.  
Programming the power windows  
may be necessary if the vehicle's  
battery has been disconnected or  
discharged.  
When there are children in the  
rear seat use the window lockout  
button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
To program the window:  
Press or pull on the switch to lower  
or raise the window.  
1. Close all doors with the ignition  
in the ACC/ACCESSORY, ON/  
RUN position, or when Retained  
Accessory Power (RAP) is  
Express Down Windows  
active. See Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP) on page 829.  
Windows that have the  
expressdown feature allow the  
windows to be lowered without  
holding the switch. Press the  
window switch fully and release it to  
activate the expressdown feature.  
The express mode can be canceled  
at any time by briefly pressing,  
or pulling the switch.  
2. Press and continue to hold the  
window switch until the window  
is fully open.  
3. Pull up and hold the window  
switch to close the window.  
Continue to hold it briefly after  
the window is fully closed.  
Uplevel shown, base similar  
The power window controls are  
located on each of the side doors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-18  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
Window Lockout  
Roof  
o (Window Lockout): The window  
lockout switch is located on the  
driver door. This feature prevents  
the rear passenger windows from  
operating, except from the driver  
position. Press the switch to turn  
the lockout feature on or off. An  
indicator light shows the feature  
is on.  
Sunroof  
On vehicles with a sunroof, the  
switches used to operate it are  
located on the headliner above the  
rearview mirror. The ignition must be  
in ON/RUN, ACC/ACCESSORY,  
or in Retained Accessory Power  
(RAP) to operate the sunroof. See  
Ignition Positions on page 828 and  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
Sun Visors  
.
Press and hold the front or  
rear of the driver side switch to  
open or close the sunroof. The  
sunshade automatically opens  
with the sunroof, but must be  
closed manually.  
on page 829  
.
Pull the sun visor down to block  
glare. Detach the sun visor from the  
center mount and slide it along the  
rod from side-to-side to cover the  
driver or passenger side of the front  
window. Swing the sun visor to the  
side to cover the side window. It can  
be moved along the rod from  
.
Press and hold the front of the  
passenger side switch to vent  
the sunroof. Press and hold the  
rear of the switch to close.  
side-to-side in this position also.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
1-19  
Dirt and debris may collect on the  
sunroof seal or in the tracks that  
could cause an issue with sunroof  
operation, noise or plug the water  
drainage system. Periodically open  
the sunroof and remove any  
obstacles or loose debris. Wipe the  
sunroof seal and roof sealing area  
using a clean cloth, mild soap, and  
water. Do not remove grease from  
sunroof.  
Express-open/Express-close  
Anti-Pinch Feature  
Press and release the front or rear  
of the driver side switch to  
express-open or express-close the  
sunroof.  
If an object is in the path of the  
sunroof when it is closing, the  
anti-pinch feature detects the object  
and stops the sunroof from closing  
at the point of the obstruction. The  
sunroof then returns to the full-open  
position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-20  
Keys, Doors and Windows  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-1  
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Safety Belt Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22  
Replacing Safety Belt System  
Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . 2-36  
Replacing Airbag System  
Parts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . 2-36  
Seats and  
Restraints  
Child Restraints  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Infants and Young  
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . 2-41  
Where to Put the  
Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43  
Lower Anchors and Tethers  
for Children (LATCH  
System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Replacing LATCH System  
Parts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Securing Child Restraints  
(Rear Seat ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Securing Child Restraints  
Parts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . 2-22  
Head Restraints  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Airbag System  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . 2-25  
When Should an Airbag  
Front Seats  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Power Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . 2-3  
Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Heated Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26  
What Makes an Airbag  
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
How Does an Airbag  
Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
What Will You See After an  
Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
Passenger Sensing  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Adding Equipment to the  
Rear Seats  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Safety Belts  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
How to Wear Safety Belts  
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17  
Safety Belt Use During  
(Front Passenger Seat) . . . . 2-54  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . 2-35  
Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-2  
Seats and Restraints  
Head Restraints  
The vehicle's front and rear seats  
have head restraints in all outboard  
seating positions.  
WARNING  
{
With head restraints that are not  
installed and adjusted properly,  
there is a greater chance that  
occupants will suffer a neck/  
spinal injury in a crash. Do not  
drive until the head restraints for  
all occupants are installed and  
adjusted properly.  
1. Pull the head restraint up to  
raise it. To lower the head  
restraint, press the release  
button, located on the head  
restraint post on the top of the  
seatback, while you push the  
head restraint down.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the  
top of the restraint is at the same  
height as the top of the occupant's  
head. This position reduces the  
chance of a neck injury in a crash.  
2. Push down on the head restraint  
after the button is released to  
make sure that it is locked in  
place.  
The vehicle's rear seat head  
restraints are not adjustable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-3  
Power Seat Adjustment  
Front Seats  
WARNING (Continued)  
pedal when you do not want to.  
Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Seat Adjustment  
To adjust the seat position:  
1. Pull the handle located at the  
front of the seat.  
2. Move the seat forward or  
backward to adjust the seat  
position.  
3. Release the handle to stop the  
seat from moving.  
Driver Seat with Power Seat  
Control, Power Recline,  
and Power Lumbar shown  
WARNING  
A: Memory Seat Adjustment  
B: Power Seat Adjustment  
C: Power Recline Adjustment  
D: Power Lumbar Adjustment  
{
You can lose control of the  
vehicle if you try to adjust a  
manual driver's seat while the  
vehicle is moving. The sudden  
movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-4  
Seats and Restraints  
Adjust the seatback by moving the  
control (C) forward or rearward.  
A second seating and mirror  
position can be programmed by  
repeating the above steps and  
pressing button 2.  
See Reclining Seatbacks on  
page 25 for more information.  
To recall the memory positions, the  
vehicle must be in P (Park). Press  
and hold either button 1 or button 2  
corresponding to the desired driving  
position. The seat, outside mirrors  
and pedals, if available move to the  
stored position. Releasing the  
Adjust the lumbar support by using  
the control (D). See Lumbar  
Adjustment on page 25 for more  
information.  
Memory Seats  
The vehicle may have a memory  
seat allowing saved and recalled  
seat settings. Controls (A) are  
located on the outboard side of  
the seat.  
button before the stored position is  
reached cancels the recall.  
Driver Seat with Power Seat  
Control, Power Lumbar,  
and Manual Recline shown  
Entry using the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter with  
the remote recall feature on  
automatically adjusts the seat and  
mirrors. There is no adjustment  
when the position has not been  
changed by another seating  
position.  
D: Power Lumbar Adjustment  
E: Power Seat Adjustment  
F: Manual Recline Adjustment  
To save:  
1. Adjust the driver seat, including  
the seatback recliner, and both  
outside mirrors, to a comfortable  
position.  
On vehicles with power seats, the  
controls are located on the outboard  
side of the seats.  
2. Press and hold the MEM button  
and button 1 at the same time  
until a beep indicates the  
position is stored.  
When the remote recall feature is  
on, the seat and mirror position will  
be stored when the ignition is turned  
to LOCK/OFF. It is stored according  
to the RKE transmitter used to start  
the vehicle.  
Adjust the power seat by moving the  
control (B) forward or rearward, up  
or down, or by pressing the top or  
bottom of control (E).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-5  
To stop recall movement of the RKE  
remote recall feature, press one of  
the power seat controls, memory  
buttons, or power mirror buttons.  
Lumbar Adjustment  
WARNING (Continued)  
Power Lumbar  
movement could startle and  
Seats with power lumbar have  
controls located on the outboard  
side of the seat. See Power Seat  
Adjustment on page 23 for more  
information.  
confuse you, or make you push a  
pedal when you do not want to.  
Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Memory Seat recall may stop if  
the seat is blocked. Remove the  
obstruction and then press the  
memory button again. If the memory  
function does not work properly, see  
your dealer for service.  
Adjust lumbar support by using the  
rocker switch (D) on the outboard  
side of the driver seat.  
WARNING  
{
Easy Exit Seat  
If either seatback is not locked, it  
could move forward in a sudden  
stop or crash. That could cause  
injury to the person sitting there.  
Always push and pull on the  
seatbacks to be sure they are  
locked.  
Release the switch when the  
seatback reaches the desired level  
of lumbar support.  
If the easy exit seat feature is on in  
the Driver Information Center (DIC),  
automatic adjustment occurs when  
the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF  
and the driver door is opened. The  
driver seat moves back.  
Reclining Seatbacks  
Manual Reclining Seatbacks  
See Vehicle Personalization on  
page 434 for more information.  
Vehicles with manual reclining  
seatbacks have a lever on the  
outboard side of the seat. Lift the  
lever and move the seatback to the  
desired position, then release the  
lever. The seatback should not  
move when pushed or pulled.  
WARNING  
{
You can lose control of the  
vehicle if you try to adjust a  
manual driver's seat while the  
vehicle is moving. The sudden  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-6  
Seats and Restraints  
Power Reclining Seatbacks  
WARNING  
{
Sitting in a reclined position when  
the vehicle is in motion can be  
dangerous. Even when buckled  
up, the safety belts cannot do  
their job when reclined like this.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its  
job because it will not be against  
your body. Instead, it will be in  
front of you. In a crash, you could  
go into it, receiving neck or other  
injuries.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if  
your vehicle is moving.  
On vehicles with power reclining  
seatbacks, the switch is located on  
the outboard side of the seat. See  
Power Seat Adjustment on  
The lap belt cannot do its job  
either. In a crash, the belt could  
go up over your abdomen. The  
belt forces would be there, not at  
your pelvic bones. This could  
cause serious internal injuries.  
page 23 for more information.  
Move the switch forward or rearward  
to adjust the seatback.  
For proper protection when the  
vehicle is in motion, have the  
seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear the  
safety belt properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-7  
Remote Start Heated Seats  
Heated Front Seats  
When it is cold outside, the  
heated seats can be turned on  
automatically during a remote  
vehicle start. The heated seats will  
be canceled when the ignition is  
turned on. Press the button to use  
the heated seats after the vehicle is  
started.  
WARNING  
{
If you cannot feel temperature  
change or pain to the skin, the  
seat heater may cause burns  
even at low temperatures. To  
reduce the risk of burns, people  
with such a condition should use  
care when using the seat heater,  
especially for long periods of  
time. Do not place anything on  
the seat that insulates against  
heat, such as a blanket, cushion,  
cover or similar item. This may  
cause the seat heater to  
The heated seat indicator lights on  
the button do not turn on during a  
remote start.  
Press the button L to heat the seat  
cushion and seatback.  
The heated seat temperature  
performance of an unoccupied seat  
may be reduced. This is normal.  
Press the button once for the  
highest setting. With each press, the  
heated seat will change to the next  
lower setting, and then the off  
setting. The lights indicate three for  
the highest setting and one for the  
lowest.  
The heated seats will not turn on  
during a remote start unless the  
heated seat feature is enabled in  
the vehicle personalization menu.  
See Remote Vehicle Start on  
page 15 and "Remote Start  
Auto Heat Seats" under Vehicle  
Personalization on page 434 for  
more information.  
overheat. An overheated seat  
heater may cause a burn or may  
damage the seat.  
On vehicles with heated front seats,  
the controls are located near the  
climate controls. To operate the  
heated seats the ignition must be in  
ON/RUN.  
The passenger seat may take  
longer to heat up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-8  
Seats and Restraints  
Rear Seats  
WARNING (Continued)  
Split Folding Seatbacks  
rear seatback, always check to  
be sure that the safety belts are  
properly routed and attached, and  
are not twisted.  
With this feature, either side of the  
rear seatback can be folded down  
for more cargo space.  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with  
the safety belts still fastened may  
cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the  
safety belts and return them to  
their normal stowed position  
before folding a rear seat.  
WARNING  
{
If either seatback is not locked, it  
could move forward in a sudden  
stop or crash. That could cause  
injury to the person sitting there.  
Always push and pull on the  
seatbacks to be sure they are  
locked.  
2. Lift the lever located on the top  
of the seatback.  
3. Fold the seatback forward.  
1. To fold the seatback down:  
Keep the seat in the upright locked  
position when not in use.  
The rear safety belts must  
be unbuckled and the front  
seatbacks are not reclined.  
To recline the seatback:  
WARNING  
{
1. Lift and hold the lever located on  
top of the seatback.  
A safety belt that is improperly  
routed, not properly attached,  
or twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be  
seriously injured. After raising the  
2. Tilt the seatback rearward, then  
release the lever when the  
seatback is in the desired  
position.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-9  
To slide the entire seat forward or  
rearward:  
Safety Belts  
This section of the manual  
describes how to use safety belts  
properly. It also describes some  
things not to do with safety belts.  
WARNING  
{
1. Lift and hold the release bar  
under the front of the seat  
cushion to unlock the seat.  
It is extremely dangerous to ride  
in a cargo area, inside or outside  
of a vehicle. In a collision, people  
riding in these areas are more  
likely to be seriously injured or  
killed. Do not allow people to ride  
in any area of your vehicle that is  
not equipped with seats and  
2. Slide the seat to the desired  
position.  
WARNING  
{
3. Release the bar.  
Do not let anyone ride where a  
safety belt cannot be worn  
4. Try to move the seat back and  
forth to endure the seat is locked  
into place.  
safety belts. Be sure everyone in  
your vehicle is in a seat and using  
a safety belt properly.  
properly. In a crash, if you or your  
passenger(s) are not wearing  
safety belts, the injuries can be  
much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be  
ejected from the vehicle. You  
and your passenger(s) can be  
seriously injured or killed. In the  
same crash, you might not be,  
if you are buckled up. Always  
fasten your safety belt, and check  
that your passenger(s) are  
This vehicle has indicators as a  
reminder to buckle the safety belts.  
See Safety Belt Reminders on  
page 414 for additional  
information.  
restrained properly too.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-10  
Seats and Restraints  
In most states and in all Canadian  
provinces, the law requires wearing  
safety belts. Here is why:  
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything,  
you go as fast as it goes.  
You never know if you will be in a  
crash. If you do have a crash, you  
do not know if it will be a  
serious one.  
A few crashes are mild, and some  
crashes can be so serious that even  
buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are in  
between. In many of them, people  
who buckle up can survive and  
sometimes walk away. Without  
safety belts they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
Put someone on it.  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose  
it is just a seat on wheels.  
After more than 40 years of safety  
belts in vehicles, the facts are clear.  
In most crashes buckling up does  
matter ... a lot!  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the  
vehicle. The rider does not stop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-11  
With safety belts, you slow down  
as the vehicle does. You get more  
time to stop. You stop over more  
distance, and your strongest bones  
take the forces. That is why safety  
belts make such good sense.  
Questions and Answers About  
Safety Belts  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle  
after a crash if I am wearing a  
safety belt?  
The person keeps going until  
stopped by something. In a real  
vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
or the instrument panel...  
A: You could be whether you are  
wearing a safety belt or not. But  
your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so  
you can unbuckle and get out, is  
much greater if you are belted.  
And you can unbuckle a safety  
belt, even if you are  
upside down.  
or the safety belts!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-12  
Seats and Restraints  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why  
should I have to wear safety  
belts?  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I  
never drive far from home,  
why should I wear safety  
belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts  
Properly  
This section is only for people of  
adult size.  
A: Airbags are supplemental  
systems only; so they work with  
safety belts not instead of  
them. Whether or not an airbag  
is provided, all occupants still  
have to buckle up to get the  
most protection. That is true not  
only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other  
collisions.  
A: You may be an excellent driver,  
but if you are in a crash even  
one that is not your fault you  
and your passenger(s) can be  
hurt. Being a good driver does  
not protect you from things  
beyond your control, such as  
bad drivers.  
Be aware that there are special  
things to know about safety belts  
and children. And there are different  
rules for smaller children and  
infants. If a child will be riding in the  
vehicle, see Older Children on  
page 237 or Infants and Young  
Children on page 239. Follow  
those rules for everyone's  
Most accidents occur within  
40 km (25 miles) of home. And  
the greatest number of serious  
injuries and deaths occur at  
speeds of less than 65 km/h  
(40 mph).  
protection.  
It is very important for all occupants  
to buckle up. Statistics show that  
unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are  
wearing safety belts.  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Occupants who are not buckled up  
can be thrown out of the vehicle in a  
crash. And they can strike others in  
the vehicle who are wearing safety  
belts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-13  
First, before you or your  
passenger(s) wear a safety belt,  
there is important information you  
should know.  
shoulder belt should go over the  
shoulder and across the chest.  
These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
WARNING  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your  
shoulder belt is too loose. In a  
crash, you would move forward  
too much, which could increase  
injury. The shoulder belt should fit  
snugly against your body.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a  
sudden stop or crash.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
Sit up straight and always keep your  
feet on the floor in front of you. The  
lap part of the belt should be worn  
low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs. In a crash, this  
applies force to the strong pelvic  
bones and you would be less likely  
to slide under the lap belt. If you slid  
under it, the belt would apply force  
on your abdomen. This could cause  
serious or even fatal injuries. The  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose.  
It will not give as much  
protection this way.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-14  
Seats and Restraints  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING  
{
lap belt should be worn low and  
snug on the hips, just touching  
the thighs.  
You can be seriously injured if  
your belt is buckled in the wrong  
place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen.  
The belt forces would be there,  
not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal  
injuries. Always buckle your belt  
into the buckle nearest you.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will  
not give nearly as much  
protection this way.  
WARNING  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your  
lap belt is too loose. In a crash,  
you could slide under the lap  
belt and apply force on your  
abdomen. This could cause  
serious or even fatal injuries. The  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong  
buckle.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-15  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING  
{
bones, and that could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. Be sure  
the belt goes under the armrests.  
You can be seriously injured if  
you wear the shoulder belt under  
your arm. In a crash, your body  
would move too far forward,  
which would increase the chance  
of head and neck injury. Also, the  
belt would apply too much force  
to the ribs, which are not as  
strong as shoulder bones. You  
could also severely injure internal  
organs like your liver or spleen.  
The shoulder belt should go over  
the shoulder and across the  
chest.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
WARNING  
{
You can be seriously injured if  
your belt goes over an armrest  
like this. The belt would be much  
too high. In a crash, you can slide  
under the belt. The belt force  
would then be applied on the  
abdomen, not on the pelvic  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under  
the arm. It should be worn over  
the shoulder at all times.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-16  
Seats and Restraints  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING  
{
You can be seriously injured by  
not wearing the lap-shoulder belt  
properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder  
belt. Your body could move too  
far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You  
might also slide under the lap  
belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen.  
That could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across  
the chest.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
A: The belt is twisted across  
the body.  
WARNING  
{
You can be seriously injured by a  
twisted belt. In a crash, you would  
not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt  
is twisted, make it straight so it  
can work properly, or ask your  
dealer to fix it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-17  
Adjustmentlater in this section  
for instructions on use and  
important safety information.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle  
have a lap-shoulder belt.  
The following instructions explain  
how to wear a lap-shoulder belt  
properly.  
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is  
adjustable, so you can sit up  
straight. To see how, see Seats”  
in the Index.  
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull  
the belt across you. Do not let it  
get twisted.  
3. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
Pull up on the latch plate to  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if  
you pull the belt across you very  
quickly. If this happens, let the  
belt go back slightly to unlock it.  
Then pull the belt across you  
more slowly.  
make sure it is secure. If the belt  
is not long enough, see Safety  
5. To make the lap part tight, pull  
up on the shoulder belt.  
Belt Extender on page 221  
.
It may be necessary to pull  
stitching on the safety belt  
through the latch plate to fully  
tighten the lap belt on smaller  
occupants.  
Position the release button on  
the buckle so that the safety belt  
could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
If the shoulder portion of a  
passenger belt is pulled out all  
the way, the child restraint  
locking feature may be engaged.  
If this happens, let the belt go  
back all the way and start again.  
4. If equipped with a shoulder belt  
height adjuster, move it to the  
height that is right for you. See  
Shoulder Belt Height  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-18  
Seats and Restraints  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt  
height adjuster for the driver and  
right front passenger seating  
positions.  
Adjust the height so that the  
shoulder portion of the belt is  
centered on the shoulder. The belt  
should be away from the face and  
neck, but not falling off the shoulder.  
Improper shoulder belt height  
adjustment could reduce the  
effectiveness of the safety belt  
in a crash.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button  
on the buckle. For outboard seating  
positions, slide the latch plate up  
the safety belt webbing when the  
safety belt is not in use. The latch  
plate should rest on the stitching on  
the safety belt, near the guide loop.  
Move the height adjuster up to the  
desired position by pushing up on  
the height adjuster.  
After the height adjuster is set to the  
desired position, try to move it up or  
down without pressing the release  
button (A) to make sure it has  
locked into position. Press the  
release button to lower the height  
adjuster.  
Before a door is closed, be sure the  
safety belt is out of the way. If a  
door is slammed against a safety  
belt, damage can occur to both the  
safety belt and the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-19  
have outgrown booster seats and  
for some adults. When installed and  
properly adjusted, the comfort guide  
positions the belt away from the  
neck and head.  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
This vehicle has safety belt  
pretensioners for front outboard  
occupants. Although the safety belt  
pretensioners cannot be seen, they  
are part of the safety belt assembly.  
They can help tighten the safety  
belts during the early stages of a  
moderate to severe frontal and near  
frontal crash if the threshold  
There is one guide for each outside  
passenger position in the rear seat.  
Here is how to install a comfort  
guide to the safety belt:  
conditions for pretensioner  
activation are met.  
2. Place the guide over the belt,  
and insert the two edges of the  
belt into the slots of the guide.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the  
pretensioners activate in a crash,  
they need to be replaced, and other  
new parts for the vehicle's safety  
belt system may be required. See  
Replacing Safety Belt System Parts  
After a Crash on page 222.  
Rear Safety Belt Comfort  
Guides  
1. Remove the guide from its  
storage pocket on the side  
of the seatback.  
This vehicle may have rear shoulder  
belt comfort guides. If not, they are  
available through your dealer. The  
guides may provide added safety  
belt comfort for older children who  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-20  
Seats and Restraints  
To remove and store the comfort  
guide, squeeze the belt edges  
together so that the safety belt can  
be removed from the guide. Slide  
the guide back into its storage  
pocket located on the side of the  
seatback.  
WARNING (Continued)  
and across the chest. These parts  
of the body are best able to take  
belt restraining forces.  
3. The belt should not be twisted  
and it should lie flat. The elastic  
cord must be under the belt and  
the guide on top.  
WARNING  
{
A safety belt that is not properly  
worn may not provide the  
4. Buckle, position, and release the  
safety belt as described  
protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be  
seriously injured. The shoulder  
belt should go over the shoulder  
previously in this section. Make  
sure that the shoulder belt  
crosses the shoulder.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
Safety System Check  
Now and then, check that the safety  
belt reminder light, safety belts,  
buckles, latch plates, retractors and  
anchorages are working properly.  
Look for any other loose or  
damaged safety belt system parts  
that might keep a safety belt system  
from doing its job. See your dealer  
to have it repaired. Torn or frayed  
safety belts may not protect you in  
a crash. They can rip apart under  
impact forces. If a belt is torn or  
frayed, get a new one right away.  
2-21  
The best way to protect the fetus is  
to protect the mother. When a safety  
belt is worn properly, it is more likely  
that the fetus will not be hurt in a  
crash. For pregnant women, as for  
anyone, the key to making safety  
belts effective is wearing them  
properly.  
Safety Belt Use During  
Pregnancy  
Safety belts work for everyone,  
including pregnant women. Like all  
occupants, they are more likely to  
be seriously injured if they do not  
wear safety belts.  
Safety Belt Extender  
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten  
around you, you should use it.  
But if a safety belt is not long  
enough, your dealer will order you  
an extender. When you go in to  
order it, take the heaviest coat you  
will wear, so the extender will be  
long enough for you. To help avoid  
personal injury, do not let someone  
else use it, and use it only for the  
seat it is made to fit. The extender  
has been designed for adults. Never  
use it for securing child seats. To  
wear it, attach it to the regular safety  
belt. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that comes with  
the extender.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder  
light is working. See Safety Belt  
Reminders on page 414 for more  
information.  
Keep safety belts clean and dry.  
See Safety Belt Care on  
A pregnant woman should wear a  
lap-shoulder belt, and the lap  
portion should be worn as low as  
possible, below the rounding,  
throughout the pregnancy.  
page 222  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-22  
Seats and Restraints  
Safety Belt Care  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following  
airbags:  
WARNING (Continued)  
safety belt systems are working  
properly after a crash, have them  
inspected and any necessary  
replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
WARNING  
{
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
.
A frontal airbag for the right front  
Do not bleach or dye safety belts.  
It may severely weaken them. In  
a crash, they might not be able to  
provide adequate protection.  
Clean safety belts only with mild  
soap and lukewarm water.  
passenger.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact  
After a minor crash, replacement of  
safety belts may not be necessary.  
But the safety belt assemblies that  
were used during any crash may  
have been stressed or damaged.  
See your dealer to have the safety  
belt assemblies inspected or  
replaced.  
airbag for the driver.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact  
airbag for the right front  
passenger.  
Replacing Safety Belt  
System Parts After a  
Crash  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the driver  
and the passenger seated  
directly behind the driver.  
New parts and repairs may be  
necessary even if the safety belt  
system was not being used at the  
time of the crash.  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the right  
front passenger and the  
passenger seated directly  
behind the right front passenger.  
WARNING  
{
A crash can damage the safety  
belt system in the vehicle.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners  
checked if the vehicle has been in a  
crash, or if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after you start the vehicle  
or while you are driving. See Airbag  
Readiness Light on page 415.  
All of the airbags in the vehicle will  
have the word AIRBAG embossed  
in the trim or on an attached label  
near the deployment opening.  
A damaged safety belt system  
may not properly protect the  
person using it, resulting in  
serious injury or even death in a  
crash. To help make sure the  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-23  
For frontal airbags, the word  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING (Continued)  
AIRBAG will appear on the middle  
part of the steering wheel for the  
driver and on the instrument panel  
for the right front passenger.  
death. Secure objects away from  
the area in which an airbag would  
inflate. For more information, see  
Where Are the Airbags? on  
page 225 and Vehicle Load  
Limits on page 824.  
designed to work with safety  
belts, but do not replace them.  
Also, airbags are not designed to  
deploy in every crash. In some  
crashes safety belts are your only  
restraint. See When Should an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 226.  
With seat-mounted side impact  
airbags, the word AIRBAG will  
appear on the side of the seatback  
closest to the door.  
Airbags are designed to supplement  
the protection provided by safety  
belts. Even though today's airbags  
are also designed to help reduce  
the risk of injury from the force of an  
inflating bag, all airbags must inflate  
very quickly to do their job.  
With roof-rail airbags, the word  
AIRBAG will appear along the trim.  
Wearing your safety belt during a  
crash helps reduce your chance  
of hitting things inside the vehicle  
or being ejected from it. Airbags  
are supplemental restraintsto  
the safety belts. Everyone in your  
vehicle should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is  
an airbag for that person.  
Even if you do not have a right front  
passenger seat in the vehicle there  
is still an active frontal airbag in the  
right side of the instrument panel.  
Do not place cargo in front of this  
airbag.  
Here are the most important things  
to know about the airbag system:  
WARNING  
{
WARNING  
{
Be sure that cargo is not near an  
airbag. In a crash, an inflating  
airbag might force that object  
toward a person. This could  
cause severe injury or even  
You can be severely injured or  
killed in a crash if you are not  
wearing your safety belt even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-24  
Seats and Restraints  
WARNING  
WARNING  
{
{
Airbags inflate with great force,  
faster than the blink of an eye.  
Anyone who is up against, or very  
close to, any airbag when it  
inflates can be seriously injured  
or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would  
be if you were sitting on the edge  
of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in  
position before and during a  
crash. Always wear your safety  
belt, even with airbags. The driver  
should sit as far back as possible  
while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
Children who are up against,  
or very close to, any airbag  
when it inflates can be seriously  
injured or killed. Airbags plus  
lap-shoulder belts offer protection  
for adults and older children, but  
not for young children and infants.  
Neither the vehicle's safety belt  
system nor its airbag system is  
designed for them. Young  
children and infants need the  
protection that a child restraint  
system can provide. Always  
secure children properly in your  
vehicle. To read how, see Older  
Children on page 237 or Infants  
and Young Children on  
There is an airbag readiness light  
on the instrument panel cluster,  
which shows the airbag symbol.  
The system checks the airbag  
electrical system for malfunctions.  
The light tells you if there is an  
electrical problem. See Airbag  
Readiness Light on page 415 for  
more information.  
Occupants should not lean on or  
sleep against the door or side  
windows in seating positions with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags  
and/or roof-rail airbags.  
page 239  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-25  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger frontal  
airbag is in the instrument panel on  
the passenger side.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger  
Side similar  
The driver frontal airbag is in the  
middle of the steering wheel.  
The seat-mounted side impact  
airbags for the driver and right front  
passenger are in the side of the  
seatbacks closest to the door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-26  
Seats and Restraints  
When Should an Airbag  
Inflate?  
WARNING (Continued)  
or even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept  
clear. Do not put anything  
between an occupant and an  
airbag, and do not attach or put  
anything on the steering wheel  
hub or on or near any other  
airbag covering.  
Frontal airbags are designed to  
inflate in moderate to severe frontal  
or near-frontal crashes to help  
reduce the potential for severe  
injuries mainly to the driver's or  
right front passenger's head and  
chest. However, they are only  
designed to inflate if the impact  
exceeds a predetermined  
deployment threshold. Deployment  
thresholds are used to predict how  
severe a crash is likely to be in time  
for the airbags to inflate and help  
restrain the occupants.  
Do not use seat accessories that  
block the inflation path of a  
seat-mounted side impact airbag.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger  
Side similar  
The roof-rail airbags for the driver,  
right front passenger, and second  
row outboard passengers are in the  
ceiling above the side windows.  
Never secure anything to the roof  
of a vehicle with roof-rail airbags  
by routing a rope or tie down  
through any door or window  
opening. If you do, the path of an  
inflating roof-rail airbag will be  
blocked.  
Whether the frontal airbags will  
or should deploy is not based on  
how fast your vehicle is traveling.  
It depends largely on what you hit,  
the direction of the impact, and how  
quickly your vehicle slows down.  
WARNING  
{
If something is between an  
occupant and an airbag, the  
airbag might not inflate properly  
or it might force the object into  
that person causing severe injury  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-27  
Frontal airbags may inflate at  
different crash speeds. For  
example:  
Frontal airbags are not intended to  
inflate during vehicle rollovers, rear  
impacts, or in many side impacts.  
the system's designed threshold  
level. The threshold level can vary  
with specific vehicle design.  
.
If the vehicle hits a stationary  
In addition, the vehicle has  
dual-stage frontal airbags.  
Seat-mounted side impact airbags  
are not intended to inflate in frontal  
impacts, near-frontal impacts,  
rollovers, or rear impacts. Roof-rail  
airbags are not intended to inflate in  
rear impacts. A seat-mounted side  
impact airbag is intended to deploy  
on the side of the vehicle that is  
struck. Both roof-rail airbags will  
deploy when either side of the  
vehicle is struck, or if the sensing  
system predicts that the vehicle is  
about to roll over, or in a severe  
frontal impact.  
object, the airbags could inflate  
at a different crash speed than if  
the vehicle hits a moving object.  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the  
restraint according to crash severity.  
The vehicle has electronic frontal  
sensors, which help the sensing  
system distinguish between a  
moderate frontal impact and a more  
severe frontal impact. For moderate  
frontal impacts, dual-stage airbags  
inflate at a level less than full  
.
If the vehicle hits an object that  
deforms, the airbags could  
inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits an object  
that does not deform.  
.
If the vehicle hits a narrow object  
(like a pole), the airbags could  
inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide  
object (like a wall).  
deployment. For more severe frontal  
impacts, full deployment occurs.  
The vehicle has seat-mounted side  
impact and roof-rail airbags. See  
Airbag System on page 222  
In any particular crash, no one  
can say whether an airbag should  
have inflated simply because of  
the damage to a vehicle or because  
of what the repair costs were.  
For frontal airbags, inflation is  
determined by what the vehicle hits,  
the angle of the impact, and how  
quickly the vehicle slows down. For  
seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags, deployment is  
.
If the vehicle goes into an object  
.
at an angle, the airbags could  
inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight  
into the object.  
Seat-mounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags are intended to  
inflate in moderate to severe side  
crashes. In addition, these roof-rail  
airbags are intended to inflate  
during a rollover or in a severe  
frontal impact. Seat-mounted side  
impact and roof-rail airbags will  
inflate if the crash severity is above  
Thresholds can also vary with  
specific vehicle design.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-28  
Seats and Restraints  
determined by the location and  
severity of the side impact. In a  
rollover event, roof-rail airbag  
deployment is determined by the  
direction of the roll.  
full or partial ejection in rollover  
events, although no system can  
prevent all such ejections.  
How Does an Airbag  
Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or  
near frontal collisions, even belted  
occupants can contact the steering  
wheel or the instrument panel. In  
moderate to severe side collisions,  
even belted occupants can contact  
the inside of the vehicle.  
But airbags would not help in  
many types of collisions, primarily  
because the occupant's motion is  
not toward those airbags. See When  
Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
What Makes an Airbag  
Inflate?  
page 226 for more information.  
In a deployment event, the sensing  
system sends an electrical signal  
triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the  
airbag causing the bag to break out  
of the cover and deploy. The inflator,  
the airbag, and related hardware are  
all part of the airbag module.  
Airbags should never be regarded  
as anything more than a supplement  
to safety belts.  
Airbags supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Frontal  
airbags distribute the force of the  
impact more evenly over the  
occupant's upper body, stopping  
the occupant more gradually.  
Seatmounted side impact and  
roof-rail airbags distribute the force  
of the impact more evenly over the  
occupant's upper body.  
What Will You See After  
an Airbag Inflates?  
After the frontal airbags and  
Frontal airbag modules are located  
inside the steering wheel and  
seat-mounted side impact airbags  
inflate, they quickly deflate, so  
quickly that some people may not  
even realize an airbag inflated.  
Roof-rail airbags may still be at least  
partially inflated for some time after  
they deploy. Some components of  
the airbag module may be hot for  
several minutes. For location of the  
airbag modules, see What Makes  
an Airbag Inflate? on page 228.  
instrument panel. For vehicles with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags,  
there are airbag modules in the side  
of the front seatbacks closest to the  
door. For vehicles with roof-rail  
airbags, there are airbag modules in  
the ceiling of the vehicle, near the  
side windows that have occupant  
seating positions.  
Rollover capable roof-rail airbags  
are designed to help contain the  
head and chest of occupants in the  
outboard seating positions in the  
first and second rows. The rollover  
capable roof-rail airbags are  
designed to help reduce the risk of  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-29  
The parts of the airbag that come  
into contact with you may be warm,  
but not too hot to touch. There may  
be some smoke and dust coming  
from the vents in the deflated  
airbags. Airbag inflation does not  
prevent the driver from seeing out of  
the windshield or being able to steer  
the vehicle, nor does it prevent  
people from leaving the vehicle.  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING (Continued)  
problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek  
medical attention.  
concealed damage that could  
make it difficult to safely operate  
the vehicle.  
Use caution if you should attempt  
to restart the engine after a crash  
has occurred.  
The vehicle has a feature that may  
automatically unlock the doors, turn  
on the interior lamps and hazard  
warning flashers, and shut off the  
fuel system after the airbags inflate.  
You can lock the doors, turn off the  
interior lamps and hazard warning  
flashers by using the controls for  
those features.  
In many crashes severe enough to  
inflate the airbag, windshields are  
broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may  
also occur from the right front  
passenger airbag.  
WARNING  
{
When an airbag inflates, there  
may be dust in the air. This dust  
could cause breathing problems  
for people with a history of  
asthma or other breathing trouble.  
To avoid this, everyone in the  
vehicle should get out as soon as  
it is safe to do so. If you have  
breathing problems but cannot  
get out of the vehicle after an  
airbag inflates, then get fresh air  
by opening a window or a door.  
If you experience breathing  
.
Airbags are designed to inflate  
only once. After an airbag  
WARNING  
{
inflates, you will need some new  
parts for the airbag system.  
If you do not get them, the  
airbag system will not be there  
to help protect you in another  
crash. A new system will include  
airbag modules and possibly  
other parts. The service manual  
for your vehicle covers the need  
to replace other parts.  
A crash severe enough to inflate  
the airbags may have also  
damaged important functions in  
the vehicle, such as the fuel  
system, brake and steering  
systems, etc. Even if the vehicle  
appears to be drivable after a  
moderate crash, there may be  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-30  
Seats and Restraints  
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing  
and diagnostic module which  
records information after a  
crash. See Vehicle Data  
Recording and Privacy on  
page 1214 and Event Data  
Recorders on page 1215.  
The passenger sensing system  
turns off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag under certain  
conditions. The driver airbag,  
seatmounted side impact airbags  
and the roof-rail airbags are not  
affected by the passenger sensing  
system.  
United States  
.
Let only qualified technicians  
work on the airbag systems.  
Improper service can mean that  
an airbag system will not work  
properly. See your dealer for  
service.  
The passenger sensing system  
works with sensors that are part of  
the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the  
presence of a properly-seated  
occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag  
should be enabled (may inflate)  
or not.  
Canada  
Passenger Sensing  
System  
The vehicle has a passenger  
sensing system for the right front  
passenger position. The passenger  
airbag status indicator will be visible  
on the overhead console when the  
vehicle is started.  
The words ON and OFF, or the  
symbol for on and off, are visible  
during the system check. If you are  
using remote start, if equipped, to  
start the vehicle from a distance,  
you may not see the system check.  
When the system check is  
complete, either the word ON or  
OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will  
be visible. See Passenger Airbag  
Status Indicator on page 415.  
According to accident statistics,  
children are safer when properly  
secured in a rear seat in the correct  
child restraint for their weight  
and size.  
We recommend that children be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an  
infant or a child riding in a  
rear-facing child restraint; a child  
riding in a forward-facing child seat;  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-31  
an older child riding in a booster  
seat; and children, who are large  
enough, using safety belts.  
The passenger sensing system is  
designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag if:  
WARNING (Continued)  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can  
guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the  
airbag is turned off.  
.
A label on the sun visor says,  
Never put a rear-facing child seat in  
the front.This is because the risk to  
the rear-facing child is so great,  
if the airbag deploys.  
The right front passenger seat is  
unoccupied.  
.
The system determines that an  
infant is present in a child  
restraint.  
.
A right front passenger takes  
WARNING  
{
his/her weight off of the seat for  
a period of time.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints  
in a rear seat, even if the airbag  
is off. If you secure a  
A child in a rear-facing child  
restraint can be seriously injured  
or killed if the right front  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem  
with the airbag system or the  
forward-facing child restraint in  
the right front seat, always move  
the front passenger seat as far  
back as it will go. It is better to  
secure the child restraint in a  
rear seat.  
passenger airbag inflates. This  
is because the back of the  
rear-facing child restraint would  
be very close to the inflating  
airbag. A child in a forward-facing  
child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates and the  
passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
passenger sensing system.  
When the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag, the off  
indicator will light and stay lit to  
remind you that the airbag is off.  
See Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator on page 415.  
The passenger sensing system is  
designed to turn on (may inflate) the  
right front passenger frontal airbag  
anytime the system senses that a  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-32  
Seats and Restraints  
person of adult size is sitting  
properly in the right front  
passenger seat.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint  
following the directions  
WARNING  
{
provided by the child restraint  
manufacturer and refer to  
Securing Child Restraints (Rear  
Seat ) on page 251 or  
Securing Child Restraints (Front  
Passenger Seat) on page 254.  
If the airbag readiness light ever  
comes on and stays on, it means  
that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help  
avoid injury to yourself or others,  
have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness  
Light on page 415 for more  
information, including important  
safety information.  
When the passenger sensing  
system has allowed the airbag to be  
enabled, the on indicator will light  
and stay lit to remind you that the  
airbag is active.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child  
restraint and restarting the  
vehicle, the on indicator is still lit,  
turn the vehicle off. Then slightly  
recline the vehicle seatback and  
adjust the seat cushion, if  
For some children, including  
children in child restraints, and for  
very small adults, the passenger  
sensing system may or may not  
turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag, depending upon the  
persons seating posture and  
body build. Everyone in the vehicle  
who has outgrown child restraints  
should wear a safety belt  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a  
Child Restraint  
adjustable, to make sure that the  
vehicle seatback is not pushing  
the child restraint into the seat  
cushion.  
If a child restraint has been installed  
and the on indicator is lit:  
properly whether or not there is  
an airbag for that person.  
Also make sure the child  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
restraint is not trapped under the  
vehicle head restraint. If this  
happens, adjust the head  
2. Remove the child restraint from  
the vehicle.  
restraint. See Head Restraints  
3. Remove any additional items  
from the seat such as blankets,  
cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
on page 22  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-33  
6. Restart the vehicle.  
properly in the seat. If this happens,  
use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and  
enable the right front passenger  
frontal airbag:  
Additional Factors Affecting  
System Operation  
The passenger sensing system  
may or may not turn off the  
airbag for a child in a child  
restraint depending upon the  
childs seating posture and body  
build. It is better to secure the  
child restraint in a rear seat.  
Safety belts help keep the  
passenger in position on the seat  
during vehicle maneuvers and  
braking, which helps the passenger  
sensing system maintain the  
passenger airbag status. See  
Safety Beltsand Child Restraints”  
in the Index for additional  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material  
from the seat, such as blankets,  
cushions, seat covers, seat  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
information about the importance of  
proper restraint use.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully  
upright position.  
A thick layer of additional material,  
such as a blanket or cushion,  
or aftermarket equipment such as  
seat covers, seat heaters, and seat  
massagers can affect how well the  
passenger sensing system  
4. Have the person sit upright in  
the seat, centered on the seat  
cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the  
person remain in this position for  
two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
operates. We recommend that you  
not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when  
approved by GM for your specific  
vehicle. See Adding Equipment to  
the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
page 235 for more information  
about modifications that can affect  
how the system operates.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in  
the right front passenger seat, but  
the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-34  
Seats and Restraints  
A wet seat can affect the  
performance of the passenger  
sensing system. Here is how:  
The on indicator may be lit if an  
object, such as a briefcase,  
handbag, grocery bag, laptop or  
other electronic device, is put on  
an unoccupied seat. If this is not  
desired remove the object from  
the seat.  
To purchase a service manual, see  
Service Publications Ordering  
Information on page 1212.  
.
The passenger sensing system  
WARNING  
{
may turn off the passenger  
airbag when liquid is soaked  
into the seat. If this happens, the  
off indicator will be lit, and the  
airbag readiness light on the  
instrument panel will also be lit.  
For up to 10 seconds after the  
ignition is turned off and the  
battery is disconnected, an airbag  
can still inflate during improper  
service. You can be injured if you  
are close to an airbag when it  
inflates. Avoid yellow connectors.  
They are probably part of the  
airbag system. Be sure to follow  
proper service procedures, and  
make sure the person performing  
work for you is qualified to do so.  
WARNING  
{
Stowing of articles under the  
passenger seat or between the  
passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the  
proper operation of the passenger  
sensing system.  
.
Liquid pooled on the seat that  
has not soaked in may make it  
more likely that the passenger  
sensing system will enable (turn  
on) the passenger airbag while a  
child restraint or child occupant  
is on the seat. If the passenger  
airbag is turned on, the on  
Servicing the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
indicator will be lit.  
If the passenger seat gets wet, dry  
the seat immediately. If the airbag  
readiness light is lit, do not install a  
child restraint or allow anyone to  
occupy the seat. See Airbag  
Airbags affect how the vehicle  
should be serviced. There are parts  
of the airbag system in several  
places around the vehicle. Your  
dealer and the service manual have  
information about servicing the  
vehicle and the airbag system.  
Readiness Light on page 415 for  
important safety information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-35  
that are part of the passenger  
seat. The passenger sensing  
system may not operate properly  
if the original seat trim is  
replaced with non-GM covers,  
upholstery or trim, or with GM  
covers, upholstery or trim  
designed for a different vehicle.  
Any object, such as an  
aftermarket seat heater or a  
comfort enhancing pad or  
device, installed under or on top  
of the seat fabric, could also  
interfere with the operation of  
the passenger sensing system.  
This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger  
airbag(s) or prevent the  
passenger sensing system  
from properly turning off the  
passenger airbag(s). See  
Satisfaction Procedure in this  
manual. See Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure on  
Adding Equipment to the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
Q: Is there anything I might add  
to or change about the vehicle  
that could keep the airbags  
from working properly?  
page 121  
.
If the vehicle has rollover  
roof-rail airbags, see Different  
Size Tires and Wheels on  
page 955 for additional  
important information.  
A: Yes. If you add things that  
change the vehicle's frame,  
bumper system, height, front end  
or side sheet metal, they may  
keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or  
moving any parts of the front  
seats, safety belts, the airbag  
sensing and diagnostic module,  
steering wheel, instrument  
Q: Because I have a disability,  
I have to get my vehicle  
modified. How can I find out  
whether this will affect my  
airbag system?  
A: If you have questions, call  
Customer Assistance. The  
phone numbers and addresses  
for Customer Assistance are in  
Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this  
manual. See Customer  
panel, roof-rail airbag modules,  
ceiling headliner or pillar garnish  
trim, overhead console, front  
sensors, side impact sensors,  
rollover sensor module, or airbag  
wiring can affect the operation of  
the airbag system.  
Passenger Sensing System on  
page 230  
.
Satisfaction Procedure on  
page 121  
.
If you have questions, call  
Customer Assistance. The  
phone numbers and addresses  
for Customer Assistance are in  
Step Two of the Customer  
In addition, the vehicle has a  
passenger sensing system  
for the right front passenger  
position, which includes sensors  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-36  
Seats and Restraints  
In addition, your dealer and the  
service manual have information  
about the location of the airbag  
sensors, sensing and diagnostic  
module and airbag wiring.  
If an airbag inflates, you will need to  
replace airbag system parts. See  
your dealer for service.  
Replacing Airbag System  
Parts After a Crash  
If the airbag readiness light stays on  
after the vehicle is started or comes  
on when you are driving, the airbag  
system may not work properly. Have  
the vehicle serviced right away. See  
Airbag Readiness Light on  
WARNING  
{
A crash can damage the airbag  
systems in your vehicle.  
Airbag System Check  
The airbag system does not need  
regularly scheduled maintenance or  
replacement. Make sure the airbag  
readiness light is working. See  
Airbag Readiness Light on  
A damaged airbag system  
may not work properly and  
may not protect you and your  
passenger(s) in a crash, resulting  
in serious injury or even death.  
To help make sure your airbag  
systems are working properly  
after a crash, have them  
page 415 for more information.  
page 415 for more information.  
Notice: If an airbag covering is  
damaged, opened, or broken, the  
airbag may not work properly. Do  
not open or break the airbag  
coverings. If there are any  
inspected and any necessary  
replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
opened or broken airbag covers,  
have the airbag covering and/or  
airbag module replaced. For the  
location of the airbag modules,  
see What Makes an Airbag  
Inflate? on page 228. See your  
dealer for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-37  
.
Can proper safety belt fit be  
maintained for the length of the  
trip? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
The manufacturer's instructions that  
come with the booster seat, state  
the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat  
with a lap-shoulder belt until the  
child passes the below fit test:  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
Q: What is the proper way to  
wear safety belts?  
.
Sit all the way back on the seat.  
A: An older child should wear a  
lap-shoulder belt and get the  
additional restraint a shoulder  
belt can provide. The shoulder  
belt should not cross the face or  
neck. The lap belt should fit  
snugly below the hips, just  
touching the top of the thighs.  
This applies belt force to the  
child's pelvic bones in a crash.  
It should never be worn over the  
abdomen, which could cause  
severe or even fatal internal  
injuries in a crash.  
Do the knees bend at the seat  
edge? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
.
Buckle the lap-shoulder belt.  
Does the shoulder belt rest on  
the shoulder? If yes, continue.  
If no, try using the rear safety  
belt comfort guide. See Rear  
Safety Belt Comfort Guides”  
under Lap-Shoulder Belt on  
page 217 for more information.  
If the shoulder belt still does not  
rest on the shoulder, then return  
to the booster seat.  
Older children who have outgrown  
booster seats should wear the  
vehicle's safety belts.  
Also see Rear Safety Belt Comfort  
Guidesunder Lap-Shoulder Belt on  
.
Does the lap belt fit low and  
snug on the hips, touching the  
thighs? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
page 217  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-38  
Seats and Restraints  
According to accident statistics,  
children and infants are safer when  
properly restrained in a child  
restraint system or infant restraint  
system secured in a rear seating  
position.  
WARNING (Continued)  
might also slide under the lap  
belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen.  
That could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across  
the chest.  
In a crash, children who are not  
buckled up can strike other people  
who are buckled up, or can be  
thrown out of the vehicle. Older  
children need to use safety belts  
properly.  
WARNING  
{
WARNING  
{
Never do this.  
Never do this.  
Never allow a child to wear the  
safety belt with the shoulder belt  
behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing  
the lap-shoulder belt properly. In  
a crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt.  
The child could move too far  
Never allow two children to wear  
the same safety belt. The safety  
belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two  
children can be crushed together  
and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one  
person at a time.  
forward increasing the chance of  
head and neck injury. The child  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-39  
Airbags plus lapshoulder belts offer  
protection for adults and older  
children, but not for young children  
and infants. Neither the vehicle's  
safety belt system nor its airbag  
system is designed for them. Every  
time infants and young children ride  
in vehicles, they should have the  
protection provided by appropriate  
child restraints.  
Infants and Young  
Children  
WARNING (Continued)  
110 kg (240 lb) force on a person's  
arms. An infant should be  
secured in an appropriate  
restraint.  
Everyone in a vehicle needs  
protection! This includes infants  
and all other children. Neither the  
distance traveled nor the age and  
size of the traveler changes the  
need, for everyone, to use safety  
restraints. In fact, the law in every  
state in the United States and in  
every Canadian province says  
children up to some age must be  
restrained while in a vehicle.  
Children who are not restrained  
properly can strike other people,  
or can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
WARNING  
{
WARNING  
{
Never do this.  
Children can be seriously injured  
or strangled if a shoulder belt is  
wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to  
tighten. Never leave children  
unattended in a vehicle and never  
allow children to play with the  
safety belts.  
Never hold an infant or a child  
while riding in a vehicle. Due to  
crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not  
possible to hold it during a crash.  
For example, in a crash at only  
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb)  
infant will suddenly become a  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-40  
Seats and Restraints  
Q: What are the different types of  
add-on child restraints?  
WARNING  
{
A: Add-on child restraints, which  
are purchased by the vehicle's  
owner, are available in four basic  
types. Selection of a particular  
restraint should take into  
Never do this.  
Children who are up against,  
or very close to, any airbag when  
it inflates can be seriously injured  
or killed. Never put a rear-facing  
child restraint in the right front  
seat. Secure a rear-facing child  
restraint in a rear seat. It is also  
better to secure a forward-facing  
child restraint in a rear seat. If you  
must secure a forward-facing  
child restraint in the right front  
seat, always move the front  
passenger seat as far back as it  
will go.  
consideration not only the child's  
weight, height, and age but also  
whether or not the restraint will  
be compatible with the motor  
vehicle in which it will be used.  
For most basic types of child  
restraints, there are many  
different models available. When  
purchasing a child restraint, be  
sure it is designed to be used in  
a motor vehicle. If it is, the  
restraint will have a label saying  
that it meets federal motor  
vehicle safety standards.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-41  
The restraint manufacturer's  
instructions that come with the  
restraint state the weight and  
height limitations for a particular  
child restraint. In addition, there  
are many kinds of restraints  
available for children with  
special needs.  
Child Restraint Systems  
WARNING  
{
A young child's hip bones are still  
so small that the vehicle's regular  
safety belt may not remain low on  
the hip bones, as it should.  
Instead, it may settle up around  
the child's abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a  
body area that is unprotected by  
any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal  
injuries. To reduce the risk of  
serious or fatal injuries during a  
crash, young children should  
always be secured in appropriate  
child restraints.  
WARNING  
{
To reduce the risk of neck and  
head injury during a crash, infants  
need complete support. This is  
because an infant's neck is not  
fully developed and its head  
weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an  
infant in a rear-facing child  
(A) RearFacing Infant Seat  
A rear-facing infant seat (A)  
provides restraint with the seating  
surface against the back of the  
infant.  
restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be  
The harness system holds the infant  
in place and, in a crash, acts to  
keep the infant positioned in the  
restraint.  
distributed across the strongest  
part of an infant's body, the back  
and shoulders. Infants should  
always be secured in rear-facing  
child restraints.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-42  
Seats and Restraints  
Securing an Add-On Child  
Restraint in the Vehicle  
WARNING  
{
A child can be seriously injured  
or killed in a crash if the child  
restraint is not properly secured  
in the vehicle. Secure the child  
restraint properly in the vehicle  
using the vehicle's safety belt or  
LATCH system, following the  
instructions that came with that  
child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
(B) Forward-Facing Child Seat  
(C) Booster Seats  
A forward-facing child seat (B)  
provides restraint for the child's  
body with the harness.  
A booster seat (C) is a child restraint  
designed to improve the fit of the  
vehicle's safety belt system.  
To help reduce the chance of injury,  
the child restraint must be secured  
in the vehicle. Child restraint  
A booster seat can also help a child  
to see out the window.  
systems must be secured in vehicle  
seats by lap belts or the lap belt  
portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by  
the LATCH system. See Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH System) on page 245 for  
more information. Children can be  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-43  
endangered in a crash if the child  
restraint is not properly secured in  
the vehicle.  
Securing the Child Within the  
Child Restraint  
Where to Put the  
Restraint  
According to accident statistics,  
children and infants are safer when  
properly restrained in a child  
restraint system or infant restraint  
system secured in a rear seating  
position.  
When securing an add-on child  
restraint, refer to the instructions  
that come with the restraint which  
may be on the restraint itself or in a  
booklet, or both, and to this manual.  
The child restraint instructions are  
important, so if they are not  
WARNING  
{
A child can be seriously injured or  
killed in a crash if the child is not  
properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child  
properly following the instructions  
that came with that child restraint.  
We recommend that children and  
child restraints be secured in a rear  
seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint;  
a child riding in a forward-facing  
child seat; an older child riding in a  
booster seat; and children, who are  
large enough, using safety belts.  
available, obtain a replacement  
copy from the manufacturer.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured  
child restraint can move around in a  
collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to  
properly secure any child restraint in  
the vehicle even when no child is  
in it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-44  
Seats and Restraints  
A label on your sun visor says,  
Never put a rear-facing child seat in  
the front.This is because the risk to  
the rear-facing child is so great,  
if the airbag deploys.  
recommend that rear-facing child  
restraints not be transported in the  
vehicle, even if the airbag is off.  
WARNING (Continued)  
deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is  
turned off.  
Wherever you install a child  
restraint, be sure to secure the child  
restraint properly.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints  
in a rear seat, even if the airbag  
is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in  
the right front seat, always move  
the front passenger seat as far  
back as it will go. It is better to  
secure the child restraint in a  
rear seat.  
WARNING  
{
Keep in mind that an unsecured  
child restraint can move around in a  
collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to  
properly secure any child restraint in  
your vehicle even when no child  
is in it.  
A child in a rear-facing child  
restraint can be seriously injured  
or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is  
because the back of the  
rear-facing child restraint would  
be very close to the inflating  
airbag. A child in a forward-facing  
child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates and the  
passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
If you need to secure more than one  
child restraint in the rear seat,  
review the following illustrations.  
Depending on where you place the  
child restraint or the size of the child  
restraint, you may not be able to  
access certain safety belt  
assemblies or LATCH anchors for  
additional passengers or child  
restraints.  
See Passenger Sensing System  
on page 230 for additional  
information.  
When securing a child restraint in a  
rear seating position, study the  
instructions that came with your  
child restraint to make sure it is  
compatible with this vehicle.  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can  
guarantee that an airbag will not  
If the vehicle does not have a rear  
seat that will accommodate a  
rear-facing child restraint, we  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-45  
The LATCH system uses anchors in  
the vehicle and attachments on the  
child restraint that are made for use  
with the LATCH system.  
Configurations for Use of Child  
Restraints  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible  
child restraint is properly installed  
using the anchors, or use the  
A. Child restraint or occupant  
using safety belt  
vehicle's safety belts to secure the  
restraint, following the instructions  
that came with that restraint, and  
also the instructions in this manual.  
When installing a child restraint with  
a top tether, you must also use  
either the lower anchors or the  
safety belts to properly secure the  
child restraint. A child restraint must  
never be installed using only the top  
tether and anchor.  
A. Child restraint using LATCH  
B. Occupant prohibited  
A. Child restraint or occupant  
using safety belt  
B. Child restraint using LATCH  
A. Child restraint using LATCH  
B. Occupant prohibited  
In order to use the LATCH system  
in your vehicle, you need a child  
restraint that has LATCH  
attachments. The child restraint  
manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the child  
restraint and its attachments. The  
following explains how to attach a  
child restraint with these  
Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children  
(LATCH System)  
The LATCH system holds a child  
restraint during driving or in a crash.  
This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier.  
C. Child restraint or occupant  
using safety belt  
attachments in your vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-46  
Seats and Restraints  
Not all vehicle seating positions or  
child restraints have lower anchors  
and attachments or top tether  
anchors and attachments.  
Your child restraint may have a  
single tether (A) or a dual tether (C).  
Either will have a single  
attachment (B) to secure the top  
tether to the anchor.  
Top Tether Anchor  
Lower Anchors  
Some child restraints that have a  
top tether are designed for use with  
or without the top tether being  
attached. Others require the top  
tether always to be attached. In  
Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached. Be sure to read and follow  
the instructions for your child  
restraint.  
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars  
built into the vehicle. There are two  
lower anchors for each LATCH  
seating position that will  
accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the  
top of the child restraint to the  
vehicle. A top tether anchor is built  
into the vehicle. The top tether  
attachment (B) on the child restraint  
connects to the top tether anchor in  
the vehicle in order to reduce the  
forward movement and rotation of  
the child restraint during driving or in  
a crash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-47  
Do not secure a child restraint in a  
position without a top tether anchor  
if a national or local law requires  
that the top tether be attached, or if  
the instructions that come with the  
child restraint say that the top tether  
must be attached.  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether  
Anchor Locations  
According to accident statistics,  
children and infants are safer when  
properly restrained in a child  
restraint system or infant restraint  
system secured in a rear seating  
position. See Where to Put the  
Restraint on page 243 for  
Top Tether Anchors  
The top tether anchors for each rear  
seating position are located on the  
back of the rear seatback. You may  
need to adjust the rear compartment  
storage panel/cover in the rear  
cargo area to access the anchors.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on  
the same side of the vehicle as the  
seating position where the child  
restraint will be placed.  
additional information.  
Rear Seat  
i (Top Tether Anchor): Seating  
positions with top tether anchors.  
j (Lower Anchor): Seating  
positions with two lower anchors.  
The rear outboard seating positions  
have exposed metal anchors  
located in the crease between the  
seatback and the seat cushion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-48  
Seats and Restraints  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Designed for the LATCH  
System  
WARNING  
WARNING (Continued)  
{
Do not attach more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor.  
of the retractor to set the lock,  
if your vehicle has one, after the  
child restraint has been installed.  
WARNING  
{
Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could  
cause the anchor or attachment  
to come loose or even break  
during a crash. A child or others  
could be injured. To reduce the  
risk of serious or fatal injuries  
during a crash, attach only one  
child restraint per anchor.  
If a LATCH-type child restraint is  
not attached to anchors, the child  
restraint will not be able to protect  
the child correctly. In a crash, the  
child could be seriously injured or  
killed. Install a LATCH-type child  
restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle's  
safety belts to secure the  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH  
attachments rub against the  
vehicles safety belts. This may  
damage these parts. If necessary,  
move buckled safety belts to  
avoid rubbing the LATCH  
attachments.  
Do not fold the empty rear seat  
with a safety belt buckled. This  
could damage the safety belt or  
the seat. Unbuckle and return the  
safety belt to its stowed position,  
before folding the seat.  
restraint, following the instructions  
that came with the child restraint  
and the instructions in this  
WARNING  
{
Children can be seriously injured  
or strangled if a shoulder belt is  
wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to  
tighten. Buckle any unused safety  
belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull  
the shoulder belt all the way out  
manual.  
Make sure to attach the child  
restraint at the proper anchor  
location.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-49  
This system is designed to make  
installation of child restraints easier.  
When using lower anchors, do not  
use the vehicle's safety belts.  
Instead use the vehicle's anchors  
and child restraint attachments to  
secure the restraints. Some  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower  
attachments on the child  
restraint to the lower  
anchors.  
2.2. Route, attach and tighten  
the top tether according to  
your child restraint  
instructions and the  
following instructions:  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer  
recommends that the top tether  
be attached, attach and tighten  
the top tether to the top tether  
anchor, if equipped. Refer to the  
child restraint instructions and  
the following steps:  
restraints also use another vehicle  
anchor to secure a top tether.  
1. Attach and tighten the lower  
attachments to the lower  
anchors. If the child restraint  
does not have lower  
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.  
attachments or the desired  
seating position does not have  
lower anchors, secure the child  
restraint with the top tether and  
the safety belts. Refer to your  
child restraint manufacturer  
instructions and the instructions  
in this manual.  
If the position you are using  
does not have a headrest  
or head restraint and you  
are using a single tether,  
route the tether over the  
seatback.  
1.1. Find the lower anchors for  
the desired seating  
position.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on  
the seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-50  
Seats and Restraints  
If the position you are using  
does not have a headrest  
or head restraint and you  
are using a dual tether,  
route the tether over the  
seatback.  
If the position you are using  
has a fixed headrest or  
head restraint and you are  
using a dual tether, route  
the tether around the  
If the position you are using  
has a fixed headrest or  
head restraint and you are  
using a single tether, route  
the tether over the headrest  
or head restraint.  
headrest or head restraint.  
3. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-51  
In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
Replacing LATCH System Securing Child Restraints  
Parts After a Crash  
(Rear Seat )  
When securing a child restraint in  
a rear seating position, study the  
instructions that came with the child  
restraint to make sure it is  
WARNING  
{
If the child restraint does not have  
the LATCH system, you will be  
using the safety belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Be  
sure to follow the instructions that  
came with the child restraint. Secure  
the child in the child restraint when  
and as the instructions say.  
A crash can damage the LATCH  
system in the vehicle. A damaged  
LATCH system may not properly  
secure the child restraint,  
resulting in serious injury or even  
death in a crash. To help make  
sure the LATCH system is  
working properly after a crash,  
see your dealer to have the  
system inspected and any  
necessary replacements made as  
soon as possible.  
compatible with this vehicle.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH  
system, see Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH  
System) on page 245 for how and  
where to install the child restraint  
using LATCH. If a child restraint is  
secured in the vehicle using a  
safety belt and it uses a top tether,  
see Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH System) on  
page 245 for top tether anchor  
locations.  
If more than one child restraint  
needs to be installed in the rear  
seat, be sure to read Where to Put  
the Restraint on page 243.  
1. Put the child restraint on  
the seat.  
If the vehicle has the LATCH system  
and it was being used during a  
crash, new LATCH system parts  
may be needed.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run  
the lap and shoulder portions of  
the vehicle's safety belt through  
or around the restraint. The child  
restraint instructions will show  
you how.  
Do not secure a child seat in a  
position without a top tether anchor  
if a national or local law requires  
that the top tether be anchored, or if  
the instructions that come with the  
child restraint say that the top strap  
must be anchored.  
New parts and repairs may be  
necessary even if the LATCH  
system was not being used at the  
time of the crash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-52  
Seats and Restraints  
3. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
4. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to  
set the lock.  
5. To tighten the belt, push down  
on the child restraint, pull the  
shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt  
and feed the shoulder belt back  
into the retractor. When installing  
a forward-facing child restraint, it  
may be helpful to use your knee  
to push down on the child  
Position the release button on  
the buckle so that the safety belt  
could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
restraint as you tighten the belt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-53  
6. If the child restraint has a top  
tether, follow the child restraint  
manufacturer's instructions  
regarding the use of the top  
tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH  
System) on page 245 for more  
information.  
center armrest before installing a  
rearfacing child restraint in the  
second row center seat position.  
Armrest Retaining Strap  
WARNING  
{
A rear center armrest that is not  
properly stowed and secured  
could fall forward during a sudden  
stop or collision. The armrest  
could contact an infant secured in  
a rearfacing child restraint in the  
center seat position. Fasten the  
retaining strap onto the stowed  
armrest before installing a  
7. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
To remove the child restraint,  
unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  
let it return to the stowed position.  
If the top tether is attached to a top  
tether anchor, disconnect it.  
rearfacing child restraint in  
the rear center seat position.  
Stow the rear seat center armrest.  
Attach the retaining strap to the  
armrest loop (A) and to the center  
top tether anchor on the  
seatback (B). Make sure the  
retaining strap's clips are firmly  
attached.  
When new, the vehicle's glove box  
materials included an armrest  
retaining strap. Use it to secure the  
Install the rear-facing child restraint  
using the child restraint  
manufacturer's instructions and the  
instructions described previously.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-54  
Seats and Restraints  
Remove the armrest retaining strap  
before installing a forward facing  
child restraint in the center seat  
position, as it may interfere with the  
attachment of the top tether to the  
top tether anchor on the seatback.  
A label on the sun visor says,  
Never put a rear-facing child seat in  
the front.This is because the risk to  
the rear-facing child is so great,  
if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING (Continued)  
deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is  
turned off.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints  
in a rear seat, even if the airbag  
is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in  
the right front seat, always move  
the front passenger seat as far  
back as it will go. It is better to  
secure the child restraint in a  
rear seat.  
WARNING  
{
Securing Child Restraints  
(Front Passenger Seat)  
This vehicle has airbags. A rear  
seat is a safer place to secure a  
forward-facing child restraint. See  
Where to Put the Restraint on  
A child in a rear-facing child  
restraint can be seriously injured  
or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This  
is because the back of the  
rear-facing child restraint would  
be very close to the inflating  
airbag. A child in a forward-facing  
child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates and the  
passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
page 243  
.
In addition, the vehicle has a  
passenger sensing system which is  
designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under  
certain conditions. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 230 and  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  
on page 415 for more information,  
including important safety  
See Passenger Sensing System  
on page 230 for additional  
information.  
If the vehicle does not have a  
rear seat that will accommodate  
a rearfacing child restraint, a  
rearfacing child restraint should not  
be installed in the vehicle, even if  
the airbag is off.  
Even if the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can  
guarantee that an airbag will not  
information.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seats and Restraints  
2-55  
If the child restraint has the LATCH  
system, see Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH  
System) on page 245 for how and  
where to install the child restraint  
using LATCH. If a child restraint is  
secured using a safety belt and it  
uses a top tether, see Lower  
You will be using the lap-shoulder  
belt to secure the child restraint in  
this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it  
will go before securing the  
forward-facing child restraint.  
When the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag  
and seatmounted side impact  
airbag, the off indicator on the  
passenger airbag status  
indicator should light and stay lit  
when you start the vehicle. See  
Passenger Airbag Status  
Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH System) on page 245 for  
top tether anchor locations.  
Do not secure a child seat in a  
position without a top tether anchor  
if a national or local law requires  
that the top tether be anchored, or if  
the instructions that come with the  
child restraint say that the top strap  
must be anchored.  
4. Push the latch plate into the  
buckle until it clicks.  
Position the release button on  
the buckle, so that the safety  
belt could be quickly unbuckled  
if necessary.  
Indicator on page 415.  
2. Put the child restraint on  
the seat.  
In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have  
a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run  
the lap and shoulder portions of  
the vehicle's safety belt through  
or around the restraint. The child  
restraint instructions will show  
you how.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-56  
Seats and Restraints  
instructions regrading the use of  
the top tether. See Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH System) on  
page 245 for more information.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint  
in different directions to be sure  
it is secure.  
If the airbags are off, the off  
indicator in the passenger airbag  
status indicator will come on and  
stay on when the vehicle is started.  
5. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to  
set the lock.  
6. To tighten the belt, push down  
on the child restraint, pull the  
shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt  
and feed the shoulder belt back  
into the retractor. When installing  
a forward-facing child restraint,  
it may be helpful to use your  
knee to push down on the child  
restraint as you tighten the belt.  
If a child restraint has been installed  
and the on indicator is lit, see If  
the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraintunder Passenger Sensing  
System on page 230 for more  
information.  
To remove the child restraint,  
unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and  
let it return to the stowed position.  
If the vehicle does not have a  
rear seat and the child restraint  
has a top tether, follow the child  
restraint manufacturer's  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storage  
3-1  
Storage  
Compartments  
Additional Storage  
Features  
Storage  
Storage Compartments  
Instrument Panel Storage Cargo Cover  
Instrument Panel Storage . . . . 3-1  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . 3-1  
There may be a storage  
For vehicles with a cargo cover, use  
it to cover items in the rear of the  
vehicle.  
compartment on the instrument  
panel. Pull the handle to open.  
Additional Storage Features  
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
To remove the cover from the  
vehicle, pull both ends toward each  
other. To reinstall, place each end of  
the cover in the holes behind the  
rear seat.  
Glove Box  
Open the glove box by lifting up on  
the lever.  
Roof Rack System  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Cupholders  
Convenience Net  
This vehicle may have a  
convenience net located in the rear  
of the vehicle. Attach it to the cargo  
tie-downs for storing small loads.  
Two cupholders are in the center  
console. Cupholders may be located  
in the second row seat armrest. To  
access, pull the armrest down.  
Center Console Storage  
For vehicles with center console  
storage, use the lever on the front  
to open.  
Do not use the net to store heavy  
loads.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-2  
Storage  
Notice: Loading cargo on the  
roof rack that weighs more than  
100 kg (220 lbs) or hangs over the  
rear or sides of the vehicle may  
damage the vehicle. Load cargo  
so that it rests evenly between  
the crossrails, making sure to  
fasten cargo securely.  
Roof Rack System  
WARNING  
{
If something is carried on top of  
the vehicle that is longer or wider  
than the roof racklike paneling,  
plywood, or a mattressthe wind  
can catch it while the vehicle is  
being driven. The item being  
carried could be violently torn off,  
and this could cause a collision,  
and damage the vehicle. Never  
carry something longer or wider  
than the roof rack on top of the  
vehicle unless using a GM  
To prevent damage or loss of cargo  
when driving, check to make sure  
cross rails and cargo are securely  
fastened. Loading cargo on the roof  
rack will make the vehicle's center  
of gravity higher. Avoid high speeds,  
sudden starts, sharp turns, sudden  
braking or abrupt maneuvers,  
otherwise it may result in loss of  
control. If driving for a long distance,  
on rough roads, or at high speeds,  
occasionally stop the vehicle to  
make sure the cargo remains in its  
place. Do not exceed the maximum  
vehicle capacity when loading the  
vehicle. For more information on  
vehicle capacity and loading, see  
Vehicle Load Limits on page 824.  
The roof rack crossrails can be  
locked in four positions along the  
roof rack side rails.  
Certified accessory carrier.  
This vehicle may be equipped with  
a roof rack. For roof racks that do  
not have cross rails included,  
GM Certified cross rails can be  
purchased as an accessory. See  
your dealer for additional  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storage  
3-3  
Try sliding the crossrails forward  
and backward to ensure that they  
are correctly secured and that the  
levers stay tight to the cross rails.  
Do not stand on the plastic lower  
body panels when loading cargo  
on the luggage carrier.  
When the roof rack is not in use,  
lock one crossrail at the furthest  
forward position and lock the other  
crossrail at the furthest rearward  
position to reduce wind noise.  
Lift the lever to release and move  
the crossrail.  
Push the lever down to completely  
engage into the side rail holes.  
Position the crossrail on both sides  
of the vehicle at the same time.  
Slide the crossrails back and forth  
until the lock pins engage in the  
holes and a click is heard as the  
pins align and the crossrail locks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3-4  
Storage  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-1  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Instruments and  
Controls  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Traction Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
StabiliTrak® OFF Light . . . . . . . 4-20  
Traction Control System  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Engine Coolant Temperature  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . 4-14  
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . 4-15  
Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Charging System Light . . . . . . 4-16  
Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Brake System Warning  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light . . . . 4-21  
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Engine Oil Pressure Light . . . . 4-22  
Fuel Economy Light . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . 4-22  
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
High-Beam on Light . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Lamps on Reminder . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Instrument Panel Overview  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . 4-4  
Controls  
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . 4-6  
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . 4-6  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . 4-7  
Rear Window Wiper/  
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Clock (With Date Display) . . . . . 4-9  
Clock (Without Date  
Display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Information Displays  
Driver Information  
Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-2  
Instruments and Controls  
Object Detection System  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Ride Control System  
Vehicle Messages  
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Battery Voltage and Charging  
Vehicle Personalization  
Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . 4-34  
OnStar® System  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Airbag System Messages . . . . 4-32  
Safety Belt Messages . . . . . . . 4-32  
Anti-Theft Alarm System  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Service Vehicle Messages . . . 4-32  
Tire Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Transmission Messages . . . . . 4-33  
Vehicle Reminder  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Brake System Messages . . . . 4-28  
Compass Messages . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Cruise Control Messages . . . . 4-28  
Door Ajar Messages . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Engine Cooling System  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Engine Oil Messages . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Engine Power Messages . . . . 4-30  
Fuel System Messages . . . . . . 4-30  
Key and Lock Messages . . . . . 4-31  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-3  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-4  
Instruments and Controls  
Instrument Panel Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-5  
A. Air Vents on page 76.  
H. AM-FM Radio on page 611  
Navigation System (If  
.
P. Shift Lever. See Shifting Into  
Park on page 832.  
B. Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
on page 53. Exterior Lamp  
Controls on page 51. Fog  
Lamps on page 53 (If  
Equipped).  
Equipped). See Navigation  
System Manual.  
Q. Fuel Economy Mode on  
page 837 (If Equipped).  
I. Cruise Control on page 844  
J. Instrument Panel Illumination  
.
R. StabiliTrak System on  
page 843  
.
C. Instrument Cluster on  
Control on page 54  
K. Steering Wheel Adjustment on  
page 46  
.
S. Cupholders on page 31.  
T. Power Outlets on page 410.  
U. CD Player on page 619.  
page 412  
.
D. Windshield Wiper/Washer on  
page 47. Rear Window  
.
L. Horn on page 47.  
Wiper/Washer on page 48.  
V. Driver Information Center  
Buttons. See Driver Information  
Center (DIC) on page 424.  
M. Steering Wheel Controls on  
E. Power Door Locks on  
page 46  
.
page 17  
F. Instrument Panel Storage on  
page 31  
G. Safety Locks on page 17.  
.
N. Ignition Positions on page 828.  
W. Hazard Warning Flashers on  
O. Climate Control Systems on  
page 71 or Automatic Climate  
Control System on page 73.  
page 52  
.
.
X. Glove Box on page 31.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-6  
Instruments and Controls  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the  
steering wheel in place.  
OnStar® System on page 643,  
Bluetooth (Overview) on page 642  
or Bluetooth (Infotainment Controls)  
on page 643 or Bluetooth (Voice  
Recognition) on page 646 or  
Bluetooth (Navigation) on  
page 658, or the separate  
navigation manual for more  
information.  
Controls  
Do not adjust the steering wheel  
while driving.  
Steering Wheel  
Adjustment  
Steering Wheel Controls  
$ / c (Mute/End Call): Press to  
silence the vehicle speakers only.  
Press again to turn the sound on.  
For vehicles with OnStar or  
Bluetooth systems, press to reject  
an incoming call, or end a  
current call.  
_ SRC ^ (Toggle Switch): Press to  
select an audio source.  
The adjustment lever is located on  
the left side of the steering column.  
Toggle up or down to select the next  
or previous favorite radio station or  
CD track, DVD, if equipped, track,  
or MP3 track.  
For vehicles with audio steering  
wheel controls, some audio controls  
can be adjusted at the steering  
wheel.  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or  
down and in or out to a  
+ x (Volume): Press + to  
increase the volume, press to  
decrease the volume.  
b / g (Push to Talk): For vehicles  
with an OnStar®, Bluetooth®,  
or navigation system, press to  
interact with those systems. See  
comfortable position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-7  
Move the lever to one of the  
following positions:  
Windshield Washer  
Horn  
Pull the lever toward you to spray  
washer fluid on the windshield. The  
spray continues until the lever is  
released. The wipers will run a  
few times. See Washer Fluid on  
page 921 for information on filling  
the windshield washer fluid  
reservoir.  
Press near the horn symbols or  
press on the steering wheel pad to  
sound the horn.  
8 (Mist): Single wipe, move the  
lever to z and then release. The  
wipers stop after one wipe.  
Windshield Wiper/Washer  
( (Off): Turns the wipers off.  
& (Adjustable Interval Wipes):  
The time between wipes can be  
adjusted. Turn the & band up for  
more frequent wipes or down for  
less frequent wipes.  
WARNING  
{
In freezing weather, do not use  
your washer until the windshield  
is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the  
1 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
2 (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
Clear snow and ice from the wiper  
blades before using them. If frozen  
to the windshield, carefully loosen or  
thaw them. Damaged wiper blades  
should be replaced. See Wiper  
windshield, blocking your vision.  
The windshield wiper/washer lever  
is located on the right side of the  
steering column.  
Blade Replacement on page 926.  
Heavy snow or ice can overload the  
wiper motor. A circuit breaker will  
stop the motor until it cools down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-8  
Instruments and Controls  
from Global Positioning System  
(GPS) antenna, StabiliTrak, and  
vehicle speed information.  
Rear Window Wiper/  
Washer  
The rear wiper controls are on the  
end of the windshield wiper lever.  
5 (Rear Wiper Delay): Sets a  
delay between wipes.  
= (Rear Washer): Push the  
windshield wiper lever forward to  
spray washer fluid on the rear  
window. The lever returns to its  
starting position when released.  
Avoid covering the GPS antenna for  
long periods of time with objects  
that may interfere with the antenna's  
ability to receive a satellite signal.  
See Multi-Band Antenna on  
page 618 for the location of the  
vehicle's antennas. The compass  
system is designed to operate for a  
certain number of miles or degrees  
of turn before needing a signal from  
the GPS satellites. When the  
The windshield washer reservoir is  
used for the windshield and the rear  
window. Check the fluid level in the  
reservoir if either washer is not  
working. See Washer Fluid on  
page 921  
.
compass display shows CAL, drive  
the vehicle for a short distance in an  
open area where it can receive a  
GPS signal. The compass system  
will automatically determine when  
GPS signal is restored and provide  
a heading again. See Compass  
Messages on page 428 for more  
information on the messages that  
may be displayed for the compass.  
WARNING  
{
In freezing weather, do not use  
your washer until the windshield  
is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the  
Press the upper or lower portion of  
the button to control the rear wiper  
and rear wiper delay.  
windshield, blocking your vision.  
The system turns off when the  
button is returned to the middle  
position.  
Compass  
The vehicle may have a compass  
display on the Driver Information  
Center (DIC). The compass receives  
its heading and other information  
Z (Rear Wiper): For continuous  
rear window wipes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-9  
6. To save the time or date and  
return to the Time and Date  
3. Highlight Month & Day Format.  
Clock (With Date Display)  
4. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select MM/DD (month/day) or  
DD/MM (day/month).  
The infotainment system controls,  
located on the instrument panel, are  
used to access the time and date  
settings through the menu system.  
See Operation on page 67 for  
information about how to use the  
menu system.  
Settings menu, press the 0  
BACK button at any time or  
press the MENU/SEL knob after  
adjusting the minutes or year.  
Setting the Auto Time Adjust  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
Setting the 12/24 Hour Format  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time and Date Settings.  
Setting the Time and Date  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time and Date Settings.  
3. Highlight Auto Time Adjust.  
4. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
turn Auto Time Adjust on or off.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time and Date Settings.  
3. Highlight 12/24 Hour Format.  
4. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select the 12 hour or 24 hour  
display format.  
5. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select Time Zone, and then  
select the Time Zone.  
3. Select Set Time or Set Date.  
4. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
adjust the highlighted value.  
Setting the Month & Day  
Format  
6. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
turn Daylight Savings on or off.  
5. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select the next value.  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time and Date Settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-10  
Instruments and Controls  
6. To save the time and return to  
the Time Settings menu, press  
console storage, on the rear of the  
center console storage, and in the  
rear cargo compartment.  
Clock (Without Date  
Display)  
the 0 BACK button at any time  
or press the SELECT button  
after adjusting the minutes.  
The infotainment system controls,  
located on the instrument panel, are  
used to access the time and date  
settings through the menu system.  
See Operation on page 67 for  
information about how to use the  
menu system.  
To use the outlets, remove the  
cover. Close the outlet cover, when  
not in use.  
Setting the 12/24 Hour Format  
Notice: If electrical devices are  
left plugged into a power outlet,  
the battery may drain causing the  
vehicle not to start or damage to  
the battery. This would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always unplug all electrical  
devices when turning off the  
vehicle.  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time Settings, or press  
Setting the Time  
the H button.  
1. Turn the infotainment  
system ON.  
3. Highlight 12/24 Hour Format.  
2. Press the CONFIG button and  
select Time Settings, or press  
4. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select the 12 hour or 24 hour  
display format.  
Certain electrical accessories  
may not be compatible with the  
accessory power outlets and could  
result in blown vehicle or adapter  
fuses. If you experience a problem,  
see your dealer for additional  
information on the accessory power  
outlet.  
the H button.  
3. Select Set Time.  
Power Outlets  
4. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
adjust the highlighted value.  
The accessory power outlets can  
be used to connect electrical  
equipment, such as a cellular  
phone.  
5. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
select the next value.  
There are four accessory power  
outlets in the following locations,  
below the CD slot, inside the center  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-11  
Notice: Adding any electrical  
equipment to the vehicle can  
damage it or keep other  
components from working as  
they should. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Do not use equipment  
exceeding maximum amperage  
rating of 20 amperes. Check with  
your dealer before adding  
Gauges can indicate when there  
could be a problem with a vehicle  
function. Often gauges and warning  
lights work together to indicate a  
problem with the vehicle.  
Warning Lights,  
Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Warning lights and gauges can  
signal that something is wrong  
before it becomes serious enough  
to cause an expensive repair or  
replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gauges could  
prevent injury.  
When one of the warning lights  
comes on and stays on while  
driving, or when one of the gauges  
shows there may be a problem,  
check the section that explains what  
to do. Follow this manual's advice.  
Waiting to do repairs can be costly  
and even dangerous.  
electrical equipment.  
When adding electrical equipment,  
be sure to follow the installation  
instructions included with the  
equipment.  
Warning lights come on when there  
could be a problem with a vehicle  
function. Some warning lights come  
on briefly when the engine is started  
to indicate they are working.  
Notice: Improper use of the  
power outlet can cause damage  
not covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Do not hang any type of  
accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the power  
outlets are designed for  
accessory power plugs only.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-12  
Instruments and Controls  
Instrument Cluster  
US Version Shown, Canada Similar  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-13  
Here are some situations that can  
occur with the fuel gauge. None of  
these indicate a problem with the  
fuel gauge.  
Speedometer  
Tachometer  
The tachometer displays the engine  
speed in revolutions per  
minute (rpm).  
The vehicle's speed can be selected  
to display on the Driver Information  
Center (DIC) and the speedometer  
in either kilometers per hour (km/h)  
or miles per hour (mph). Telltales on  
the speedometer indicate whether  
kilometers or miles were chosen.  
The DIC will show the vehicles  
speed after the limit on the  
.
At the service station, the fuel  
pump shuts off before the gauge  
reads full.  
Fuel Gauge  
.
It takes a little more or less  
fuel to fill up than the gauge  
indicated. For example, the  
gauge may have indicated the  
tank was half full, but it actually  
took a little more or less than  
half the tank's capacity to fill  
the tank.  
speedometer has been reached.  
Odometer  
The odometer shows how far the  
vehicle has been driven, in either  
kilometers or miles.  
United States  
Canada  
When the ignition is on, the fuel  
gauge shows about how much fuel  
the vehicle has left in the fuel tank.  
.
The gauge moves a little while  
turning a corner or speeding up.  
This vehicle has a tamper-resistant  
odometer. If the vehicle needs a  
new odometer installed, the new  
one is set to the mileage of the old  
odometer. If this is not possible, it is  
set at zero and a label is put on the  
driver's door to show the old  
An arrow on the fuel gauge  
indicates the side of the vehicle the  
fuel door is on.  
.
The gauge takes a few seconds  
to stabilize after the ignition is  
turned on, and goes back to  
empty when the ignition is  
turned off.  
The gauge will first indicate empty  
before the vehicle is out of fuel and  
the low fuel light comes on, but the  
vehicle's fuel tank should be  
filled soon.  
mileage reading.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-14  
Instruments and Controls  
Passenger Safety Belt  
Reminder Light  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature Gauge  
Safety Belt Reminders  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder  
Light  
The passenger safety belt reminder  
light is by the passenger airbag  
status indicator.  
There is a driver safety belt  
reminder light on the instrument  
panel cluster.  
United States  
Canada  
This gauge measures the  
temperature of the vehicle's engine.  
When the engine is started this light  
and the chime come on and stay on  
for several seconds to remind the  
passenger to fasten their safety belt.  
The light also begins to flash.  
If the indicator needle moves to the  
hot side of the gauge towards the  
colored line, the engine is too hot.  
A temperature indicator light will  
turn on.  
When the engine is started this light  
and a chime come on and stay on  
for several seconds to remind  
drivers to fasten their safety belts.  
The light also begins to flash.  
This cycle repeats if the passenger  
remains unbuckled and the vehicle  
is moving.  
If the vehicle has been operated  
under normal driving conditions, and  
the temperature indicator light  
comes on, pull off the road, stop the  
vehicle and turn off the engine as  
soon as possible.  
This cycle repeats if the driver  
remains unbuckled and the vehicle  
is moving.  
If the passenger safety belt is  
buckled, neither the chime nor the  
light comes on.  
If the driver safety belt is already  
buckled, neither the light nor chime  
come on.  
The front passenger safety belt  
warning light and chime may turn on  
if an object is put on the seat such  
as a briefcase, handbag, grocery  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-15  
bag, laptop or other electronic  
device. To turn off the warning light  
and or chime, remove the object  
from the seat or buckle the  
safety belt.  
WARNING  
{
If the airbag readiness light stays  
on after the vehicle is started or  
comes on while driving, it means  
the airbag system might not be  
working properly. The airbags in  
the vehicle might not inflate in a  
crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid  
injury, have the vehicle serviced  
right away.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
United States  
This light shows if there is an  
electrical problem. The system  
check includes the airbag sensor,  
the pretensioners, the airbag  
modules, the wiring and the crash  
sensing and diagnostic module. For  
more information on the airbag  
system, see Airbag System on  
Canada  
Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator  
When the vehicle is started, the  
passenger airbag status indicator  
will light ON and OFF, or the symbol  
for on and off, for several seconds  
as a system check. If you are using  
remote start to start the vehicle from  
a distance, if equipped, you may not  
see the system check. Then, after  
several more seconds, the status  
indicator will light either ON or OFF,  
or either the on or off symbol to let  
you know the status of the right front  
passenger frontal airbag.  
page 222  
.
The vehicle has a passenger  
sensing system. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 230 for  
important safety information. The  
overhead console has a passenger  
airbag status indicator.  
The airbag readiness light comes on  
and stays on for several seconds  
when the vehicle is started. Then  
the light turns off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-16  
Instruments and Controls  
If the word ON or the on symbol is  
lit on the passenger airbag status  
indicator, it means that the right  
front passenger frontal airbag is  
enabled (may inflate).  
system. Have it checked by your  
dealer. Driving while this light is on  
could drain the battery.  
WARNING (Continued)  
away. See Airbag Readiness  
Light on page 415 for more  
information, including important  
safety information.  
When this light comes on, the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) also  
displays a message.  
If the word OFF or the off symbol is  
lit on the passenger airbag status  
indicator, it means that the  
passenger sensing system has  
turned off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag.  
See Battery Voltage and Charging  
Messages on page 428.  
Charging System Light  
This light and a Transport Mode On  
message display when the vehicle  
is in Transport Mode. For more  
information, see Key and Lock  
Messages on page 431.  
If, after several seconds, both status  
indicator lights remain on, or if there  
are no lights at all, there may be a  
problem with the lights or the  
passenger sensing system. See  
your dealer for service.  
If a short distance must be driven  
with the light on, be sure to turn off  
all accessories, such as the radio  
and air conditioner.  
The charging system light comes on  
briefly when the ignition is turned  
on, but the engine is not running, as  
a check to show the light is working.  
The light turns off when the engine  
is started. If it does not, have the  
vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
WARNING  
{
Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp  
A computer system called OBD II  
(On-Board Diagnostics-Second  
Generation) monitors operation of  
the fuel, ignition, and emission  
control systems. It ensures that  
If the airbag readiness light ever  
comes on and stays on, it means  
that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help  
avoid injury to yourself or others,  
have the vehicle serviced right  
If the light stays on, or comes on  
while driving, there may be a  
problem with the electrical charging  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-17  
emissions are at acceptable levels  
for the life of the vehicle, helping to  
produce a cleaner environment.  
Notice: If the vehicle is  
This light comes on during a  
malfunction in one of two ways:  
continually driven with this light  
on, after a while, the emission  
controls might not work as well,  
the vehicle's fuel economy might  
not be as good, and the engine  
might not run as smoothly. This  
could lead to costly repairs that  
might not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition  
has been detected. A misfire  
increases vehicle emissions and  
could damage the emission control  
system on the vehicle. Diagnosis  
and service might be required.  
The following can prevent more  
serious damage to the vehicle:  
This light comes on when the  
ignition is on, but the engine is not  
running, as a check to show it is  
working. If it does not, have the  
vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
Notice: Modifications made to the  
engine, transmission, exhaust,  
intake, or fuel system of the  
vehicle or the replacement of the  
original tires with other than  
those of the same Tire  
Performance Criteria (TPC) can  
affect the vehicle's emission  
controls and can cause this light  
to come on. Modifications to  
these systems could lead to  
costly repairs not covered by the  
vehicle warranty. This could also  
result in a failure to pass a  
.
Reduce vehicle speed.  
.
Avoid hard accelerations.  
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
.
If the check engine light comes on  
and stays on, while the engine is  
running, this indicates that there is  
an OBD II problem and service is  
required.  
If towing a trailer, reduce the  
amount of cargo being hauled as  
soon as it is possible.  
If the light continues to flash, when  
it is safe to do so, stop the vehicle.  
Find a safe place to park the  
vehicle. Turn the key off, wait at  
least 10 seconds, and restart the  
engine. If the light is still flashing,  
follow the previous steps and see  
your dealer for service as soon as  
possible.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by  
the system before any problem is  
apparent. Being aware of the light  
can prevent more serious damage  
to the vehicle. This system assists  
the service technician in correctly  
diagnosing any malfunction.  
required Emission Inspection/  
Maintenance test. See  
Accessories and Modifications  
on page 94  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-18  
Instruments and Controls  
.
Make sure to fuel the vehicle  
with quality fuel. Poor fuel quality  
causes the engine not to run as  
efficiently as designed and may  
cause: stalling after start-up,  
stalling when the vehicle is  
changed into gear, misfiring,  
hesitation on acceleration,  
or stumbling on acceleration.  
These conditions might go away  
once the engine is warmed up.  
Light On Steady: An emission  
control system malfunction has  
been detected on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be  
required.  
Emissions Inspection and  
Maintenance Programs  
Some state/provincial and local  
governments have or might begin  
programs to inspect the emission  
control equipment on the vehicle.  
Failure to pass this inspection could  
prevent getting a vehicle  
An emission system malfunction  
might be corrected.  
.
Make sure the fuel cap is fully  
registration.  
installed. See Filling the Tank on  
page 856. The diagnostic  
system can determine if the  
fuel cap has been left off or  
improperly installed. A loose or  
missing fuel cap allows fuel to  
evaporate into the atmosphere.  
A few driving trips with the cap  
properly installed should turn the  
light off.  
Here are some things to know to  
help the vehicle pass an inspection:  
If one or more of these  
conditions occurs, change the  
fuel brand used. It will require at  
least one full tank of the proper  
fuel to turn the light off.  
.
The vehicle will not pass this  
inspection if the check engine  
light is on with the engine  
running, or if the key is in ON/  
RUN and the light is not on.  
See Recommended Fuel on  
page 854  
.
.
The vehicle will not pass this  
inspection if the OBD II  
.
If none of the above have made  
the light turn off, your dealer can  
check the vehicle. The dealer  
has the proper test equipment  
and diagnostic tools to fix any  
mechanical or electrical problems  
that might have developed.  
If the vehicle has been driven  
through a deep puddle of water,  
the vehicle's electrical system  
might be wet. The condition is  
usually corrected when the  
electrical system dries out. A  
few driving trips should turn the  
light off.  
(on-board diagnostic) system  
determines that critical emission  
control systems have not been  
completely diagnosed by the  
system. The vehicle would be  
considered not ready for  
inspection. This can happen if  
the battery has recently been  
replaced or if the battery has run  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-19  
down. The diagnostic system is  
designed to evaluate critical  
emission control systems during  
normal driving. This can take  
several days of routine driving.  
If this has been done and the  
vehicle still does not pass the  
inspection for lack of OBD II  
system readiness, your dealer  
can prepare the vehicle for  
inspection.  
WARNING  
{
The brake system might not be  
working properly if the brake  
system warning light is on.  
Driving with the brake system  
warning light on can lead to a  
crash. If the light is still on after  
the vehicle has been pulled off  
the road and carefully stopped,  
have the vehicle towed for  
service.  
United States  
Canada  
The brake indicator light should  
come on briefly as the engine is  
started. If it does not come on have  
the vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
Brake System Warning  
Light  
When the ignition is on, the brake  
system warning light comes on  
when the parking brake is set. The  
light stays on if the parking brake  
does not fully release. If it stays on  
after the parking brake is fully  
released, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected  
immediately.  
If the light comes on while driving, a  
chime sounds. Pull off the road and  
stop. The pedal might be harder to  
push or go closer to the floor.  
It might also take longer to stop.  
If the light is still on, have the  
The vehicle brake system consists  
of two hydraulic circuits. If one  
circuit is not working, the remaining  
circuit can still work to stop the  
vehicle. For normal braking  
performance, both circuits need to  
be working  
vehicle towed for service. See  
Towing the Vehicle on page 972.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-20  
Instruments and Controls  
not antilock brakes. If the regular  
brake system warning light is also  
on, the vehicle does not have  
antilock brakes and there is a  
problem with the regular brakes.  
See Brake System Warning Light  
See Traction Control System (TCS)  
on page 841 and StabiliTrak  
System on page 843 for more  
information.  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS) Warning Light  
StabiliTrak® OFF Light  
on page 419  
.
For vehicles with a Driver  
Information Center (DIC), see Driver  
Information Center (DIC) on  
page 424 for all brake related DIC  
messages.  
For vehicles with the Antilock Brake  
System (ABS), this light comes on  
briefly when the engine is started.  
If the light does not come on, have it  
fixed so it will be ready to warn if  
there is a problem.  
This light comes on when the  
StabiliTrak system is turned off.  
If the Traction Control System (TCS)  
is off, wheel spin is not limited. If the  
StabiliTrak system is off, the system  
does not assist in controlling the  
vehicle. Turn on the TCS and the  
StabiliTrak system and the warning  
light turns off.  
Traction Off Light  
If the ABS light stays on, turn the  
ignition off. If the light comes on  
while driving, stop as soon as it is  
safely possible and turn the ignition  
off. A chime may also sound when  
the light comes on steady. Then  
start the engine again to reset the  
system. If the ABS light stays on,  
or comes on again while driving, the  
vehicle needs service. If the regular  
brake system warning light is not  
on, the vehicle still has brakes, but  
This light comes on if the Traction  
Control System (TCS) either has a  
problem or is turned off. DIC  
messages appear in the DIC display  
to help explain. See Ride Control  
System Messages on page 431  
for more information.  
Check the DIC for applicable  
messages. See Ride Control  
System Messages on page 431  
for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-21  
See Traction Control System (TCS)  
on page 841 and StabiliTrak  
System on page 843 for more  
information.  
If the TCS warning light comes on  
and stays on while driving, the  
vehicle needs service.  
When the Light is On Steady  
This indicates that one or more of  
the tires are significantly  
underinflated.  
Check the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) for applicable messages. See  
Ride Control System Messages on  
page 431 for more information.  
A tire pressure message in the  
Driver Information Center (DIC), can  
accompany the light. See Tire  
Messages on page 433 for more  
information. Stop as soon as  
possible, and inflate the tires to the  
pressure value shown on the tire  
loading information label. See Tire  
Pressure on page 946 for more  
information.  
Traction Control System  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light  
See Traction Control System (TCS)  
on page 841 and StabiliTrak  
System on page 843 for more  
information.  
Tire Pressure Light  
The StabiliTrak® system or the  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
indicator/warning light comes on  
briefly while starting the engine.  
When the Light Flashes First and  
Then is On Steady  
This indicates that there may be a  
problem with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System. The light flashes  
for about a minute and stays on  
steady for the remainder of the  
ignition cycle. This sequence  
repeats with every ignition cycle.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor  
If it does not, have the vehicle  
serviced by your dealer. If the  
system is working normally the  
indicator light then goes off.  
For vehicles with a tire pressure  
monitoring system, this light comes  
on briefly when the engine is  
started. It provides information  
about tire pressures and the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System.  
The indicator/warning light flashes  
while the StabiliTrak or TCS system  
is working to control the vehicle on  
a low traction surface.  
Operation on page 949 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-22  
Instruments and Controls  
the center console near the shifter,  
is pressed. For vehicles with a  
Driver Information Center (DIC) an  
ECO Mode On message displays.  
See Fuel System Messages on  
page 430 for more information.  
Press the switch again to turn off  
the light and exit the fuel  
Engine Oil Pressure Light  
WARNING  
{
Do not keep driving if the oil  
pressure is low. The engine can  
become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check  
the oil as soon as possible and  
have the vehicle serviced.  
The oil pressure light should come  
on briefly as the engine is started.  
If it does not come on have the  
vehicle serviced by your dealer.  
saver mode.  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
If the light comes on and stays on, it  
means that oil is not flowing through  
the engine properly. The vehicle  
could be low on oil and might have  
some other system problem. See  
your dealer.  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil  
maintenance can damage the  
engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always follow the maintenance  
schedule in this manual for  
changing engine oil.  
Fuel Economy Light  
United States Shown, Canada  
Similar  
This light comes on for a few  
seconds when the ignition is turned  
on as a check to indicate it is  
working. If it does not come on,  
have it fixed.  
The low fuel warning light is a circle  
located on the fuel gauge. This light  
comes on and a chime sounds  
For vehicles with the fuel economy  
mode light, it comes on when the  
eco (economy) switch, located on  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-23  
periodically when the vehicle is low  
on fuel. The light goes off when fuel  
is added to the fuel tank.  
The light goes out when the fog  
lamps are turned off. See Fog  
Lamps on page 53 for more  
information.  
High-Beam on Light  
For vehicles with a Driver  
Information Center (DIC), see Fuel  
System Messages on page 430  
for more information.  
Lamps on Reminder  
The high-beam on light comes on  
when the high-beam headlamps are  
in use.  
Security Light  
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Changer on page 51 for more  
information.  
For vehicles with the lamps on  
reminder light, it comes on when the  
lights are in use.  
Fog Lamp Light  
This light comes on if there is a  
problem with the security system,  
or if the vehicle has been  
tampered with.  
For more information, see Vehicle  
Security on page 112.  
The fog lamp light comes on when  
the fog lamps are in use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-24  
Instruments and Controls  
It also shows the shift lever position,  
the odometer, and the direction the  
vehicle is driving.  
Cruise Control Light  
Information Displays  
Driver Information  
Center (DIC)  
DIC Buttons (with V shown, SET/  
CLR version similar)  
The vehicle may have a Driver  
Information Center (DIC). It displays  
information about the vehicle and  
warning messages if there is a  
system problem detected. DIC  
messages display in the center of  
the instrument panel cluster. See  
Vehicle Messages on page 427 for  
more information.  
The cruise control light is white  
whenever the cruise control is set  
and turns green when the cruise  
control is active.  
The light turns off when the cruise  
control is turned off. See Cruise  
Control on page 844 for more  
information.  
The vehicle may also have features  
that can be customized through the  
controls on the radio. See Vehicle  
Personalization on page 434 for  
more information.  
MENU: Press this button to get to  
the Trip/Fuel Menu and the Vehicle  
Information Menu.  
DIC Operation and Displays  
Use the DIC buttons located in the  
center of the instrument panel to  
access different displays. The DIC  
displays trip, fuel, vehicle system  
information, and warning messages.  
w x : Use these buttons to scroll  
through the items in each menu.  
A small marker will move along the  
page as you scroll through the  
items. This shows where each page  
is in the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-25  
Trip 1 and Trip 2  
economy can be reset by pressing  
V or SET/CLR while the Average  
Fuel Economy display is showing.  
The display may not reset to zero.  
V or SET/CLR (Set/Clear): Use  
this button to set or clear the menu  
item when it is displayed.  
This display shows the current  
distance traveled, in either  
kilometers (km) or miles (mi), since  
the last reset for the trip odometer.  
The trip odometer can be reset to  
zero by pressing the trip reset stem  
Trip/Fuel Menu Items  
Instantaneous Fuel Economy  
Press the MENU button until Trip/  
Fuel Information Menu is displayed.  
This display shows the current  
fuel economy in either liters per  
100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles  
per gallon (mpg). This number  
reflects only the fuel economy that  
the vehicle has right now and  
changes frequently as driving  
conditions change. Unlike average  
economy, this display cannot be  
reset.  
Then press x to scroll through the  
following menu items:  
or V or SET/CLR while the trip  
odometer display is showing.  
.
Trip 1  
Fuel Range  
.
Trip 2  
This display shows the approximate  
distance the vehicle can be driven  
without refueling. The fuel range  
estimate is based on an average  
of the vehicle's fuel economy over  
recent driving history and the  
.
Fuel Range  
.
Average Fuel Economy  
.
Instantaneous Fuel Economy  
Average Vehicle Speed  
.
Average Vehicle Speed  
amount of fuel remaining in the fuel  
tank. Fuel range cannot be reset.  
This display shows the average  
speed of the vehicle in kilometers  
per hour (km/h) or miles per  
.
Timer  
.
Digital Speedometer  
Average Fuel Economy  
hour (mph). This average is  
.
Navigation Turn-by-Turn  
This display shows the approximate  
average liters per 100 kilometers  
(L/100 km) or miles per gallon  
(mpg). This number is calculated  
based on the number of L/100 km  
(mpg) recorded since the last time  
this menu item was reset. The fuel  
calculated based on the various  
vehicle speeds recorded since the  
last reset of this value. The average  
.
Blank  
speed can be reset by pressing V  
or SET/CLR while the Average  
Vehicle Speed display is showing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-26  
Instruments and Controls  
Timer  
Turn-by-Turn  
Unit  
This display can be used as a timer.  
This display is used for the OnStar  
or Navigation System Turn-by-Turn  
guidance. See OnStar® System on  
page 439 or the Navigation  
manual, if the vehicle has  
navigation, for more information.  
Press V or SET/CLR to enter the  
To start the timer, press V or SET/  
CLR while Timer is displayed. The  
display will show the amount of time  
that has passed since the timer was  
last reset, not including time the  
ignition is off. Time will continue to  
be counted as long as the ignition is  
on, even if another display is being  
shown on the DIC. The timer will  
record up to 99 hours, 59 minutes  
and 59 seconds (99:59:59) after  
which the display will return to zero.  
unit menu. Then press w or x to  
switch between US or Metric when  
the Unit display is active. Press V  
or SET/CLR to confirm the setting.  
This will change the displays on the  
cluster and DIC to either metric or  
English (US) measurements.  
Blank Display  
This display shows no information.  
Tire Pressure  
Vehicle Information Menu  
Items  
The display will show a vehicle with  
the approximate pressures of all  
four tires. Tire pressure is displayed  
in either pounds per square  
Press the MENU button until Vehicle  
Information Menu is displayed. Then  
To stop the timer, press V or SET/  
CLR briefly while Timer is displayed.  
To reset the timer to zero, press and  
press x to scroll through the  
following menu items:  
inch (psi) or in kilopascal (kPa).  
Any time the tire pressures are  
adjusted the system needs to  
relearn the new pressures. To  
.
hold V or SET/CLR.  
Unit  
.
Tire Pressure  
Digital Speedometer  
.
.
relearn the tire pressures press V or  
SET/CLR while the Tire Pressure  
display is active. The display will  
ask for confirmation of a relearn.  
Remaining Oil Life  
Blank  
The speedometer shows how fast  
the vehicle is moving in either  
kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles  
per hour (mph). The speedometer  
cannot be reset.  
Press w or x to select Yes or No.  
Then press V or SET/CLR to  
confirm the selection. See Tire  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-27  
Pressure Monitor System on  
page 949 and Tire Pressure  
Monitor Operation on page 949 for  
more information.  
Remember, the Oil Life display must  
Vehicle Messages  
be reset after each oil change. It  
will not reset itself. Also, be careful  
not to reset the Oil Life display  
accidentally at any time other than  
when the oil has just been changed.  
It cannot be reset accurately until  
the next oil change. To reset the  
Messages are displayed on the DIC  
to notify the driver that the status of  
the vehicle has changed and that  
some action may be needed by the  
driver to correct the condition.  
Multiple messages may appear one  
after another.  
Remaining Oil Life  
This display shows an estimate of  
the oil's remaining useful life.  
If Remaining Oil Life 99%is  
displayed, that means 99% of the  
current oil life remains.  
engine oil life system, press V or  
SET/CLR while the Oil Life display  
is active. The display will ask for  
Some messages may not require  
immediate action, but you can press  
V or SET/CLR to acknowledge that  
you received the messages and to  
clear them from the display. Some  
messages cannot be cleared from  
the DIC display because they are  
more urgent. These messages  
require action before they can be  
cleared. You should take any  
When the remaining oil life is low,  
the Change Engine Oil Soon”  
message will appear on the display.  
See Engine Oil Messages on  
page 430. The oil should be  
changed as soon as possible. See  
Engine Oil on page 910. In  
addition to the engine oil life system  
monitoring the oil life, additional  
maintenance is recommended in the  
Maintenance Schedule in this  
manual. See Scheduled  
confirmation of a reset. Press w or  
x to select Yes or No. Then press  
V or SET/CLR to confirm the  
selection. See Engine Oil Life  
System on page 911  
.
Blank Display  
This display shows no information.  
messages that appear on the  
Compass  
display seriously and remember that  
clearing the messages will only  
make the messages disappear, not  
correct the problem. You will find the  
possible messages that can be  
displayed and some information  
about them grouped by subject in  
the following information.  
The vehicle may have a compass in  
the Driver Information Center (DIC).  
See Compass on page 48.  
Maintenance on page 102 for  
more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-28  
Instruments and Controls  
Service Battery Charging  
System  
Battery Voltage and  
Charging Messages  
Compass Messages  
CAL  
This message is displayed when  
there is a fault in the battery  
charging system. Take the vehicle to  
your dealer for service.  
Battery Saver Active  
This message is displayed when the  
compass needs to be calibrated.  
See Compass on page 48.  
This message displays when the  
vehicle has detected that the battery  
voltage is dropping beyond a  
reasonable point. The battery saver  
system starts reducing certain  
features of the vehicle that you may  
be able to notice. At the point that  
features are disabled, this message  
is displayed. It means that the  
vehicle is trying to save the charge  
in the battery. Turn off unnecessary  
accessories to allow the battery to  
recharge.  
– – –  
Brake System Messages  
Three dashes will be displayed if the  
compass needs service. See your  
dealer for service.  
Brake Fluid Low  
This message is displayed when the  
brake fluid level is low, see Brake  
Fluid on page 922.  
Cruise Control Messages  
Apply Brake Before Cruise  
Release Parking Brake  
If this message displays when  
attempting to activate cruise control,  
apply the brake and then try again.  
This message is displayed as a  
reminder that the parking brake is  
on. Release it before you attempt to  
drive.  
Low Battery  
Cruise Set to XXX  
This message is displayed when the  
battery voltage is low. See Battery  
on page 924 for more information.  
This message will display when the  
cruise control is set and it will show  
the speed it was set to. See Cruise  
Control on page 844 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-29  
Rear Access Open  
Coolant Level Low Add  
Coolant  
Door Ajar Messages  
This message will display along with  
a symbol when the liftgate is open.  
Close the liftgate completely.  
Door Open  
This message will display if the  
coolant is low, see Engine Coolant  
on page 915  
A door open symbol will be  
displayed on the DIC showing  
which door is open. If the vehicle  
has been shifted out of P (Park), a  
Door Openmessage will also be  
displayed. Close the door  
completely.  
.
Engine Cooling System  
Messages  
Engine Overheated Idle  
Engine  
A/C Off Due to High  
Engine Temp  
This message displays when the  
engine coolant temperature is too  
hot. Stop and allow the vehicle to  
idle until it cools down.  
Hood Open  
This message displays when the  
engine coolant becomes hotter than  
the normal operating temperature.  
To avoid added strain on a hot  
engine, the air conditioning  
compressor automatically turns off.  
When the coolant temperature  
returns to normal, the air  
This message will display along with  
a hood open symbol when the hood  
is open. Close the hood completely.  
Engine Overheated Stop  
Engine  
This message displays and a  
Manually Close the Power  
Liftgate  
continuous chime sounds if the  
engine cooling system reaches  
unsafe temperatures for operation.  
Stop and turn off the vehicle as  
soon as it is safe to do so to avoid  
severe damage. This message  
clears when the engine has cooled  
to a safe operating temperature.  
This message will display if the  
power liftgate encounters multiple  
obstacles on the same power cycle.  
After removing the obstructions, the  
liftgate will resume normal power  
operation.  
conditioning compressor turns back  
on. You can continue to drive the  
vehicle.  
If this message continues to appear,  
have the system repaired by your  
dealer as soon as possible to avoid  
damage to the engine.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-30  
Instruments and Controls  
next time the vehicle is driven. The  
vehicle may be driven at a reduced  
speed while this message is on, but  
maximum acceleration and speed  
may be reduced. Anytime this  
message stays on, the vehicle  
should be taken to your dealer for  
service as soon as possible.  
High Coolant Temperature  
Engine Oil Low Add Oil  
This message displays if the coolant  
temperature is hot, see Engine  
Overheating on page 918.  
This message displays when the  
engine oil level is too low. Check the  
oil level. See Engine Oil on  
page 910  
.
Engine Oil Messages  
Oil Pressure Low Stop  
Engine  
Change Engine Oil Soon  
This message displays if low oil  
pressure levels occur. Stop the  
vehicle as soon as safely possible  
and do not operate it until the cause  
of the low oil pressure has been  
corrected. Check the oil as soon as  
possible and have your vehicle  
serviced by your dealer.  
This message displays when the  
engine oil needs to be changed.  
When you change the engine oil, be  
sure to reset the Oil Life System.  
See Engine Oil Life System on  
page 911 and Driver Information  
Center (DIC) on page 424 for  
information on how to reset the  
system. See Engine Oil on  
Fuel System Messages  
ECO Mode On  
On some models, this message  
displays when the fuel economy  
mode has been turned on by  
pressing the eco button near the  
shift lever. See Fuel Economy Mode  
on page 837 for more information.  
page 910 and Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 102 for  
more information.  
Engine Power Messages  
Fuel Level Low  
Engine Power Is Reduced  
This message displays when the  
vehicle is low on fuel. Refuel as  
soon as possible.  
This message displays when the  
vehicle's engine power is reduced.  
Reduced engine power can affect  
the vehicle's ability to accelerate.  
If this message is on, but there  
is no reduction in performance,  
proceed to your destination. The  
performance may be reduced the  
Engine Oil Hot, Idle Engine  
This message displays when the  
engine oil temperature is too hot.  
Stop and allow the vehicle to idle  
until it cools down.  
Tighten Gas Cap  
This message displays when the  
fuel cap is not on tight. Tighten the  
fuel cap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
Service All Wheel Drive  
4-31  
Service Park Assist  
Key and Lock Messages  
This message is displayed if there is  
a problem with the park assist  
system. Take the vehicle to your  
dealer for service.  
If your vehicle has the All-Wheel  
Drive (AWD) system, this message  
displays if a problem occurs with  
this system. If this message  
appears, stop as soon as possible  
and turn off the vehicle. Restart the  
vehicle and check for the message  
on the DIC display. If the message  
is still displayed or appears again  
when you begin driving, the AWD  
system needs service. See your  
dealer.  
Replace Battery In Remote Key  
This message displays when the  
battery in the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter needs to be  
replaced.  
Ride Control System  
Messages  
Transport Mode On  
This message displays when the  
ignition is held in START for  
15 seconds. The battery light may  
also be flashing when this message  
is displayed. To turn this message  
off, start the vehicle and hold the  
key in the START position for  
15 seconds.  
All Wheel Drive Off  
If your vehicle has the All-Wheel  
Drive (AWD) system, this message  
displays when the rear drive system  
is overheating. This message turns  
off when the rear drive system cools  
down. If the warning message stays  
on for a while, you need to reset the  
warning message. To reset the  
warning message, turn the ignition  
off and then back on again. If the  
message stays on, see your dealer  
right away. See All-Wheel Drive on  
page 838 for more information.  
Service Traction Control  
This message displays when there  
is a problem with the Traction  
Control System (TCS). When this  
message is displayed, the system  
will not limit wheel spin. Adjust your  
driving accordingly. See your dealer  
for service.  
Object Detection System  
Messages  
Park Assist Off  
This message is displayed when the  
park assist system has been turned  
off. See Ultrasonic Parking Assist  
on page 846  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-32  
Instruments and Controls  
Service Stabilitrak  
Traction Control On  
Anti-Theft Alarm System  
Messages  
This message displays if there is a  
This message displays when the  
Traction Control System (TCS) is  
first turned on. See Traction Control  
System (TCS) on page 841 for  
more information.  
problem with the StabiliTrak®  
Theft Attempted  
system. If this message appears, try  
to reset the system. Stop; turn off  
the engine for at least 15 seconds;  
then start the engine again. If this  
message still comes on, it means  
there is a problem. See your dealer  
for service. The vehicle is safe to  
drive, however, you do not have the  
benefit of StabiliTrak, so reduce  
your speed and drive accordingly.  
This message displays if the vehicle  
detects a tamper condition.  
Airbag System Messages  
Service Vehicle Messages  
Service Airbag  
Service AC System  
This message is displayed if there is  
a problem with the airbag system.  
Take the vehicle to your dealer for  
service.  
This message is displayed if there is  
a problem with the air conditioning  
system. Take the vehicle to your  
dealer for service.  
Stabilitrak Off  
This message displays when the  
StabiliTrak system is turned off. See  
StabiliTrak System on page 843  
for more information.  
Service Power Steering  
Safety Belt Messages  
This message is displayed if there is  
a problem with the power steering  
system. Take the vehicle to your  
dealer for service.  
Buckle Seatbelt  
This message displays as a  
reminder when the safety belt  
is not buckled.  
Traction Control Off  
This message displays when the  
Traction Control System (TCS) is  
turned off. Adjust your driving  
accordingly.  
Service Vehicle Soon  
This message is displayed if there is  
a problem with the vehicle. Take the  
vehicle to your dealer for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-33  
The low tire pressure warning light  
will also come on. See Tire  
Tire Messages  
Transmission Messages  
Service Tire Monitor System  
Service Transmission  
Pressure Light on page 421.  
This message displays if there is a  
problem with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS). See Tire  
Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 949 for more information.  
This message displays if there is a  
problem with the transmission. See  
your dealer.  
If a tire pressure message appears  
on the DIC, stop as soon as you  
can. Inflate the tires by adding air  
until the tire pressure is equal to the  
values shown on the Tire Loading  
Information label. See Tires on  
page 940, Vehicle Load Limits on  
page 824, and Tire Pressure on  
Shift To Park  
This message displays when the  
transmission needs to be shifted to  
P (Park). This may appear when  
attempting to remove the key from  
the ignition if the vehicle is not in  
P (Park).  
Tire Learning Active  
This message displays when the  
system is learning new tires. See  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 949 for more information.  
page 946  
.
You can receive more than one tire  
pressure message at a time. To  
read the other messages that may  
have been sent at the same time,  
press the set/reset button. The DIC  
also shows the tire pressure values.  
See Driver Information Center (DIC)  
Tire Low Add Air To Tire  
Transmission Hot Idle  
Engine  
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS), this  
message displays when the  
pressure in one or more of the  
vehicle's tires is low.  
This message displays and a chime  
sounds if the transmission fluid in  
the vehicle gets hot. Driving with the  
transmission fluid temperature high  
can cause damage to the vehicle.  
Stop the vehicle and let it idle to  
allow the transmission to cool. This  
message clears when the fluid  
on page 424  
.
This message also displays Left  
Front, Right Front, Left Rear,  
or Right Rearto indicate the  
location of the low tire.  
temperature reaches a safe level.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-34  
Instruments and Controls  
3. Press the center of the  
MENU / SELECT knob to select  
the Vehicle Settings menu.  
Vehicle Reminder  
Messages  
Vehicle  
Personalization  
The audio system controls are used  
to access the personalization  
menus for customizing vehicle  
features.  
Ice Possible Drive With Care  
The following list of menu items will  
be available:  
This message is displayed when ice  
conditions are possible.  
.
Climate and Air Quality  
.
Comfort and Convenience  
Turn Wiper Control to  
Intermittent First  
CONFIG (Configuration): Press to  
access the Configuration  
Settings Menu.  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Collision/Detection Systems  
Languages  
This message is displayed when  
attempting to adjust the intermittent  
wiper speed without intermittent  
selected on the wiper control. See  
Windshield Wiper/Washer on  
MENU / SELECT Knob: Press the  
center of this knob to enter the  
menus and select menu items. Turn  
the knob to scroll through the  
menus.  
Lighting  
Power Door Locks  
Remote Lock/Unlock/Start  
Return to Factory Settings  
page 47  
.
0 BACK: Press to exit or move  
backwards in a menu.  
Turn the MENU / SELECT knob to  
highlight the menu. Press the knob  
to select it. Each of the menus is  
detailed in the following information.  
All of the menus may not be  
available. Only those tied to the  
features on your vehicle will be  
shown.  
Entering the Personalization  
Menus  
1. Turn the infotainment system on  
and press the CONFIG button to  
access the Configuration  
Settings menu.  
2. Turn the MENU / SELECT knob  
to highlight Vehicle Settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-35  
Air Conditioning Mode  
Remote Start Auto Heat Seats  
Climate and Air Quality  
This will allow you to select whether  
or not the air conditioning comes on  
automatically the next time the  
vehicle is started. Onmeans that  
the air conditioning will be on at  
start up, regardless of whether it  
was on or off the last time the  
vehicle was turned off. Offmeans  
the air conditioning will be off at the  
next start up, regardless of whether  
it was on or off the last time the  
vehicle was turned off. Last  
Settingmeans that the when the  
vehicle is started the air conditioning  
will resume whichever setting it was  
at the last time the vehicle was  
turned off.  
When on, this feature will turn the  
heated seats on when using remote  
start on cold days.  
Select the Climate and Air Quality  
menu and the following will be  
displayed:  
.
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Remote Start Auto Heat  
Seatsis highlighted to toggle  
Auto Fan Speed  
.
Air Conditioning Mode  
.
Remote Start Auto Heat Seats  
between Onor Off. Press 0  
BACK to confirm the selection and  
go back to the last menu.  
Auto Fan Speed  
This selection is available on  
vehicles with the Automatic Climate  
Control System. Choose from the  
following blower speed settings:  
Comfort and Convenience  
Select the Comfort and  
Convenience menu and the  
following will be displayed:  
High: Increased speed.  
Low: Reduced speed.  
Normal: Moderate speed.  
.
Easy Exit Driver Seat  
.
Chime Volume  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Air Conditioning Modeis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to  
highlight On, Off, or Last  
Setting. Press the knob to confirm  
your selection and go back to the  
last menu.  
.
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Auto Fan Speedis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to  
highlight High, Normal, or Low.  
Press the knob to confirm the  
selection and go back to the  
last menu.  
Reverse Tilt Mirror  
Easy Exit Driver Seat  
This allows you to turn the easy exit  
seat feature on or off.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Easy Exit Driver Seatis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-36  
Instruments and Controls  
Onor Off. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Turn the MENU / SELECT knob to  
select the language. Press the knob  
to confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Collision/Detection Systems  
Select the Collision/Detection  
Systems menu and the following  
will be displayed:  
Chime Volume  
Lighting  
.
Park Assist  
This allows the selection of the  
chime volume level.  
Select the Lighting menu and the  
following will be displayed:  
Park Assist  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Chime Volumeis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
Normalor High. Press the knob  
to confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
This allows the Ultrasonic Parking  
Assist feature to be turned on or off.  
.
Vehicle Locator Lights  
.
Exit Lighting  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Park Assistis highlighted.  
Turn the knob to select On, Off,  
or Tow Bar. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Vehicle Locator Lights  
This allows the vehicle locator lights  
to be turned on or off.  
Reverse Tilt Mirror  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Vehicle Locator Lightsis  
highlighted to toggle between On”  
This allows you to turn the park tilt  
mirrors feature on or off.  
Languages  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Reverse Tilt Mirroris  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
Onor Off. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Select the Language menu and the  
following will be displayed:  
or Off. Press 0 BACK to confirm  
the selection and go back to the  
last menu.  
.
English  
.
Exit Lighting  
French  
.
This allows the selection of how  
long the exterior lamps stay on  
when leaving the vehicle when it is  
dark outside.  
Spanish  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
Remote Lock/Unlock/Start  
4-37  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Exit Lightingis highlighted.  
Turn the knob to select Off,  
30 Seconds, 1 Minute,  
or 2 Minutes. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
between Onor Off. Press 0  
BACK to confirm the selection and  
go back to the last menu.  
Select Remote Lock/Unlock/Start  
and the following will be displayed:  
.
Auto Door Unlock  
Remote Unlock Light Feedback  
.
This allows selection of which of the  
doors will automatically unlock when  
the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
Remote Lock Feedback  
.
Remote Door Unlock  
Power Door Locks  
.
Memory Remote Recall  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Auto Door Unlockis  
Select Power Door Locks and the  
following will be displayed:  
.
Remote Vehicle Start  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
All Doors, Driver Door, or Off.  
Press the knob to confirm and go  
back to the last menu.  
Remote Unlock Light Feedback  
.
Unlocked Door Anti Lock Out  
When on, the exterior lamps will  
flash when unlocking the vehicle  
with the RKE transmitter.  
.
.
Auto Door Unlock  
Delayed Door Lock  
Delayed Door Lock  
Unlocked Door Anti Lock Out  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Remote Unlock Light  
Feedbackis highlighted. Turn the  
knob to select Flash Lightsor  
Off. Press the knob to confirm and  
go back to the last menu.  
When on, this feature will delay the  
locking of the doors. If you want to  
override the delay you can press the  
power door lock on the instrument  
panel.  
When on, this feature will keep the  
driver's door from locking when the  
door is open. If off is selected, the  
Delayed Door Lock menu will be  
available.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Delayed Door Lockis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
Onor Off. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Unlocked Door Anti Lock  
Outis highlighted to toggle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-38  
Instruments and Controls  
Remote Lock Feedback  
Memory Remote Recall  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Remote Vehicle Startis  
highlighted to toggle between On”  
This allows selection of what type of  
feedback is given when unlocking  
the vehicle with the RKE transmitter.  
This allows the Memory Remote  
Recallfeature to be turned on or  
off. Memory Remote Recallis  
when the memorized settings will be  
recalled as you unlock the vehicle.  
or Off. Press 0 BACK to confirm  
the selection and go back to the  
last menu.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Remote Lock Feedbackis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
Lights and Horn, Lights Only,  
Horn Only, or Off. Press the knob  
to confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Memory Remote Recallis  
highlighted to toggle between On”  
Return to Factory Settings  
Select Return to Factory Settings”  
to return all of the vehicle  
personalization to the default  
settings. Turn the knob to select  
Yesor No. Press the knob to  
confirm and go back to the  
last menu.  
or Off. Press 0 BACK to confirm  
the selection and go back to the  
last menu.  
Remote Door Unlock  
Remote Vehicle Start  
This allows selection of which doors  
will unlock when pressing the unlock  
button on the RKE transmitter.  
This allows the Remote Vehicle  
Startto be turned on or off, if the  
vehicle has this feature.  
Press the MENU / SELECT knob  
when Remote Door Unlockis  
highlighted. Turn the knob to select  
All Doorsor Driver Door. Press  
the knob to confirm and go back to  
the last menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments and Controls  
4-39  
OnStar® System  
For a full description of OnStar  
] : Push this red emergency  
button to get priority help from  
specially trained OnStar emergency  
advisors.  
services and system limitations,  
see the OnStar Owner's Guide in  
the glove box.  
OnStar service is subject to the  
OnStar terms and conditions  
included in the OnStar Subscriber  
Information.  
X : Push this button for handsfree,  
voiceactivated calling and to give  
voice commands for turnbyturn  
navigation.  
OnStar® uses several innovative  
technologies and live advisors to  
provide a wide range of safety,  
security, navigation, diagnostics,  
and calling services.  
OnStar service cannot work unless  
the vehicle is in a place where  
OnStar has an agreement with a  
wireless service provider for service  
in that area. OnStar service also  
cannot work unless the vehicle is in  
a place where the wireless service  
provider OnStar has hired for that  
area has coverage, network  
capacity and reception when the  
service is needed, and technology  
that is compatible with the OnStar  
service. Not all services are  
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle  
Assistance, Vehicle Diagnostics,  
Remote Door Unlock, Roadside  
Assistance, TurnbyTurn Navigation  
and HandsFree Calling are  
available on most vehicles. Not all  
OnStar services are available on all  
vehicles. For more information see  
the OnStar Owner's Guide or  
visit www.onstar.com (U.S.) or  
www.onstar.ca (Canada), contact  
OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR  
Automatic Crash Response  
In a crash, built in sensors can  
automatically alert an OnStar  
advisor who is immediately  
connected to the vehicle to see if  
you need help.  
(18884667827) or TTY  
How OnStar Service Works  
available everywhere, particularly in  
remote or enclosed areas, or at all  
times.  
18772482080, or press Q to  
speak with an OnStar advisor  
24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
Q : This blue button connects you  
to a specially trained OnStar advisor  
to verify your account information  
and to answer questions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-40  
Instruments and Controls  
The OnStar system can record and  
transmit vehicle information. This  
information is automatically sent to  
The vehicle must have a working  
electrical system, including  
Your Responsibility  
Increase the volume of the radio if  
the OnStar advisor cannot be heard.  
adequate battery power, for the  
OnStar equipment to operate. There  
are other problems OnStar cannot  
control that may prevent OnStar  
from providing OnStar service at  
any particular time or place. Some  
examples are damage to important  
parts of the vehicle in a crash, hills,  
tall buildings, tunnels, weather or  
wireless phone network congestion.  
an OnStar call center when Q is  
If the light next to the OnStar  
buttons is red, the system may not  
pressed, ] is pressed, or if the  
airbags or ACR system deploy. This  
information usually includes the  
vehicle's GPS location and, in the  
event of a crash, additional  
information regarding the crash that  
the vehicle was involved in (e.g. the  
direction from which the vehicle was  
hit). When the virtual advisor feature  
of OnStar hands-free calling is  
used, the vehicle also sends OnStar  
the vehicle's GPS location so they  
can provide services where it is  
located.  
be functioning properly. Press Q  
and request a vehicle diagnostic.  
If the light appears clear (no light  
is appearing), your OnStar  
subscription has expired and all  
services have been deactivated.  
Press Q to confirm that the OnStar  
equipment is active.  
OnStar Steering Wheel  
Controls  
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute  
button that can be used to interact  
with OnStar hands-free calling. See  
Steering Wheel Controls on  
Location information about the  
vehicle is only available if the GPS  
satellite signals are unobstructed  
and available.  
page 46 for more information.  
On some vehicles, the mute button  
can be used to dial numbers into  
voice mail systems, or to dial phone  
extensions. See the OnStar Owner's  
Guide for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
5-1  
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the  
parking lamps together with the  
following:  
Exterior Lighting  
Lighting  
Exterior Lamp Controls  
.
Sidemarker Lamps  
Exterior Lighting  
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . 5-2  
Turn and Lane-Change  
.
Taillamps  
.
License Plate Lamps  
.
Instrument Panel Lights  
5 (Headlamps): Turns on the  
headlamps, together with the  
previously listed lamps and lights.  
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Headlamp High/  
Low-Beam Changer  
Interior Lighting  
Instrument Panel Illumination  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
2 3 Headlamp High/Low Beam  
Changer: Push the turn/lane  
change lever away from you to  
turn the high beams on.  
The exterior lamp control is located  
on the turn signal/lane change lever.  
O (Exterior Lamp Control): Turn  
to operate the exterior lamps.  
Pull the lever towards you to return  
to low beams.  
Lighting Features  
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
O (Off): Turns the exterior  
lamps off.  
AUTO (Automatic Headlamps):  
Turns the exterior lamps on and off  
automatically depending on the  
exterior light.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-2  
Lighting  
When the exterior lamp band is  
turned to the headlamp position, the  
low-beam headlamps come on. The  
other lamps that come on with the  
headlamps will also come on.  
Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
system makes the low-beam  
headlamps come on at a reduced  
brightness in daylight when the  
following conditions are met:  
To idle your vehicle with the DRL  
off, move the shift lever to P (Park).  
The DRL will stay off until the shift  
lever is moved out of the P (Park)  
position.  
This indicator light turns on in the  
instrument panel cluster when the  
high beam headlamps are on.  
.
The ignition is on.  
.
The exterior lamp band is in the  
Flash-to-Pass  
The flashtopass feature works with  
the lowbeams or Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) on or off.  
The regular headlamp system  
should be turned on when needed.  
automatic position.  
.
The transmission is not in  
P (Park).  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
.
The light sensor determines it is  
daytime.  
To flash the high beams, pull the  
turn signal/lane change lever all the  
way towards you. Then release it.  
| (Hazard Warning Flasher):  
Press this button, located on the  
center of the instrument panel, to  
make the front and rear turn signal  
lamps flash on and off. This warns  
others that you are having trouble.  
.
The parking brake is released.  
Fully functional Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) are required on all  
vehicles first sold in Canada.  
When the DRL are on the taillamps,  
sidemarker, instrument panel lights  
and other lamps will not be on. The  
instrument panel cluster will be lit.  
Press | again to turn the  
flashers off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
5-3  
The lever returns to its starting  
position when it is released.  
# (Fog Lamps): Turn the fog lamp  
Turn and Lane-Change  
Signals  
band on the lever to # and release  
it, to turn the fog lamps on or off.  
The band will return to its original  
position.  
If after signaling a turn or a lane  
change the arrows flash rapidly or  
do not come on, a signal bulb may  
be burned out.  
The parking lamps or lowbeam  
headlamps must be on to use the  
fog lamps.  
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb  
is not burned out, check the fuse,  
see Fuses on page 934 for more  
information.  
The fog lamps will go off whenever  
the high-beam headlamps are  
turned on. When the highbeam  
headlamps are turned off, the fog  
lamps will come on again.  
An arrow on the instrument panel  
cluster will flash in the direction of  
the turn or lane change.  
Fog Lamps  
For vehicles with fog lamps, the  
control is located on the turn signal/  
lane change lever.  
Move the lever all the way up or  
down to signal a turn.  
Some localities have laws that  
require the headlamps to be on  
along with the fog lamps.  
Raise or lower the lever until the  
arrow starts to flash to signal a lane  
change. Hold it there until the lane  
change is complete.  
Use the fog lamps for better vision  
in foggy or misty conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-4  
Lighting  
1 (Door): The lamp comes on  
automatically when a door is  
opened.  
Interior Lighting  
Lighting Features  
Instrument Panel  
Illumination Control  
This control is located on the  
instrument panel, to the left of  
the steering column.  
Entry Lighting  
+ (On): Turns the dome lamp on.  
The dome lamp, cargo lamp and  
foot lamp inside the vehicle come  
on when any door is opened, if the  
dome lamp is in the door position. In  
addition, these lamps come on  
when the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) unlock button is pressed.  
They stay on for 20 seconds or until  
a door is opened. After the door is  
opened and then closed, the light  
remains on for 20 seconds, or until  
the ignition is turned to ON/RUN.  
Reading Lamps  
The reading lamps are located on  
the overhead console. These lamps  
come on automatically when any  
door is opened.  
D (Instrument Panel  
Brightness): Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to brighten or  
dim the lights.  
For manual operation, press the  
button next to each lamp to turn it  
on or off.  
Dome Lamps  
The dome lamp controls are located  
in the overhead console. To change  
the settings, press the following:  
* (Dome Lamp Override): Turns  
the lamp off, even when a door  
is open.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-1  
Audio Players  
Introduction  
Read the following pages to  
become familiar with the audio  
system's features.  
Infotainment  
System  
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
CD/DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Mass Storage  
Media (MEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Auxiliary Devices (Radio  
with CD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Auxiliary Devices (Radio  
Introduction  
WARNING  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . 6-2  
Overview (Radio with CD) . . . . . 6-3  
Overview (Radio with  
{
with CD/DVD/MEM) . . . . . . . 6-31  
Taking your eyes off the road for  
extended periods could cause a  
crash resulting in injury or death  
to you or others. Do not give  
extended attention to  
Rear Seat Infotainment  
Rear Seat Entertainment  
CD/DVD/MEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
(RSE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Radio  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
Phone  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Multi-Band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Bluetooth (Overview) . . . . . . . . 6-42  
Bluetooth (Infotainment  
This system provides access to  
many audio and non audio listings.  
Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Bluetooth (Voice  
Recognition) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Bluetooth (Navigation) . . . . . . . 6-58  
To minimize taking your eyes off the  
road while driving, do the following  
while the vehicle is parked:  
.
Become familiar with the  
operation and controls of the  
audio system.  
.
Set up the tone, speaker  
adjustments, and preset radio  
stations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-2  
Infotainment System  
For more information, see Defensive  
Driving on page 83.  
Notice: Contact your dealer  
before adding any equipment.  
Navigation/Radio System  
For vehicles with a navigation radio  
system, see the separate Navigation  
System manual.  
This vehicle's infotainment system  
may be equipped with a noise  
reduction system which can work  
improperly if the audio amplifier,  
engine calibrations, exhaust system,  
microphones, radio, or speakers are  
modified or replaced. This could  
result in more noticeable engine  
noise at certain speeds.  
Adding audio or communication  
equipment could interfere with  
the operation of the vehicle's  
engine, radio, or other systems,  
and could damage them. Follow  
federal rules covering mobile  
radio and telephone equipment.  
Theft-Deterrent Feature  
The theft-deterrent feature works by  
learning a portion of the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN) to  
the infotainment system. The  
infotainment system does not  
operate if it is stolen or moved to  
a different vehicle.  
The vehicle has Retained  
Accessory Power (RAP). With RAP,  
the audio system can be played  
even after the ignition is turned off.  
See Retained Accessory Power  
(RAP) on page 829 for more  
information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-3  
Overview (Radio with CD)  
A. VOL/ O  
.
Turns the system on or off  
and adjusts the volume.  
B. g SEEK  
.
Radio: Seeks the previous  
station.  
.
CD: Selects the previous  
track or rewinds within a  
track.  
C. RADIO/BAND  
.
Changes the band while  
listening to the radio.  
.
Selects the radio when  
listening to a different  
audio source.  
D. AUX  
.
Selects a connected  
external audio source.  
E. Buttons 1 to 6  
.
Radio: Saves and selects  
favorite stations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-4  
Infotainment System  
F. FAV  
O. INFO  
K. k  
.
.
Radio: Opens the  
favorites list.  
Radio: Shows available  
information about the  
current station.  
.
CD: Pauses the CD.  
L. CD  
G. TONE  
.
Selects the CD player  
when listening to a  
.
CD: Shows available  
information about the  
current track.  
.
Opens the tone menu.  
different audio source.  
H. CONFIG  
.
Opens the settings menu.  
M. Z CD Eject  
P. 5 / 0  
.
I. MENU/SEL  
Removes a disc from the  
CD slot.  
.
Opens the phone  
main menu.  
.
Press: Opens the menus  
and selects menu items.  
.
N. l SEEK  
Mutes the audio system.  
.
Turn: Highlights menu  
items or sets values while  
in a menu. Manually  
selects radio stations while  
listening to the radio.  
.
Radio: Seeks the next  
station.  
Q. H  
.
Opens the clock menu.  
.
CD: Selects the next track  
or fast forwards within a  
track.  
R. 0 BACK  
.
Menu: Moves one  
level back.  
J. CD Slot  
.
Insert a CD.  
.
Character Input: Deletes  
the last character.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-5  
Overview (Radio with CD/DVD/MEM)  
A. VOL/ O  
.
Turns the system on or off  
and adjusts the volume.  
B. g SEEK  
.
Radio: Seeks the previous  
station.  
.
CD/DVD: Selects the  
previous track or rewinds  
within a track.  
.
MEM: Selects the previous  
track or rewinds within a  
track.  
C. RADIO/BAND  
.
Changes the band while  
listening to the radio.  
.
Selects the radio when  
listening to a different  
audio source.  
D. MEM/DVD/AUX  
.
Selects MEM, CD/DVD,  
USB, or a connected front  
or rear auxillary audio  
source.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-6  
Infotainment System  
E. Buttons 1 to 6  
J. CD/DVD Slot  
N. l SEEK  
.
.
Radio: Saves and selects  
Insert a disc.  
.
Radio: Seeks the next  
favorite stations.  
station.  
K. k (Play/Pause)  
.
MEM: Saves and selects  
favorite tracks and  
playlists.  
.
.
CD/DVD: Selects the next  
track or fast forwards  
within a track.  
.
Radio: Pauses time shifted  
content.  
.
.
CD/DVD: Pauses CD/DVD  
A and DVDV playback.  
Stops DVDV playback.  
F. FAV  
MEM: Selects the next  
track or fast forwards  
within a track.  
.
Radio: Opens the  
favorites list.  
MEM: Pauses MEM  
playback.  
.
O. INFO  
MEM: Opens the  
favorites list.  
.
Radio: Shows available  
information about the  
current station.  
L. O REC  
G. TONE  
.
CD/DVD: Records content  
.
Opens the tone menu.  
from audio CDs and MP3/  
WMA CDs.  
.
.
CD/DVD: Shows available  
information about the  
current track.  
H. CONFIG  
.
.
Opens the settings menu.  
AUX: Records content  
from USB mass storage  
devices.  
I. MENU/SEL  
MEM: Shows available  
information about the  
current track.  
.
Press: Opens menus and  
M. Z CD Eject  
selects menu items.  
.
.
P. 5 / 0 (Phone/Mute)  
Turn: Highlights menu  
items or sets values while  
in a menu. Manually  
Removes a disc from the  
CD/DVD slot.  
.
Opens the phone  
main menu.  
selects radio stations while  
listening to the radio.  
.
Mutes the audio system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-7  
Q. DEL  
Automatic SwitchOff  
Menu System  
Controls  
.
MEM: Deletes the current  
track from MEM.  
If the infotainment system has been  
turned on after the ignition is turned  
off, the system will turn off  
The MENU/SEL knob and the  
0 BACK button are used to  
navigate the menu system.  
R. 0 BACK  
automatically after ten minutes.  
.
Menu: Moves one  
level back.  
Volume Control  
MENU/SEL (Menu/Select):  
Press to:  
VOL/ O (Volume/Power): Turn to  
adjust the volume.  
.
Character Input: Deletes  
the last character.  
.
Enter the menu system.  
.
5 / 0 (Mute): For vehicles with  
OnStar®, press and hold 5 / 0 to  
Select or activate the highlighted  
menu option.  
Operation  
mute the infotainment system. Press  
.
.
Confirm a set value.  
Controls  
and hold 5 / 0 again, or turn the  
VOL/ O knob to cancel mute.  
For vehicles without OnStar®, press  
Turn a system setting on or off.  
The infotainment system is operated  
by using the pushbuttons,  
multifunction knobs, menus that are  
shown on the display, and steering  
wheel controls, if equipped.  
Turn to:  
.
Highlight a menu option.  
Select a value.  
5 / 0 to mute the infotainment  
.
system. Press 5 / 0 again, or turn  
the VOL/ O knob to cancel mute.  
0 BACK: Press to:  
.
Turning the System On or Off  
Exit a menu.  
VOL/ O (Volume/Power): Press to  
turn the system on and off.  
.
Return from a submenu screen  
to the previous menu screen.  
.
Delete the last character in a  
sequence.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-8  
Infotainment System  
Selecting a Menu Option  
Activating a Setting  
Turning a Function On or Off  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
move the highlighted bar.  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
highlight the setting.  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
highlight the function.  
2. Press the MENU/SEL button to  
select the highlighted option.  
2. Press the MENU/SEL button to  
activate the setting.  
2. Press the MENU/SEL button to  
turn the function on or off.  
Submenus  
Setting a Value  
Entering a Character Sequence  
An arrow on the righthand edge of  
the menu indicates that it has a  
submenu with other options.  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
change the current value of the  
setting.  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
highlight the character.  
2. Press the MENU/SEL button to  
select the character.  
2. Press the MENU/SEL button to  
confirm the setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-9  
Adjusting the Treble, Midrange,  
and Bass  
Adjusting the Fader and Balance  
Press the 0 BACK button to delete  
the last character in the sequence  
or press and hold to delete the  
entire character sequence.  
Audio Settings  
The audio settings can be set for  
each radio band and each audio  
player source.  
1. Press the TONE button.  
2. Select Fader or Balance.  
3. Select the value.  
1. Press the TONE button.  
To quickly reset an audio setting  
value to 0:  
2. Select Treble, Midrange,  
or Bass.  
1. Press the TONE button.  
2. Select the audio setting.  
Press the 0 BACK button to go  
back to the Tone Settings menu.  
3. Select the value.  
Press the 0 BACK button to go  
back to the Tone Settings menu.  
3. Press and hold the MENU/SEL  
button until the value changes  
to 0.  
Press the 0 BACK button to go  
back to the Tone Settings menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-10  
Infotainment System  
Adjusting the EQ (Equalizer)  
Auto Volume  
System Settings  
For vehicles that have an equalizer:  
The auto volume feature  
Configuring the Number of  
Favorite Pages  
automatically adjusts the radio  
volume to compensate for road and  
wind noise as the vehicle speeds up  
or slows down, so that the volume  
level is consistent.  
The level of volume compensation  
can be selected, or the auto volume  
feature can be turned off.  
1. Press the TONE button.  
2. Select EQ.  
To configure the number of available  
favorite pages:  
3. Select the setting.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Radio Settings.  
3. Select Radio Favorites.  
Press the 0 BACK button to go  
back to the Tone Settings menu.  
4. Select the number of available  
favorite pages.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Radio Settings.  
3. Select Auto Volume.  
4. Select the setting.  
5. Press the 0 BACK button  
to go back to the System  
Configuration menu.  
5. Press the 0 BACK button  
to go back to the System  
Configuration menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-11  
Maximum Startup Volume  
k : Press to pause and resume  
time shifted data. See Time Shifting  
(Radio with CD/DVD and MEM)”  
later in this section.  
Radio  
The maximum volume played when  
the Radio with CD is first turned on  
can be set.  
AM-FM Radio  
Control Buttons  
1 to 6: Press to select preset  
stations.  
The buttons used to control the  
radio are:  
RDS (Radio Data System)  
RADIO/BAND: Press to turn the  
radio on and choose between AM,  
FM, and XM, if equipped.  
The radio may have RDS. The RDS  
feature is available for use only on  
FM stations that broadcast RDS  
information. This feature only works  
when the information from the radio  
station is available. In rare cases,  
a radio station could broadcast  
incorrect information that causes the  
radio features to work improperly.  
If this happens, contact the radio  
station.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Radio Settings.  
MENU/SEL: Turn to manually  
search for stations.  
FAV: Press to open the  
favorites list.  
3. Select Maximum Startup  
Volume.  
l SEEK or g SEEK: Press to  
search for stations. Press and hold  
to fast forward and rewind time  
shifted data. See Time Shifting  
(Radio with CD/DVD and MEM)”  
later in this section.  
4. Select the setting.  
5. Press the 0 BACK button  
to go back to the System  
Configuration menu.  
While the radio is tuned to an  
FM-RDS station, the station name  
or call letters display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-12  
Infotainment System  
If the radio station is known:  
Station Lists  
Radio Menus  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
Radio menus are available for AM  
and FM.  
Press and hold g SEEK or  
l SEEK until the station on the  
display is reached, then release  
the button.  
2. Select AM or FM Station List. All  
receivable stations in the current  
reception area are displayed. If a  
station list has not been created,  
an automatic station search  
is done.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob to open  
the main radio menu for that band.  
Seek Tuning (Radio with CD/DVD  
and MEM)  
Selecting a Band  
Press the RADIO/BAND button to  
choose AM, FM, or XM,  
if equipped. The last station that  
was playing starts playing again.  
Briefly press l SEEK or g SEEK,  
to automatically search for the next  
available station. If a station is not  
found, the radio switches to a more  
sensitive search level. If a station  
still is not found, the frequency that  
was last active begins to play.  
3. Select the station.  
Category Lists  
Most stations that broadcast an  
RDS program type code specify the  
type of programming transmitted.  
Some stations change the program  
type code depending on the  
content. The system stores the  
RDS stations sorted by program  
type in the FM category list.  
Selecting a Station  
Seek Tuning (Radio with CD)  
If the radio station is not known:  
Manual Tuning  
Briefly press g SEEK or l SEEK,  
to automatically search for the next  
available station. If a station is not  
found, the radio switches to a more  
sensitive search level. If a station  
still is not found, the frequency that  
was last active begins to play.  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to select  
the frequency on the display.  
Favorites List  
To search for a programming type  
determined by station:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Favorites List.  
3. Select the station.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select FM category list. A list of  
all programming types available  
displays.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-13  
3. Select the programming type.  
A list of stations that transmit  
programming of the selected  
type displays.  
Storing a Station as a Favorite  
Time Shifting (Radio with  
CD/DVD and MEM)  
Stations from all bands can be  
stored in any order in the favorite  
pages.  
The radio with MEM time shift  
feature can rewind 20 minutes of  
FM/AM content. While listening to  
the radio, the content from the  
current station is always being  
buffered.  
4. Select the station.  
Up to six stations can be stored in  
each favorite page and the number  
of available favorite pages can  
be set.  
The category lists are updated  
when the station lists are  
updated.  
Press the k button to pause the  
radio. The radio displays the time  
shift status bar. The status bar  
shows the amount of content that is  
stored in the buffer and the current  
pause point.  
Updating Station & Category Lists  
Storing a Station as a Favorite  
If stations stored in the station list  
can no longer be received.  
To store the station to a position in  
the list, press the corresponding  
button 1 to 6 until a beep is heard.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
Retrieving stations  
2. Select Update AM or FM Station  
List, if the stations stored in the  
station list are no longer  
To resume playback from the  
current pause point, press the  
k button again. The radio is no  
longer live, but played from the time  
shift buffer. A status bar displays  
below the station number.  
Press the FAV button to open a  
favorite page or to switch to another  
favorite page. Briefly press one of  
the 1 to 6 buttons to retrieve the  
station.  
received. A station search will be  
completed and the first station in  
the updated list will play.  
To cancel the station search, press  
the MENU/SEL knob.  
Press and hold the g SEEK or  
l SEEK buttons to fast forward or  
rewind through the time shift buffer.  
Hold l SEEK until the end of the  
recorded buffer resumes live  
playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-14  
Infotainment System  
Control Buttons  
Press and release the g SEEK or  
l SEEK buttons to jump forward or  
back 30 seconds in the time shift  
buffer.  
Satellite Radio  
The buttons used to control the XM  
radio are:  
Vehicles with an XMSatellite  
Radio tuner and a valid XM Satellite  
Radio subscription can receive XM  
programming.  
RADIO/BAND: Press to turn the  
radio on and choose between AM,  
FM, and XM, if equipped.  
When the radio station is changed,  
the buffer is cleared and  
automatically restarted for the  
current station. Content from a  
previously tuned station is no longer  
available.  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
g SEEK / l SEEK: Press to go  
XM is a satellite radio service that is  
based in the 48 contiguous United  
States and 10 Canadian provinces.  
XM Satellite Radio has a wide  
variety of programming and  
to the previous or next station.  
FAV: Press to open the  
favorites list.  
The time shift feature is not  
available while recording or with  
other sources of playback.  
k : Press to pause and resume  
time shifted data. See Time Shifting  
(Radio with CD/DVD and MEM)”  
later in this section.  
commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality  
sound. A service fee is required to  
receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at  
www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and  
www.xmradio.ca or call  
Pausing AM/FM with the Vehicle  
Turned Off  
1 to 6: Press to select preset  
stations.  
If AM/FM is paused when the  
vehicle is turned off, the radio  
continues to buffer the current radio  
station for up to 20 minutes. If the  
vehicle is turned back on within  
20 minutes, the radio resumes  
playback from the paused point.  
MENU/SEL: Turn to select stations.  
Press to open the XM Satellite  
Radio menu.  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-15  
Selecting a Channel Using the  
MENU/SEL Knob  
Selecting the XM Band  
Selecting an XM Channel  
Press the RADIO/BAND button to  
choose between the AM, FM and  
XM bands. The last channel played  
in that band begins to play when  
that band is selected.  
XM channels can be selected by  
To select an XM channel using the  
MENU/SEL knob:  
using g SEEK, l SEEK, the  
MENU/SEL knob, or the menu  
system.  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
highlight an XM channel, the  
channel is selected after a short  
delay.  
Selecting a Channel Using  
XM Categories  
g SEEK or l SEEK  
XM channels are organized in  
categories.  
(Radio with CD)  
To select a channel using the menu:  
.
Press and release g SEEK or  
1. Turn the menu knob and select  
Channel List.  
Removing or Adding Categories  
l SEEK to go to the previous  
or next channel.  
Channels in a category that have  
been removed can still be accessed  
2. Select the desired channel.  
.
Press and hold g SEEK or  
l SEEK to scroll through the  
previous or next channel until  
the channel is reached.  
Selecting a Channel Using the  
Menu System  
by using the g SEEK or l SEEK  
buttons, or the MENU/SEL knob.  
1. Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select XM Category List.  
3. Select the category.  
To add or remove categories:  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Radio Settings.  
3. Select XM Categories.  
Selecting a Channel Using  
g SEEK or l SEEK (Radio  
with CD/DVD and MEM)  
4. Select the channel.  
Press and release g SEEK or  
l SEEK to go to the previous or  
next channel.  
4. Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
highlight the category.  
5. Press the MENU/SEL knob to  
remove or add the category.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-16  
Infotainment System  
Storing an XM Channel as a  
Favorite  
Time Shifting (Radio with  
CD/DVD and MEM)  
Press and release the g SEEK or  
l SEEK buttons to go to the next  
or previous song in the time shift  
buffer.  
Channels from all bands can be  
stored in any order in the favorite  
pages.  
The radio with MEM time shift  
feature can rewind 20 minutes of  
XM content. While listening to the  
radio, the content from the current  
channel is always being buffered.  
When the channel is changed, the  
buffer is cleared and automatically  
restarted for the current channel.  
Content from a previously tuned  
station is no longer available.  
Up to six channels can be stored in  
each favorite page and the number  
of available favorite pages can  
be set.  
Press the k button to pause the  
radio. The radio displays the time  
shift status bar. The status bar  
shows the amount of content that is  
stored in the buffer and the current  
pause point.  
The time shift feature is not  
available while recording or with  
other sources of playback.  
Storing a Channel as a Favorite  
To store the channel to a position  
in the list, press and hold the  
corresponding 1 to 6 button until  
the channel can be heard again.  
Pausing XM with the Vehicle  
Turned Off  
To resume playback from the  
current pause point, press the  
k button again. The radio is no  
longer live, but played from the time  
shift buffer. A status bar displays  
below the channel number.  
If XM is paused when the vehicle is  
turned off, the radio continues to  
buffer the current radio station for  
up to 20 minutes. If the vehicle is  
turned back on within 20 minutes,  
the radio resumes playback from the  
paused point.  
Retrieving Channels  
Press the FAV button to open a  
favorite page or to change to  
another favorite page. Briefly press  
one of the 1 to 6 buttons to retrieve  
the channel.  
Press and hold the g SEEK or  
l SEEK buttons to fast forward or  
rewind through the time shift buffer.  
Hold l SEEK until the end of the  
recorded buffer resumes live  
playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-17  
No Artist Info: The system is  
working properly. No artist  
information is available at this  
time on this channel.  
CAT Not Found: The system is  
working properly. There are no  
channels available for the selected  
category.  
XM Messages  
XL (Explicit Language  
Channels): These channels, or any  
others, can be blocked by request,  
by calling 1-800-852-XMXM (9696).  
No Title Info: The system is  
working properly. No song title  
information is available at this time  
on this channel.  
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0,  
this message alternates with the XM  
Radio 8 digit radio ID label. This  
label is needed to activate the  
service.  
XM Updating: The encryption code  
in the receiver is being updated, no  
action is required. This process  
should take no longer than  
30 seconds.  
No CAT Info: The system is  
working properly. No category  
information is available at this time  
on this channel.  
Unknown: If this message is  
received when tuned to channel 0,  
there could be a receiver fault.  
Consult with your dealer.  
Loading XM: The audio system is  
acquiring and processing audio and  
text data, no action is needed. This  
message should disappear shortly.  
No Information: The system is  
working properly. No text or  
informational messages are  
available at this time on this  
channel.  
Check Antenna: If this message  
does not clear within a short period  
of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer.  
Channel Off Air: This channel is  
not currently in service. Tune in to  
another channel.  
No XM Signal: The system is  
working properly. The vehicle may  
be in a location where the XM signal  
is being blocked. When the vehicle  
is moved into an open area, the  
signal should return.  
XM Not Available: If this message  
does not clear within a short period  
of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer.  
Channel Unauth: This channel is  
blocked or cannot be received with  
your XM Subscription package.  
Channel Unavailable: This  
previously assigned channel is no  
longer assigned. Tune to another  
station.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-18  
Infotainment System  
AM  
Cellular Phone Usage  
Radio Reception  
The range for most AM stations is  
greater than for FM, especially at  
night. The longer range can cause  
station frequencies to interfere with  
each other. Static can occur when  
things like storms and power lines  
interfere with radio reception. When  
this happens, try reducing the treble  
on the radio.  
Cellular phone usage can cause  
interference with the vehicle's radio.  
Frequency interference and static  
can occur during normal radio  
reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience  
accessories, and external electronic  
devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is  
interference or static, unplug the  
item from the accessory power  
outlet.  
Multi-Band Antenna  
The multi-band antenna is located  
on the roof of the vehicle. The  
antenna is used for the AM/FM  
radio, OnStar, the XM Satellite  
Radio Service System, and GPS  
(Global Positioning System); if the  
vehicle has these features. Keep  
the antenna clear of obstructions  
for clear reception. If the vehicle  
has a sunroof and it is open, the  
performance of the AM/FM radio,  
OnStar, XM system, and GPS can  
be affected.  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
FM  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives  
digital radio reception from  
FM signals only reach about 16 to  
65 km (10 to 40 miles). Although the  
radio has a built-in electronic circuit  
that automatically works to reduce  
interference, some static can occur,  
especially around tall buildings or  
hills, causing the sound to fade in  
and out.  
coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous  
United States, and in Canada. Just  
as with FM, tall buildings or hills can  
interfere with satellite radio signals,  
causing the sound to fade in and  
out. In addition, traveling or standing  
under heavy foliage, bridges,  
garages, or tunnels may cause loss  
of the XM signal for a period of time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-19  
If the bottom surface of a disc is  
dirty, take a soft lint free cloth,  
or dampen a clean soft cloth in a  
mild neutral detergent solution  
mixed with water, and clean it. Wipe  
the disc from the center to the  
outer edge.  
While using the CD player, use  
only CDs in good condition  
without any label, load one CD at  
a time, and keep the CD player  
and the loading slot free of  
foreign materials, liquids, and  
debris.  
Audio Players  
CD Player  
The CD player can play audio CDs  
and MP3 CDs.  
The CD player will not play  
8 cm (3 in.) CDs.  
Care of the CD Player  
Control Buttons  
Do not add a label to a disc, as it  
could get caught in the CD player.  
If a label is needed, label the top of  
the recorded disc with a  
The buttons used to control the CD  
player are:  
Care of CDs  
Sound quality can be reduced due  
to disc quality, recording method,  
quality of the music recorded, and  
how the disc has been handled.  
Handle discs carefully and store  
them in their original cases or other  
protective cases away from direct  
sunlight and dust. If the bottom  
surface of a disc is damaged, the  
disc may not play properly or at all.  
Do not touch the bottom surface of  
a disc while handling it; this could  
damage the surface. Pick up discs  
by grasping the outer edges or the  
edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
CD: Press to choose between the  
CD and AUX player.  
marking pen.  
l SEEK or g SEEK : Press to  
select tracks or to fast forward or  
rewind within a track.  
Do not use disc lens cleaners  
because they could contaminate the  
lens of the disc optics and damage  
the CD player.  
INFO: Press to display additional  
information about the CD that may  
be available.  
Notice: If a label is added to a  
CD, or more than one CD is  
inserted into the slot at a time,  
or an attempt is made to play  
scratched or damaged CDs, the  
CD player could be damaged.  
MENU/SEL: Turn to select tracks.  
Z (Eject): Press to remove  
the CD.  
k : Press to pause a CD or MP3  
track, press again to resume  
playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-20  
Infotainment System  
Selecting a CD Track  
Fast Forward and Rewind  
Inserting a CD  
Using the control buttons:  
With the printed side facing up,  
insert a disc into the CD slot until it  
is drawn in.  
Press and hold l SEEK or  
g SEEK to fast forward or  
rewind within the current track.  
.
Press the g SEEK or l SEEK  
button to select the previous or  
next track.  
Removing a CD  
Selecting an MP3 Track  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
Using the control buttons:  
Press the Z button.  
Using the CD Menu:  
.
The disc is pushed out of the  
CD slot.  
Press the g SEEK or l SEEK  
button to select the previous or  
next track.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Tracks list.  
3. Select the track.  
If the disc is not removed after it is  
ejected, it is pulled back in after a  
few seconds.  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
Using the CD Menu:  
Playing Tracks in Random Order  
Playing a CD or MP3 CD  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Playlists / Folders.  
3. Select the playlist or folder.  
4. Select the track.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
then set Shuffle Songs to On.  
Press the CD button, if there is a  
disc in the player it begins playing.  
Information about the disc and  
current track is shown on the  
display depending on the data  
stored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-21  
Searching for MP3 Tracks  
mixed with water, and clean it. Wipe  
the disc from the center to the  
outer edge.  
CD/DVD Player  
The CD/DVD player can play  
CDs, DVDAs, MP3/WMA CDs,  
MP3/WMA DVDs, and DVDVs.  
The search feature may take some  
time to display the information after  
reading the disc due to the amount  
of information stored on the disc.  
FM automatically plays while the  
disc is being read.  
Care of the CD/DVD Player  
Do not add a label to a disc, as it  
could get caught in the CD/DVD  
player. If a label is needed, label the  
top of the recorded disc with a  
marking pen.  
The CD/DVD player will not play  
8 cm (3 in.) discs.  
Care of CDs and DVDs  
Tracks can be searched by:  
.
Sound quality can be reduced due  
to disc quality, recording method,  
quality of the music recorded, and  
how the disc has been handled.  
Handle discs carefully and store  
them in their original cases or other  
protective cases away from direct  
sunlight and dust. If the bottom  
surface of a disc is damaged, the  
disc may not play properly or at all.  
Do not touch the bottom surface of  
a disc while handling it; this could  
damage the surface. Pick up discs  
by grasping the outer edges or the  
edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
Playlists  
Do not use disc lens cleaners  
because they could contaminate the  
lens of the disc optics and damage  
the CD/DVD player.  
.
Artists  
.
Albums  
.
Song Titles  
.
Notice: If a label is added to a  
CD, or more than one CD is  
inserted into the slot at a time,  
or an attempt is made to play  
scratched or damaged CDs, the  
CD player could be damaged.  
While using the CD player, use  
only CDs in good condition  
without any label, load one CD at  
a time, and keep the CD player  
and the loading slot free of  
foreign materials, liquids, and  
debris.  
Genres  
.
Folder View  
To search for tracks:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, Genres,  
or Folder View.  
If the bottom surface of a disc is  
dirty, take a soft lint free cloth,  
or dampen a clean soft cloth in a  
mild neutral detergent solution  
4. Select the track.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-22  
Infotainment System  
Using the menu:  
Control Buttons  
Removing a CD or DVD  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Tracks List.  
3. Select the track.  
The buttons used to control the  
CD/DVD player are:  
Press the Z button.  
The disc is pushed out of the  
CD/DVD slot.  
MEM/DVD/AUX: Press to choose  
between the MEM, CD/DVD,  
and AUX.  
If the disc is not removed after it is  
ejected, it is pulled back in after a  
few seconds.  
Pausing a CD or DVDA Track  
l SEEK or g SEEK : Press to  
select tracks or to fast forward or  
rewind within a track.  
Press the k button to pause a CD  
or DVDA track. Press the k button  
again to continue playing the track.  
Playing a CD or DVDA Disc  
Press the MEM/DVD/AUX button if  
there is a disc in the player, it  
begins playing.  
INFO: Press to display additional  
information about the disc that may  
be available.  
Playing CD or DVDA Tracks in  
Random Order  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
then set Shuffle Songs to On.  
Information about the disc and  
current track is shown on the  
display depending on the data  
stored.  
MENU/SEL: Turn to select tracks.  
Z (Eject): Press to remove  
Fast Forward and Rewind  
a disc.  
Press and hold the l SEEK or  
g SEEK button to fast forward or  
rewind within the current track.  
k : Press to pause a CD, DVDA,  
or DVDV, press again to resume  
playback. Press and hold to stop a  
DVDV disc.  
Selecting CD or DVDA Tracks  
Using the control buttons:  
.
Press the g SEEK or l SEEK  
button to select the previous or  
next track.  
Inserting a CD or DVD  
With the printed side facing up,  
insert a disc into the slot until it is  
drawn in.  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-23  
Searching for MP3s on a CD  
or DVD  
To search for tracks:  
Playing an MP3 CD or DVD  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
Files that are not stored in folders  
are displayed in the root  
directory (disc).  
It is normal for the search feature to  
take some time to display the  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, or Genres.  
information after reading the disc  
due to the amount of information  
stored on the disc. The infotainment  
system automatically switches to  
FM while the disc is being read.  
The search rate increases if the  
MENU/SEL knob is continuously  
turned while searching in a list.  
4. Select the track. The search rate  
increases if the menu MENU/  
SEL knob is continuously turned  
while searching in a list.  
Selecting an MP3 Track  
Files that do not have any meta  
data stored in the ID3 tag display as  
Unknown.  
Using the control buttons:  
Playing MP3 Tracks in Random  
Order  
.
Press the g SEEK or l SEEK  
button to select the previous or  
next track.  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
then set Shuffle Songs to On.  
.
Playlists  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
.
Artists  
Recording an Audio or MP3  
CD to MEM  
Using the CD or DVD Menu:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Folder List.  
.
Albums  
.
See Mass Storage Media (MEM) on  
page 625 for more information.  
Song Titles  
.
Genres  
3. Select the folder.  
The number of objects in each  
category is shown in parentheses  
after the category.  
4. Select the track.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-24  
Infotainment System  
.
.
.
Cursor RIGHT  
Cursor LEFT  
Up Menu  
Changing the Audio Stream  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Audio Stream.  
Playing a DVDV  
See Rear Seat Entertainment (RSE)  
System on page 633 for  
information about how to control a  
Video DVD using the wireless  
remote control.  
Use the following actions to  
navigate the menu on a DVDV  
Disc while playing chapters.  
3. Select Change Audio Stream.  
4. Press MENU/SEL to change the  
selection.  
Selecting a Chapter  
.
Pause (Play)  
Select Cancel to exit the menu.  
Using the control buttons:  
.
Chapter List  
Pausing a DVD  
.
.
Press the g SEEK or l SEEK  
button to select the previous or  
next track.  
Title List  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
.
DVD/DVD  
2. Select Pause, to pause the disc.  
Select Unpause to start  
playback.  
.
DVD/AUX  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob.  
.
AUX/DVD  
Using DVD Menu:  
.
AUX/AUX  
Navigating the DVDV Disc Menu  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Chapter List.  
3. Select the chapter.  
To navigate the menu:  
Use the following actions to  
navigate the title menu on a  
DVDV Disc.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select the action.  
.
Selecting a Title  
Select / Enter  
.
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Title List.  
Cursor UP  
.
Cursor DOWN  
3. Select the title.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-25  
INFO: Press to display additional  
information about the MEM track  
that may be available.  
Recording to MEM  
Mass Storage  
Media (MEM)  
Press O REC, then select Record  
Current Song or Record All Songs  
on Disc. If the track has started  
playing, the system will restart the  
track and begin recording from the  
beginning of the track. When the  
song recording is completed, the  
message Song Recorded to MEM  
displays, and there may be a slight  
pause.  
Infotainment systems with MEM  
storage are able to record up to  
1.1 GB (gigabyte) of music from  
Audio CDs, MP3/WMA/AAC discs,  
and USB storage devices. The MEM  
player can also time shift audio from  
AM, FM, and XMradio.  
k : Press to pause the track  
currently playing, press again to  
resume playback.  
O REC: Press to record music  
from a CD, DVD-A, or USB drive.  
FAV (Favorites): Press to display  
MEM favorites.  
Music or content that is stored in  
MEM that you did not create,  
or have the right to distribute, must  
be deleted before the sale or end of  
the lease of the vehicle.  
16: Press to select a track or a  
stored playlist.  
Songs recorded to MEM are stored  
as the current date, disc and track  
number.  
MENU/SEL: Turn to select tracks.  
Re-recording a Previously  
Recorded Disc  
Recording From Audio CDs  
Control Buttons  
The infotainment system can record  
the current song playing or all songs  
from an audio CD to MEM. A status  
bar appears on the top of the  
display when the recording process  
starts and disappears when the  
process has ended. Copy protected  
CDs cannot be recorded to MEM.  
The buttons used to control the  
MEM player are:  
If the disc or track has already been  
recorded to MEM, the message The  
Song(s) is Already Recorded  
displays.  
MEM/DVD/AUX: Press to select  
the MEM player.  
l SEEK or g SEEK: Press to  
select tracks or to fast forward or  
rewind within a track.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-26  
Infotainment System  
Stopping the Recording  
Re-recording a Previously  
Recorded Disc  
Recording From MP3/WMA  
Discs or USB Storage Devices  
Press the O REC button while  
recording from an audio CD to  
display the stop recording option.  
Select Stop Recording Song  
to MEM.  
If the disc or track has already been  
recorded to MEM, the message The  
Song(s) is Already Recorded  
displays.  
USB Host Support  
The USB connector uses the USB  
standards, 1.1 and 2.0.  
USB Supported Devices  
Stopping the Recording  
Renaming Recorded Discs  
.
USB Flash Drives  
Press the O REC button while  
recording from an MP3/WMA CD or  
USB storage device to display the  
stop recording option. Select Stop  
Recording Song to MEM.  
Discs that have been recorded to  
MEM can be renamed.  
.
Portable USB Hard Drives  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Rename Recorded Discs.  
3. Select the disc.  
Recording to MEM  
Press O REC, then select Record  
Current Song or Record Current  
Folder.  
Deleting Tracks From MEM  
4. Select Album or Artist to rename  
either one.  
Individual tracks and all tracks can  
be deleted from MEM.  
The information stored by MEM is  
titled according to the ID3 tag  
associated with it.  
5. Use the menu knob to enter  
the character sequence. See  
Operation on page 67 for  
more information.  
To delete individual tracks, press  
and release the DEL button while  
the track is playing.  
To delete all tracks from MEM,  
press and hold the DEL button while  
a track is playing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-27  
To search for tracks:  
To remove MEM favorites  
categories:  
Playing From MEM  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
Playing Back a Previously  
Recorded CD  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Radio Settings.  
3. Select MEM Favorites.  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to select  
a track if MEM is already playing  
from the previously recorded disc.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, or Genres.  
4. Select the track. The search rate  
increases if the menu knob is  
continuously turned while  
searching in a list.  
4. Remove the check mark from  
the box to remove that MEM  
favorites category.  
1. Select Recorded Disc List.  
2. Select the disc.  
Replace the check mark to re-add  
the removed category.  
3. Select the track.  
Shuffle Songs  
Searching For a Track  
Select the Shuffle Songs option  
from the MEM menu to randomly  
play back tracks stored in MEM.  
Saving MEM Tracks as  
Favorites  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
.
Playlists  
Favorites can be saved by pressing  
and holding one of the 1 to 6  
buttons. Favorites can be stored  
according to the following list:  
.
Artists  
Configuring MEM Favorites  
.
Albums  
During MEM playback, press the  
FAV button to change between  
favorite categories. The favorite  
categories are:  
.
Song Titles  
Playlist: Adds currently playing  
track to the playlist selected.  
.
Genres  
The number of objects in each  
category is shown in parentheses  
after the category.  
.
Artist: Saves the artist associated  
with the currently playing track in  
the indicated favorites position.  
Playlists  
.
Artists  
.
Albums  
.
Genres  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-28  
Infotainment System  
Album: Saves the album  
associated with the currently playing  
track in the indicated favorites  
position.  
3.5 mm Auxiliary Input Jack  
Auxiliary Devices  
(Radio with CD)  
The auxiliary input allows portable  
devices to be connected using the  
3.5 mm (1/8 in) input jack or the  
optional USB port.  
Playback of an audio device that is  
connected to the 3.5 mm auxiliary  
input jack can only be controlled  
using the controls on the device.  
Genre: Saves the genre associated  
with the currently playing track in  
the indicated favorites position.  
Adjusting the Volume  
Portable devices are controlled by  
using the menu system described in  
Operation on page 67.  
Turn the VOL/ O knob to adjust the  
volume of the infotainment system  
after the volume level has been set  
on the portable audio device.  
Creating Playlists  
To create a playlist using tracks  
stored in MEM:  
1. Select Playlist from the MEM  
favorites.  
USB Port  
For vehicles with a USB port, the  
following devices may be connected  
and controlled by the infotainment  
system.  
2. Select the track to be stored in  
the playlist.  
3. Press and hold one of the  
1 to 6 buttons until the track  
can be heard again to store the  
track.  
.
iPod's  
.
PlaysForSure Devices (PFD)  
.
4. Repeat steps 1 though 3 to store  
additional tracks in the playlist.  
USB Drives  
.
Zune's  
The auxiliary input is located in the  
center console.  
Not all iPod's, PFD's, USB Drives,  
and Zune's are compatible with the  
infotainment system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-29  
To search for tracks:  
On: Repeats the current track.  
Off: Playback starts from the  
beginning of the current track after  
the last track finishes.  
Connecting and Controlling  
an iPod™  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
Not all iPod's can be controlled by  
the Infotainment System.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, Podcasts, Genres,  
Audiobooks, or Composers.  
Connecting and Controlling a  
PlaysForSure Device (PFD)  
or Zune™  
Connecting an iPod  
Connect the iPod to the USB port.  
4. Select the track.  
Searching For a Track  
Connecting a PFD or Zune  
Shuffle  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
Connect the PFD or Zune to the  
USB port.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Shuffle Songs (Random) to On or  
.
Playlists  
.
Artists  
Searching For a Track  
Off, then press the 0 BACK button  
to return the main screen.  
.
Albums  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
.
Song Titles  
On: Plays tracks in the current  
folder in random order.  
.
Playlists  
.
Podcasts  
.
Artists  
Off: Plays tracks in the current  
folder in sequential order.  
.
Genres  
.
Albums  
.
Audiobooks  
.
Song Titles  
Repeat  
.
Composers  
.
Podcasts  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Repeat to On or Off, then press the  
0 BACK button to return the main  
screen.  
.
Genres  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-30  
Infotainment System  
To search for tracks:  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
Connecting and Controlling a  
USB Drive  
.
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
Playlists*  
The infotainment system can only  
play back .mp3 and .wma files from  
a USB drive.  
.
.
.
.
.
Artists  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, Podcasts,  
or Genres.  
Albums  
Song Titles  
Genres  
Only the first 2,500 songs are  
recognized on the device.  
4. Select the track.  
When a device is not supported, the  
message No supported data found.  
You can safely disconnect the  
deviceappears.  
Folder View  
Shuffle Functionality  
*This only displays if a playlist is  
found on the device.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Shuffle Songs (Random) to On  
or Off.  
To search for tracks:  
Connecting a USB Drive  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
On: Plays current tracks in random  
order.  
Connect the USB drive to the  
USB port.  
Off: Plays current tracks in  
sequential order.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists, Albums,  
Song Titles, Genres,  
Searching For a Track  
It is normal for the search feature to  
take some time to display the  
information after reading the disc  
due to the amount of information  
stored on the disc.  
or Folder View.  
Repeat Functionality  
4. Select the track.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Repeat to On or Off.  
Repeat On: Repeats the current  
Files that do not have any meta  
data stored in the ID3 tag display as  
Unknown.  
track.  
Repeat Off: Playback starts from  
the beginning of the current track  
after the last track finishes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-31  
Shuffle Functionality  
3.5 mm Auxiliary Input Jack  
Auxiliary Devices (Radio  
with CD/DVD/MEM)  
The auxiliary input allows portable  
devices to be connected using the  
3.5 mm (1/8 in) input jack or the  
optional USB port.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Shuffle Songs (Random) to On  
or Off.  
Playback of an audio device that is  
connected to the 3.5 mm auxiliary  
input jack can only be controlled  
using the controls on the device.  
On: Plays current tracks in random  
order.  
Adjusting the Volume  
Off: Plays current tracks in  
sequential order.  
Portable devices are controlled by  
using the menu system described in  
Operation on page 67.  
Turn the VOL/ O knob to adjust the  
volume of the infotainment system  
after the volume level has been set  
on the portable audio device.  
Repeat Functionality  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Repeat to On or Off.  
USB Port  
Repeat On: Repeats the current  
track.  
The following devices may be  
connected to the USB port and  
controlled by the infotainment  
system.  
Repeat Off: Playback starts from  
the beginning of the current track  
after the last track finishes.  
.
iPod's  
.
USB Mass Storage Devices  
Not all iPod's or USB Mass Storage  
Devices are compatible with the  
infotainment system.  
The auxiliary input is located in the  
center console.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-32  
Infotainment System  
Searching For a Track  
Connecting and Controlling  
an iPod™  
Connecting and Controlling a  
USB Drive  
Tracks can be searched for by:  
Not all iPod's can be controlled by  
the Infotainment System.  
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Files that are not stored in folders  
are displayed in the root  
directory (USB).  
Playlists  
Artists  
Connecting an iPod  
Albums  
Connecting a USB Drive  
Connect the iPod to the USB port.  
Song Titles  
Genres  
Connect the USB drive to the  
USB port.  
Selecting a Track  
Using the control buttons:  
Composers  
Audiobooks  
Disconnecting a USB Drive  
.
Press g SEEK or l SEEK to  
select the previous or next track.  
A USB drive should be ejected from  
the USB port before disconnecting  
it. To eject a USB drive:  
The number of objects in each  
category is shown in parentheses  
after the category.  
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
select the track in the current  
sub menu. The track will start  
to play.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select USB Eject.  
To search for tracks:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
Playing Tracks in Random Order  
Playing Tracks in Random Order  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
then set Shuffle Songs to On.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and set  
Shuffle Songs to On or Off.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists,  
Albums, Song Titles, Genres,  
Composers, or Audiobooks.  
Shuffle On: Plays current tracks in  
random order.  
4. Select the track. The search rate  
increases if the MENU/SEL knob  
is continuously turned while  
searching in a list.  
Shuffle Off: Plays current tracks in  
sequential order.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-33  
Selecting a Track  
Tracks can be searched by:  
Rear Seat  
Infotainment  
.
Using the control buttons:  
Playlists  
.
.
Artists  
Press g SEEK or l SEEK to  
select the previous or next track.  
.
Rear Seat Entertainment  
(RSE) System  
Albums  
.
.
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
Song Titles  
select a track in the current sub  
menu. The track will start to play.  
.
The vehicle may have a DVD Rear  
Seat Entertainment (RSE) system.  
The RSE system works with the  
vehicle's infotainment system. The  
DVD player is part of the front radio.  
The RSE system includes a radio  
with a DVD player, two rear seat  
video display screens, audio/video  
jacks, two wireless headphones,  
and a remote control. See CD/DVD  
Player on page 621 or the  
Genres  
The number of objects in each  
category is shown in parentheses  
after the category.  
Selecting a track in a different  
folder:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Folder List.  
3. Select the folder.  
To search for tracks:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Search.  
4. Select the track.  
3. Select: Playlists, Artists,  
Albums, Song Titles, Genres,  
Composers, or Audiobooks.  
Searching for Tracks  
separate navigation system manual  
for more information on the vehicle's  
DVD system.  
It is normal for the search feature  
to take some time to display the  
information after reading the device  
due to the amount of information  
stored.  
4. Select the track. The search rate  
increases if the MENU/SEL knob  
is continuously turned while  
searching in a list.  
Files that do not have any meta  
data stored in the ID3 tag display  
as Unknown.  
Recording Tracks to MEM  
See Mass Storage Media (MEM) on  
page 625 for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-34  
Infotainment System  
On some infotainment systems, the  
Global Off feature can be turned off  
by performing one of the following:  
Before Driving  
Headphones  
The RSE is for rear seat  
passengers only. The driver cannot  
safely view the video screen while  
driving.  
RSE includes two 2-channel  
wireless headphones. Channel 1 is  
dedicated to the DVD player, and  
Channel 2 is dedicated to any  
external auxiliary device connected  
to the A/V jacks. The headphones  
are used to listen to various  
.
Press and hold the radio power  
button for more than  
three seconds.  
In severe or extreme weather  
conditions, the RSE system may not  
work until the temperature is within  
the operating range. The operating  
range is above 20°C (4°F)  
and below 60°C (140°F). If the  
temperature is outside of this range,  
heat or cool the vehicle until it is  
within the operating range.  
.
Insert or eject any disc.  
.
Insert a DVD video disc.  
multimedia. The wireless  
.
headphones have an On/Off button,  
channel 1/2 switch, and a volume  
control. Turn the headphones off  
when not in use.  
Press the Remote Control power  
button.  
.
Press the MEM/DVD/AUX button  
or the k button when a DVD  
video disc is in the player.  
Push the On/Off button to turn on  
the headphones. A light on the  
headphones comes on. If the light  
does not come on, check the  
batteries. Intermittent sound or static  
can also indicate weak batteries.  
See Battery Replacementlater in  
this section for more information.  
Global Off  
.
Press the SRC button on the  
steering wheel when a DVD  
video disc is in the player.  
Depending on the infotainment  
system, the RSE system may  
have a Global Off feature. The  
Global Off feature disables all RSE  
system features. Press and hold  
the radio power button for more  
than three seconds for Global Off  
to disable the RSE features.  
.
Cycle the ignition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-35  
Infrared transmitters are on the top  
of the left seatback video screen.  
The headphones shut off  
Notice: Do not store the  
Remove the batteries if the  
headphones are not going to be  
used for a long period of time.  
headphones in heat or direct  
sunlight. This could damage the  
headphones and repairs will not  
be covered by the warranty.  
Storage in extreme cold can  
weaken the batteries. Keep the  
headphones stored in a cool, dry  
place.  
automatically to save the battery  
power if the RSE system is shut  
off or if the headphones are out of  
range of the transmitters for more  
than three minutes. Moving too far  
forward or stepping out of the  
vehicle, can cause the headphones  
to lose the signal or have static.  
Audio/Video (A/V) Jacks  
If available, the A/V jacks are  
located on the rear of the floor  
console. They allow audio or video  
cables to be connected from an  
auxiliary device such as a  
If the foam ear pads become worn  
or damaged, they can be replaced  
separately from the headphones.  
See your dealer for more  
camcorder or a video game system.  
The headphones may automatically  
turn off after four hours of  
continuous use.  
The A/V jacks are color coded:  
.
Yellow for video input.  
information.  
.
White for left audio input.  
To adjust the volume on the  
headphones, use the volume  
control.  
Battery Replacement  
.
Red for right audio input.  
To change the batteries:  
Power for auxiliary devices is not  
supplied by the radio system.  
1. Loosen the screw to the battery  
door located on the left side of  
the headphones.  
For best audio performance, the  
headphones must be worn correctly,  
with the headband over the top of  
the head. L (Left) and R (Right)  
are above the ear pads and are  
indicators as to how the  
To use the auxiliary inputs of the  
RSE system:  
2. Slide the battery door open.  
1. Connect the auxiliary device  
cables to the A/V jacks.  
3. Replace the two AAA batteries.  
4. Replace the battery door and  
tighten the screw.  
headphones should be placed  
on the head.  
2. Power on both the auxiliary  
device and the RSE video  
screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-36  
Infotainment System  
Changing the Source on the Video  
Display Screens  
4. Press the AUX button a fourth  
time to change the source of  
both video screens to the DVD  
player.  
Audio Output  
Audio from the DVD player or  
auxiliary inputs can be heard  
through the following:  
The image from the auxiliary device  
can be switched between the video  
display screens.  
How to Change the RSE Video  
Screen Settings  
.
Wireless Headphones  
To change the display:  
.
Vehicle Speakers  
The screen display mode,  
brightness, and language can be  
changed from the setup menu using  
the remote control. To change a  
setting:  
1. Press the AUX button on the  
remote control to change the  
source of both video screens  
from the DVD player to the  
auxiliary device.  
The RSE system transmits the  
audio signal to the wireless  
headphones if an audio signal is  
available. See Headphonesearlier  
in this section for more information.  
1. Press z.  
2. Press the AUX button a second  
time to change the left video  
screen source to the DVD player  
and the right video screen to the  
auxiliary device.  
The front seat passengers are able  
to listen to playback from the A/V  
jacks through the vehicle speakers  
by selecting Rear A/V as the source  
on the radio.  
2. Use n, q, p, o and r to  
select the settings.  
3. Press z again to exit the  
3. Press the AUX button a third  
time to change the left video  
screen source to the auxiliary  
device and the right video  
screen to the DVD player.  
setup menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
Video Screen Input Jack  
6-37  
Push the video screen down into its  
locked position when it is not in use,  
the screen turns off automatically.  
Video Screens  
The video screens are located in the  
back of the driver and front  
passenger seats.  
Each video screen is equipped with  
a video input jack to allow video  
cables to be connected from an  
auxiliary device such as a  
camcorder or a video game system.  
This signal will override any video  
provided by the RSE system; either  
the DVD or Auxiliary A/V jack  
source. The RSE system must be  
on for this input to operate.  
Only the left RSE seatback console  
contains the infrared transmitters for  
the wireless headphones, they may  
be visible as eight illuminated LEDs.  
These LEDs are not on the right  
video screen. Both seatback  
consoles contain an infrared  
receiver for the remote control.  
They are located at the top of each  
console.  
Remote Control  
To use the remote control, aim it at  
the transmitter window at either  
seatback console and press the  
button. Direct sunlight or very bright  
light could affect the ability of the  
RSE transmitter to receive signals  
from the remote control. Check the  
batteries if the remote control does  
not seem to be working. See  
Battery Replacementlater in this  
section. Objects blocking the line of  
sight could also affect the function  
of the remote control.  
Notice: Avoid directly touching  
the video screen, as damage may  
occur. See Cleaning the Video  
Screenlater in this section for  
more information.  
To use the video screen:  
1. Push the release button located  
on the seatback console.  
2. Move the screen to the desired  
viewing position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-38  
Infotainment System  
If a CD, DVD, or MP3 disc is in the  
Radio DVD slot, the remote control  
O button can be used to turn on the  
video screen display and start the  
disc. The infotainment system can  
also turn on the video screen  
display. See CD/DVD Player on  
page 621 or the separate  
v (Title): Press to return to the  
main menu of the DVD. This  
function could vary for each disc.  
c (Stop): Press to stop playing,  
rewinding, or fast forwarding a DVD.  
Press twice to return to the  
beginning of the DVD.  
y (Main Menu): Press to access  
the DVD menu. The DVD menu is  
different on every DVD. Use the  
navigation arrows to move the  
cursor. After making a selection  
press the enter button. This button  
only operates when using a DVD.  
s (Play/Pause): Press to start  
playing a DVD. Press to pause a  
DVD while it is playing. Press again  
to continue playing.  
navigation system manual for  
more information.  
Depending on the infotainment  
system in the vehicle, DVD  
playback may be slowed down by  
Notice: Storing the remote  
control in a hot area or in direct  
sunlight can damage it, and the  
repairs will not be covered by the  
warranty. Storage in extreme cold  
can weaken the batteries. Keep  
the remote control stored in a  
cool, dry place.  
n, q , p , o (Menu Navigation  
Arrows): Use the arrow buttons to  
navigate through a menu.  
pressing s then [. Reverse slow  
play by pressing s then r. Press  
s again to cancel slow play.  
r (Enter): Press to select the  
highlighted choice in any menu.  
t (Previous Track/Chapter):  
Press to go to the start of the  
current track or chapter. Press again  
to go to the previous track or  
chapter. This button may not work  
when the DVD is playing the  
copyright information or the  
previews.  
z (Display Menu): Press to adjust  
the brightness, screen display  
mode, and display the  
Remote Control Buttons  
language menu.  
O (Power): Press to turn the  
q (Return): Press to exit the  
current active menu and return to  
the previous menu. This button  
operates only when the display  
menu or a DVD menu is active.  
video screens on and off.  
P (Illumination): Press to turn the  
remote control backlight on. The  
backlight times out after several  
seconds if no other button is  
pressed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-39  
u (Next Track/Chapter): Press to  
go to the beginning of the next  
chapter or track. This button might  
not work when the DVD is playing  
the copyright information or the  
previews.  
e (Audio): Press to change audio  
tracks on DVDs that have this  
feature when the DVD is playing.  
} 10 (Double Digit Entries)  
(If Available): Press this button to  
select chapter or track numbers  
greater than 9. Press this button  
before inputting the number.  
{ (Subtitles): Press to turn  
ON/OFF subtitles and to move  
through subtitle options when a  
DVD is playing.  
1 through 0 (Numeric Keypad):  
The numbered keypad provides the  
capability of direct chapter or track  
number selection.  
r (Fast Reverse): Press to  
quickly reverse the DVD or CD. To  
stop fast reversing a DVD video,  
AUX (Auxiliary): Press to switch  
the video display between the DVD  
player and an auxiliary source.  
press s. To stop fast reversing a  
Replacing the Remote Control  
DVD audio or CD, release r. This  
button might not work when the  
DVD is playing the copyright  
information or the previews.  
d (Camera): Press to change the  
camera angle on DVDs that have  
this feature when the DVD is  
playing.  
If the remote control becomes lost  
or damaged, a new universal  
remote control can be purchased.  
Use a Toshiba® code set for  
replacement universal remote  
controls.  
[ (Fast Forward): Press to fast  
\ (Clear) (If Available): Press this  
button within three seconds after  
inputting a numeric selection, to  
clear all numeric inputs.  
forward the DVD or CD. To stop fast  
forwarding a DVD video, press s.  
To stop fast forwarding a DVD audio  
or CD, release [. This button might  
not work when the DVD is playing  
the copyright information or the  
previews.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-40  
Infotainment System  
Battery Replacement  
Tips and Troubleshooting Chart  
Problem Recommended Action  
To change the remote control  
batteries:  
No power.  
The ignition might not be turned to  
ON/RUN or in ACC/ACCESSORY.  
1. Slide back the rear cover on the  
remote control.  
The picture does not fill the screen. Check the display mode settings in  
2. Replace the two batteries in the  
compartment.  
There are black borders on the top  
and bottom or on both sides or it  
looks stretched out.  
the setup menu by pressing the  
display menu button on the remote  
control.  
3. Replace the battery cover.  
Remove the batteries from the  
remote control if unused for an  
extended period of time.  
In auxiliary mode, the picture moves Check the auxiliary input  
or scrolls.  
connections at both devices.  
The remote control does not work.  
Check to make sure there is no  
obstruction between the remote  
control and the transmitter window.  
Check the batteries to make sure  
they are not dead or installed  
incorrectly.  
After stopping the player, I push  
If the stop button was pressed one  
Play but sometimes the DVD starts time, the DVD player resumes  
where I left off and sometimes at the playing where the DVD was  
beginning.  
stopped. If the stop button was  
pressed two times the DVD player  
begins to play from the beginning of  
the DVD.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-41  
DVD Display Error Messages  
Tips and Troubleshooting Chart (cont'd)  
The DVD display error message  
depends on which radio the vehicle  
has. The video screen may display  
one of the following:  
Problem  
Recommended Action  
The auxiliary source is running but  
there is no picture or sound.  
Check that the RSE video screen is  
in the auxiliary source mode by  
pressing the AUX button on the  
remote control.  
Check the auxiliary input  
connections at both devices.  
Disc Load/Eject Error or  
Mechanical Error: There are disc  
load or eject problems.  
Disc Format Error or Unknown  
Format: The disc is inserted with  
the disc label wrong side up, or if  
the disc is damaged.  
Sometimes the wireless headphone Check for obstructions, low  
audio cuts out or buzzes.  
batteries, reception range, and  
interference from cellular telephone  
towers or by using a cellular  
telephone in the vehicle.  
Disc Region Error or Disc Error:  
The disc is not from a correct  
region.  
Check that the headphones are on  
correctly using the L (left) and R  
(right) on the headphones.  
Check that the headphones are  
positioned properly with the  
headband across the top of  
the head.  
No Disc Inserted: No disc is  
present when the Z EJECT or  
MEM/DVD/AUX button is pressed  
on the radio.  
I lost the remote and/or the  
headphones.  
See your dealer for assistance.  
The DVD is playing, but there is no Check that the RSE video screen is  
picture or sound.  
sourced to the DVD player by  
pressing the AUX button on the  
remote control.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-42  
Infotainment System  
Steering Wheel Controls  
DVD Distortion  
Phone  
b / g (Push To Talk): Press to  
answer incoming calls, to confirm  
system information, and to start  
voice recognition.  
Video distortion can occur when  
operating cellular phones, scanners,  
CB radios, Global Position Systems  
(GPS)*, two-way radios, mobile fax,  
or walkie talkies.  
Bluetooth (Overview)  
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system  
can use a Bluetooth capable cell  
phone with a HandsFree Profile to  
make and receive phone calls. The  
infotainment system and voice  
recognition are used to control the  
system. The system can be used  
while the ignition is in ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY. The range of  
the Bluetooth system can be up to  
9.1 m (30 ft.). Not all phones support  
all functions and not all phones work  
with the Bluetooth system. See  
www.gm.com/bluetooth for more  
information about compatible  
phones.  
$ / c (Mute/End Call): Press to  
end a call, reject a call, or to cancel  
an operation.  
It might be necessary to turn off the  
DVD player when operating one of  
these devices in or near the vehicle.  
*Excludes the OnStar® System.  
Infotainment System Controls  
For information about how to  
navigate the menu system using the  
infotainment controls, see Operation  
Cleaning the RSE Seatback  
Console  
on page 67  
.
Use only a clean cloth dampened  
with clean water to clean the RSE  
seatback console surface.  
5 (Phone): Press to enter the  
Phone main menu.  
Voice Recognition  
Cleaning the Video Screen  
The voice recognition system uses  
commands to control the system  
and dial phone numbers.  
Use only a clean cloth dampened  
with clean water. Use care when  
touching or cleaning the screen as  
damage could result.  
Bluetooth Controls  
Use the buttons located on the  
infotainment system and the  
steering wheel to operate the  
Bluetooth system.  
Noise: The system may not  
recognize voice commands if there  
is too much background noise.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-43  
When to Speak: A tone sounds to  
indicate that the system is ready for  
a voice command. Wait for the tone  
and then speak.  
Pairing Information:  
Bluetooth (Infotainment  
Controls)  
For information about how to  
navigate the menu system using the  
infotainment controls, see Operation  
.
Up to five cell phones can be  
paired to the Bluetooth system.  
.
.
The pairing process is disabled  
when the vehicle is moving.  
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a  
calm and natural voice.  
on page 67  
.
The Bluetooth system links with  
the first available paired cell  
phone in the order the phone  
was paired.  
Audio System  
Pairing  
When using the Bluetooth system,  
sound comes through the vehicle's  
front audio system speakers and  
overrides the audio system. Use the  
A Bluetooth enabled cell phone  
must be paired to the Bluetooth  
system first and then connected to  
the vehicle before it can be used.  
See the cell phone manufacturer  
user guide for Bluetooth functions  
before pairing the cell phone. If a  
Bluetooth phone is not connected,  
calls will be made using OnStar®  
HandsFree Calling, if available.  
Refer to the OnStar Owner's Guide  
for more information.  
.
.
Only one paired cell phone can  
be connected to the Bluetooth  
system at a time.  
VOL/ O knob during a call to  
change the volume level. The  
adjusted volume level remains in  
memory for later calls. The system  
maintains a minimum volume level.  
Pairing should only need to be  
completed once, unless changes  
to the pairing information have  
been made or the phone is  
deleted.  
Other Information  
The Bluetooth® word mark and  
To link to a different paired phone,  
see Linking to a Different Phone”  
later in this section.  
logos are owned by the Bluetooth®  
SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks  
by General Motors is under license.  
Other trademarks and trade names  
are those of their respective owners.  
The pairing process can be started  
by using the voice recognition  
system or the controls on the  
infotainment system.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on  
page 1216 for FCC information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-44  
Infotainment System  
Pairing a Phone  
Locate the device named  
Deleting a Paired Phone  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Phone Settings.  
3. Select Bluetooth.  
General Motorsin the list on  
the cell phone and follow the  
instructions on the cell phone to  
enter the four digit PIN number  
provided by the system.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Phone Settings.  
3. Select Bluetooth.  
4. Select Pair Device (Phone).  
A four digit PIN number appears  
on the display.  
4. Select Device List.  
6. The system prompts for a name  
for the phone and confirms the  
name provided. This name is  
used to indicate which phone is  
connected.  
5. Select the phone to delete and  
follow the on screen prompts.  
If the Add new GPS device”  
option is selected, the system  
will start a search for Bluetooth  
Handsfreeprofile devices just  
like if Add new Phonewas  
selected . The additional GPS  
location feature which would  
provide the vehicle's GPS  
location through the Bluetooth  
Serial Port Profile is not  
Linking to a Different Phone  
To link to a different phone, the new  
phone must be in the vehicle and  
available to be connected to the  
bluetooth system before the process  
is started.  
7. The system responds with  
<Phone name> has been  
successfully pairedafter the  
pairing process is complete.  
8. Repeat Steps 1 through 7 to pair  
additional phones.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Phone Settings.  
3. Select Bluetooth.  
Listing All Paired and Connected  
Phones  
available.  
5. Start the pairing process on the  
cell phone that will be paired to  
the vehicle. Reference the cell  
phone manufacturers user guide  
for information on this process.  
4. Select Device List.  
1. Press the CONFIG button.  
2. Select Phone Settings.  
3. Select Bluetooth.  
5. Select the new phone to link to  
and follow the on screen  
prompts.  
4. Select Device List.  
If delete is selected, the  
highlighted phone will be  
deleted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-45  
Declining a Call  
Making a Call  
Accepting or Declining a Call  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
Decline and press the MENU/  
SEL knob.  
When a call is received, the  
infotainment system mutes and a  
ring tone is heard in the vehicle.  
Radio with CD  
1. Press the 5 / 0 button.  
2. Enter the character sequence.  
See Entering a Character  
Switching Between Calls (Call  
Waiting Calls Only)  
Accepting a Call  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
Answer and press the MENU/  
SEL knob.  
Sequencein Operation on  
page 67 for more information.  
To switch between calls:  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
3. Select Call to start dialing the  
number.  
Declining a Call  
2. Select Switch Call from  
the menu.  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
Decline and press the MENU/  
SEL knob.  
Radio with CD/DVD and MEM  
Conference Calling  
1. Press the 5 / 0 button.  
Conference calling and three way  
calling must be supported on the  
bluetooth phone and enabled by the  
wireless service carrier to work.  
2. Select Enter number.  
Call Waiting  
3. Enter the character sequence.  
See Entering a Character  
Call waiting must be supported on  
the bluetooth phone and enabled by  
the wireless service carrier to work.  
Sequencein Operation on  
page 67 for more information.  
To start a conference while in a  
current call:  
Accepting a Call  
4. Select Call to start dialing the  
number.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob.  
2. Select Enter Number.  
Turn the MENU/SEL knob to  
Answer and press the MENU/  
SEL knob.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-46  
Infotainment System  
3. Enter the character sequence  
then select Call. See Entering a  
Character Sequencein  
Muting a Call  
To Mute a Call  
Bluetooth (Voice  
Recognition)  
Operation on page 67 for  
more information.  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
select Mute Call.  
Pairing  
A Bluetooth cell phone must be  
paired to the Bluetooth system and  
then connected to the vehicle before  
it can be used. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for  
Bluetooth functions before pairing  
the cell phone. If a Bluetooth phone  
is not connected, calls will be made  
using OnStar® HandsFree Calling,  
if available. Refer to the OnStar  
owner's guide for more information.  
4. After the call has been placed,  
press the MENU/SEL knob and  
choose Merge Calls.  
To Cancel Mute  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
select Mute Call.  
5. To add more callers to the  
conference call, repeat Steps 1  
through 4. The amount of callers  
that can be added are limited by  
your wireless service carrier.  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency  
(DTMF) Tones  
The invehicle Bluetooth system can  
send numbers during a call. This is  
used when calling a menu driven  
phone system.  
Ending a Call  
Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
select Hang Up.  
The pairing process can be started  
by using the voice recognition  
system or the controls on the  
infotainment system.  
1. Press the MENU/SEL knob and  
select Enter Number.  
2. Enter the character sequence,  
see Entering a Character  
Sequencein Operation on  
page 67 for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-47  
Pairing Information:  
Pairing a Phone  
4. Start the pairing process on the  
cell phone that will be paired to  
the vehicle. Reference the cell  
phone manufacturers user guide  
for information on this process.  
.
Up to five cell phones can be  
1. Press b / g.  
paired to the Bluetooth system.  
.
For vehicles without a  
.
The pairing process is disabled  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
when the vehicle is moving.  
Locate the device named  
.
The Bluetooth system links with  
General Motorsin the list on  
the cell phone and follow the  
instructions on the cell phone to  
enter the fourdigit PIN number  
that was provided in Step 3.  
the first available paired cell  
phone in the order the phone  
was paired.  
.
For vehicles with a  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
.
Only one paired cell phone can  
be connected to the Bluetooth  
system at a time.  
5. The system prompts for a name  
for the phone. This name will be  
used to indicate which phone is  
connected. The system confirms  
the name.  
.
Pairing only needs to be  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system  
responds Bluetooth ready,  
followed by a tone.  
completed once, unless the  
pairing information changes or  
the phone is deleted.  
6. The system responds with  
<Phone name> has been  
successfully pairedafter the  
pairing process is complete.  
3. Say Pair. The system responds  
with instructions and a fourdigit  
PIN number. The PIN number  
will be used in Step 4.  
To link to a different paired phone,  
see Linking to a Different Phone  
later in this section.  
7. Repeat Steps 1 through 7 for  
additional phones to be paired.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-48  
Infotainment System  
Listing All Paired and Connected  
Phones  
Deleting a Paired Phone  
4. Say the name of the phone to be  
deleted. If the phone name is  
unknown, use the List”  
1. Press b / g.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
command for a list of all paired  
phones. The system responds  
Would you like to delete <phone  
name>? Yes or No, followed by  
a tone.  
For vehicles without a  
.
For vehicles without a  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
.
For vehicles with a  
.
5. Say Yesto delete the phone.  
The system responds OK,  
deleting <phone name>.  
For vehicles with a  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
Linking to a Different Phone  
1. Press b / g.  
.
2. Say Bluetooth. The system  
responds Bluetooth ready,  
followed by a tone.  
For vehicles without a  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system  
responds Bluetooth ready,  
followed by a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
3. Say Delete. The system asks  
which phone to delete followed  
by a tone.  
.
3. Say List. The system lists all  
the paired Bluetooth devices.  
The system will respond is  
connectedif a phone is  
For vehicles with a  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
connected to the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-49  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system  
responds Bluetooth ready,  
followed by a tone.  
Using the Store Command  
3. Say the complete phone number  
to be stored at once with no  
pauses.  
The store command allows a phone  
number to be stored without  
entering the digits individually.  
.
3. Say Change phone. The  
system responds Please wait  
while I search for other phones.  
If the system recognizes  
the number, the response is  
OK, Storing.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
For vehicles without a  
.
.
If another phone is found,  
If the system does not  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
the response will be  
<Phone name> is now  
connected.  
recognize the phone  
number, the response is  
Store <Phone number>.  
Please say yes or no.  
If the number is correct, say  
Yes. If the number is not  
correct, say No. The  
system will ask for the  
number again.  
.
For vehicles with a  
.
If another phone is not  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
found, the original phone  
remains connected.  
Storing Name Tags  
The system can store up to thirty  
phone numbers as name tags that  
are shared between the Bluetooth  
and OnStar systems.  
4. After the system stores the  
phone number, it responds  
Please say the name tag,  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Store. The system  
responds Store, number  
please, followed by a tone.  
The system uses the following  
commands to store and retrieve  
phone numbers:  
.
Store  
.
Digit Store  
.
Directory  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-50  
Infotainment System  
.
For vehicles with a  
5. Say a name tag for the phone  
number. The name tag is  
recorded and the system  
responds About to store  
<name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?.  
4. After the complete number has  
been entered, say Store. The  
system responds Please say  
the name tag, followed by  
a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
5. Say a name tag for the phone  
number. The name tag is  
.
If the name tag does not  
2. Say Digit Store. The system  
responds with Please say the  
first digit to store, followed by  
a tone.  
sound correct, say No”  
and repeat Step 5.  
recorded and the system  
responds About to store <name  
tag>. Does that sound OK?.  
.
If the name tag sounds  
.
correct, say Yesand the  
name tag is stored. After  
the number is stored the  
system returns to the  
main menu.  
If the name tag does not  
3. Say the first digit to be stored.  
The system will repeat back the  
digit it heard followed by a tone.  
Continue entering digits until the  
number to be stored is complete.  
sound correct, say Noand  
repeat Step 5.  
.
If the name tag sounds  
correct, say Yesand the  
name tag is stored. After  
the number is stored the  
system returns to the  
main menu.  
Using the Digit Store Command  
.
If an unwanted number is  
The digit store command allows a  
phone number to be stored by  
entering the digits individually.  
recognized by the system,  
say Clearat any time to  
clear the last number.  
.
To hear all of the numbers  
recognized by the system,  
say Verifyat any time.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
For vehicles without a  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-51  
Using the Directory Command  
2. Say Delete. The system  
Deleting Name Tags  
responds Delete, please say  
the name tag, followed by  
a tone.  
The directory command lists all of  
the name tags stored by the system.  
To use the directory command:  
The system uses the following  
commands to delete name tags:  
.
Delete  
3. Say the name tag to be deleted.  
The system responds Would  
you like to delete, <name tag>?  
Please say yes or no.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
Delete all name tags  
.
For vehicles without a  
Using the Delete Command  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
The delete command is used to  
delete specific name tags.  
.
If the name tag is correct,  
say Yesto delete the  
name tag. The system  
responds with OK, deleting  
<name tag>, returning to  
the main menu.”  
.
To delete name tags:  
For vehicles with a  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
For vehicles without a  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
.
If the name tag is incorrect,  
say No. The system  
responds with No. OK, let's  
try again, please say the  
name tag.”  
.
For vehicles with a  
2. Say Directory. The system  
responds Directoryand lists all  
stored name tags. The system  
returns to the main menu when  
the list is complete.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-52  
Infotainment System  
Using the Delete All Name Tags  
Command  
2. Say Delete all name tags. The  
system responds You are about  
to delete all name tags stored in  
your phone directory and your  
route destination directory. Are  
you sure you want to do this?  
Please say yes or no.”  
Using the Dial Command  
1. Press b / g.  
The Delete All Name Tags  
.
For vehicles without a  
command deletes all stored phone  
book name tags and route name  
tags for OnStar, if stored.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
To delete all name tags:  
.
.
Say Yesto delete all  
For vehicles with a  
name tags.  
1. Press b / g.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
.
.
Say Noto cancel the  
For vehicles without a  
function and return to the  
main menu.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
Making a Call  
.
For vehicles with a  
Calls can be made using the  
following commands:  
2. Say Dial. The system responds  
Dial using <phone name>.  
Number please, followed by  
a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
.
Dial  
.
Digit Dial  
.
Call  
.
Redial  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-53  
3. Say the entire number without  
pausing.  
Using the Digit Dial Command  
3. Say the digits to be dialed one at  
a time. The system repeats back  
the digit it heard followed by  
a tone.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
If the system recognizes  
.
For vehicles without a  
the number, it responds  
with OK, Dialingand dials  
the number.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
4. Continue entering digits until the  
number to be dialed is complete.  
After the whole number has  
been entered, say Dial. The  
system responds OK, Dialing”  
and dials the number.  
.
If the system does not  
.
For vehicles with a  
recognize the number, it  
confirms the numbers  
followed by a tone. If the  
number is correct, say  
Yes. The system responds  
OK, Dialingand dials the  
number. If the number is  
not correct, say No. The  
system will ask for the  
number again.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
.
If an unwanted number is  
recognized by the system,  
say Clearat any time to  
clear the last number.  
2. Say Digit Dial. The system  
responds Digit dial using  
<phone name>, please say the  
first digit to dial, followed by  
a tone.  
.
To hear all of the numbers  
recognized by the system,  
say Verifyat any time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-54  
Infotainment System  
Using the Call Command  
3. Say the name tag of the person  
to call.  
Using the Redial Command  
1. Press b / g.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
If the system recognizes  
.
.
For vehicles without a  
For vehicles without a  
the name tag it responds  
OK, calling, <name tag>”  
and dials the number.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
.
If the system does not  
.
.
For vehicles with a  
For vehicles with a  
recognize the name tag, it  
confirms the name tag  
followed by a tone. If the  
name tag is correct, say  
Yes. The system responds  
with OK, calling, <name  
tag>and dials the number.  
If the name tag is not  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds with Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Call. The system responds  
Call using <phone name>.  
Please say the name tag,  
followed by a tone.  
2. After the tone, say Redial. The  
system responds Redial using  
<phone name>and dials the  
last number called from the  
correct, say No. The  
system will ask for the  
name tag again.  
connected Bluetooth phone.  
Once connected, the person called  
will be heard through the audio  
speakers.  
Once connected, the person called  
will be heard through the audio  
speakers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
Muting a Call  
6-55  
Receiving a Call  
ThreeWay Calling  
When an incoming call is received,  
the audio system mutes and a ring  
tone is heard in the vehicle.  
Threeway calling must be  
supported on the Bluetooth phone  
and enabled by the wireless service  
carrier.  
During a call, all sounds from inside  
the vehicle can be muted so that the  
person on the other end of the call  
cannot hear them.  
.
Press b g to answer the call.  
To Mute a call  
1. While on a call, press b g. The  
system responds with Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
.
Press c / $ to ignore a call.  
1. Press b g. The system  
responds Ready, followed by  
a tone.  
Call Waiting  
2. Say Threeway call.  
The system responds with  
Threeway call, please say  
dial or call.  
Call waiting must be supported on  
the Bluetooth phone and enabled by  
the wireless service carrier.  
2. Say Mute Call. The system  
responds Call muted.  
.
Press b g to answer an  
incoming call when another call  
is active. The original call is  
placed on hold.  
To Cancel Mute  
3. Use the dial or call command to  
dial the number of the third party  
to be called.  
1. Press b g. The system  
responds Ready, followed by  
a tone.  
4. Once the call is connected,  
.
Press b g again to return to the  
original call.  
press b g to link all the callers  
together.  
2. After the tone, say Mute Call.  
The system responds  
.
To ignore the incoming call, no  
Resuming call.  
Ending a Call  
action is required.  
Press c / $ to end a call.  
.
Press c / $ to disconnect the  
current call and switch to the call  
on hold.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-56  
Infotainment System  
For vehicles without a navigation  
To access contacts stored in the cell  
phone:  
Transferring a Call  
system, press b g during a call  
with the audio on the cell phone,  
the audio transfers to the vehicle.  
Audio can be transferred between  
the invehicle Bluetooth system and  
the cell phone.  
1. Press b / g.  
.
For vehicles without a  
For vehicles with a navigation  
To Transfer Audio to the Cell  
Phone  
navigation system, the  
system responds Ready,  
followed by a tone.  
system, press b g during a call  
with the audio on the cell phone.  
If the audio does not transfer to the  
vehicle, use the audio transfer  
feature on the cell phone. See the  
cell phone manufacturers user guide  
for more information.  
During a call with the audio in the  
vehicle:  
.
For vehicles with a  
navigation system, the  
system responds with a  
tone. After the tone say  
Hands Free. The system  
responds Ready, followed  
by a tone.  
1. Press b g. The system  
responds Ready, followed by  
a tone.  
2. Say Transfer Call.The system  
responds Transferring calland  
the audio transfers to the cell  
phone.  
Voice Pass-Thru  
Voice passthru allows access to the  
voice recognition commands on the  
cell phone. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide to see if  
the cell phone supports this feature.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system  
responds Bluetooth ready,  
followed by a tone.  
To Transfer Audio to the In-Vehicle  
Bluetooth System  
3. Say Voice. The system  
responds OK, accessing  
<phone name>.  
The cell phone must be paired  
and connected with the Bluetooth  
system before a call can be  
transferred. The connection process  
can take up to two minutes after the  
ignition is turned to ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY.  
.
The cell phone's normal  
prompt messages will go  
through its cycle according  
to the phone's operating  
instructions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-57  
.
.
If the system does not  
recognize the number, it  
responds Dial Number,  
please say yes or no?,  
followed by a tone. If the  
number is correct, say  
Yes. The system responds  
OK, Sending Numberand  
the dial tones are sent and  
the call continues.  
If the system does not  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency  
(DTMF) Tones  
recognize the name tag, it  
responds Dial <name tag>,  
please say yes or no?,  
followed by a tone. If the  
name tag is correct, say  
Yes. The system responds  
with OK, Sending <name  
tag>and the dial tones are  
sent and the call continues.  
The invehicle Bluetooth system can  
send numbers and the numbers  
stored as name tags during a call.  
Use this feature when calling a  
menu driven phone system. Account  
numbers can also be stored for use.  
Sending a Number During a Call  
Sending a Stored Name Tag  
During a Call  
Clearing the System  
1. Press b g. The system  
responds Ready, followed by  
a tone.  
Unless information is deleted out of  
the invehicle Bluetooth system, it  
will be retained indefinitely. This  
includes all saved name tags in the  
phone book and phone pairing  
information. For information on how  
to delete this information, see the  
previous sections on Deleting a  
Paired Phone and Deleting  
1. Press b g. The system  
responds Ready, followed by  
a tone.  
2. Say Dial. The system responds  
Say a number to send tones,  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Send name tag.The  
system responds Say a name  
tag to send tones, followed by  
a tone.  
3. Say the number to send.  
.
If the system recognizes  
the number, it responds  
OK, Sending Numberand  
the dial tones are sent and  
the call continues.  
Name Tags.  
3. Say the name tag to send.  
.
If the system recognizes  
the number, it responds  
OK, Sending <name tag>”  
and the dial tones are sent  
and the call continues.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-58  
Infotainment System  
The pairing process can be started  
by using the voice recognition  
system or the controls on the  
infotainment system.  
Pairing a Phone  
Bluetooth (Navigation)  
1. Press the CONFIG hard key  
repeatedly until the Phone menu  
is shown or touch the Phone tab  
on the screen.  
For information about how to  
navigate the menu system using  
the infotainment controls, see  
Overviewunder Introduction,  
in the Navigation supplement.  
Pairing Information:  
.
Up to five cell phones can be  
paired to the Bluetooth system.  
Bluetooth Pairing  
.
The pairing process is disabled  
when the vehicle is moving.  
To make calls with a Bluetooth cell  
phone through your vehicle, it must  
be paired to the vehicle's Bluetooth  
system first and then connected to  
the vehicle before it can be used.  
Refer to the cell phone  
.
The Bluetooth system links with  
the first available paired cell  
phone based on the order  
shown in the device list.  
manufacturer's user guide for  
Bluetooth pairing instructions. If a  
Bluetooth phone is off or not  
.
Only one paired cell phone can  
be connected to the vehicle's  
Bluetooth system at a time.  
connected, calls will automatically  
.
be made using the OnStar®  
Pairing should only need to be  
2. Select the Bluetooth submenu.  
completed once, unless changes  
to the pairing information have  
been made or the phone is  
deleted.  
HandsFree Calling feature,  
if available. Refer to the OnStar  
owner's guide for more information  
about OnStar Hands-Free Calling.  
To link to a different paired phone,  
see Linking to a Different Phone”  
later in this section.  
A Bluetooth phone with MP3  
capability cannot be connected to  
the vehicle as a phone and an MP3  
player at the same time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-59  
location through the Bluetooth  
Serial Port Profile is not  
available.  
system voice prompt then  
repeats the name you provided  
for confirmation, say Yes.  
5. The system responds with  
phone name has been  
successfully pairedafter the  
pairing process is complete.  
Listing All Paired and Connected  
Phones  
1. Press the CONFIG hard key  
repeatedly until the Phone menu  
is shown or touch the Phone tab  
displayed on the screen.  
3. Select Add New Phone, the  
pairing process will begin  
searching for Bluetooth devices  
on your cellular phone. See the  
cell phone manufacturer's user  
guide for information on this  
process.  
On the cell phone, locate the  
device named General Motors.  
Follow the instructions given on  
the cell phone or follow the voice  
prompts, to enter the four digit  
PIN number that has been  
provided.  
If the Add new GPS device”  
option is selected, the system  
will start a search for Bluetooth  
Handsfreeprofile devices just  
like if you had selected Add  
new Phone. The additional GPS  
location feature which would  
provide the vehicle's GPS  
4. The system voice prompt  
requests that you say the name  
you want used for the phone that  
is being paired. Use a name that  
best describes the phone. The  
2. Select the Bluetooth submenu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-60  
Infotainment System  
Deleting a Paired Phone  
1. Press the CONFIG hard key  
repeatedly until the Phone menu  
is shown or touch the Phone tab  
on the screen.  
3. Select the Device List submenu.  
A list of all previously paired phones  
will be displayed. If there is a  
currently connected phone, a check  
mark will appear on the right side of  
the Phone name.  
2. Select the Bluetooth submenu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-61  
3. Select the Device List submenu.  
4. Select the phone to be deleted  
and then follow the on screen  
prompts to delete the device  
from the system.  
5. Once a phone has been deleted,  
the only way to connect back to  
that phone is to pair the phone  
again. See Bluetooth Pairing”  
earlier before the process is  
started.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-62  
Infotainment System  
Linking to a Different Phone  
In order to link to a different phone,  
the new phone must be in the  
vehicle and available to be  
connected to the Bluetooth system  
before the process is started.  
1. Press the CONFIG hard key  
repeatedly until the Phone menu  
is shown or touch the Phone tab  
on the screen.  
3. Select the Device List submenu.  
4. Select the phone to be linked  
and then follow the on screen  
prompts.  
2. Select the Bluetooth submenu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-63  
Making a Call  
Press 5 located on the faceplate of  
the infotainment system, to access  
the phone menu.  
5. The Phone menu will be  
displayed with the name of the  
phone linked.  
2. Enter the desired number by  
touching the appropriate buttons  
on the screen or using the  
rotary knob.  
3. Press the CALL button to make  
the call.  
Enter Number  
Accepting or Declining an  
Incoming Call  
Use this option to enter a phone  
number and make a call. To do this:  
1. Press the Enter Number  
selection. A dial pad displays on  
the Navigation screen.  
When an incoming call is received,  
the infotainment system mutes any  
audio being played and sounds a  
ring tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-64  
Infotainment System  
Accepting a Call  
Call Waiting  
Conference Calling  
Call waiting must be supported on  
the Bluetooth phone and enabled by  
the wireless service carrier to work.  
Conference and three-way calling  
must be supported on the Bluetooth  
phone and enabled by the wireless  
service carrier to work.  
Press b g on the steering wheel  
control to answer the incoming call  
or touch the Answer option to  
answer the call.  
Switching Calls (Only Available  
with Call Waiting)  
To start a conference while in a  
current call:  
This feature allows you to switch  
between calls, making one call  
active and placing the other on hold.  
1. Press the 5 hard key on the  
faceplate until the Phone main  
screen is shown with the current  
active call.  
Declining a Call  
Press c / $ on the steering wheel  
controls or select the Decline option  
to decline the call.  
Switch Call: Turn or press the  
menu select knob to Switch Call”  
and press Enter or touch the  
Switch Calloption.  
2. Select the Enter Number”  
option.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infotainment System  
6-65  
Ending a Call  
Mute or UnMute a Call  
1. Press the 5 hard key.  
2. Select the Mute call option to  
mute the call.  
3. Select the Mute call option again  
to unmute the call.  
3. Make another call. The first call  
will be placed on hold while the  
second call is dialing and  
connected.  
1. Press the 5 hard key.  
2. Select Hang Up.  
4. To make a conference call,  
select the Merge Callsoption  
which will merge both calls into  
one conference call.  
5. To add more callers to the  
conference call, repeat Steps 2  
through 4. The amount of callers  
that can be added are limited by  
your wireless service carrier.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-66  
Infotainment System  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency  
(DTMF) Tones  
The in-vehicle Bluetooth system can  
send numbers during a call, this is  
used when calling a menu driven  
phone system.  
2. Select Enter Numberoption  
1. Press the 5 hard key.  
and enter the number sequence.  
The DTMF Tones will be generated  
on the network as you enter each  
number.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
7-1  
Climate Control Systems  
The vehicle's heating, cooling, defrosting, and ventilation can be controlled  
with this system.  
Climate Controls  
Climate Control Systems  
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . 7-1  
Automatic Climate Control  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Air Vents  
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Maintenance  
Passenger Compartment Air  
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
A. Fan Control  
9 (Fan Control): Turn to increase  
or decrease the fan speed. Turn the  
B. Air Delivery Mode Control  
C. Temperature Control  
D. Outside Air  
knob completely to T to turn the  
fan off.  
Temperature Control: Turn to  
increase or decrease the  
temperature.  
E. Defrost  
F. Rear Window Defogger  
G. Recirculation  
H. Air Conditioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-2  
Climate Controls  
Air Delivery Mode Control: To  
change the current mode, select  
one of the following:  
Air Conditioning  
Rear Window Defogger  
# (Air Conditioning): Press to  
turn the air conditioning on or off.  
If the fan is turned off or the outside  
temperature falls below freezing, the  
air conditioning will not work.  
< (Rear Defogger): Press to turn  
the rear window defogger on or off.  
The rear window defogger turns off  
after about 10 minutes. It can also  
be turned off by turning the ignition  
to ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/  
OFF. If turned on again, it runs for  
about five minutes before  
F (Vent): Air is directed to the  
instrument panel outlets.  
* (Bi-Level): Air is directed to the  
instrument panel outlets and the  
floor outlets.  
h (Recirculation): Press to turn  
on the recirculation. An indicator  
light comes on. Air is recirculated  
inside the vehicle. It helps to quickly  
cool the air inside the vehicle or  
prevent outside air and odors from  
entering.  
7 (Floor): Air is directed to the  
floor outlets.  
turning off.  
Do not drive the vehicle until all the  
windows are clear.  
W (Defog): Clears the windows of  
fog or moisture. Air is directed to the  
windshield and floor outlets.  
Notice: Do not use a razor blade  
or sharp object to clear the inside  
rear window. Do not adhere  
anything to the defogger grid  
lines in the rear glass. These  
actions may damage the rear  
defogger. Repairs would not be  
covered by your warranty.  
% (Outside Air): Press to turn  
on the outside air. An indicator light  
comes on. Outside air is circulated  
throughout the vehicle.  
0 (Defrost): Clears the  
windshield of fog or frost more  
quickly. Air is directed to the  
windshield and side window outlets.  
For best results, clear all snow and  
ice from the windshield before  
defrosting.  
Do not drive the vehicle until all the  
windows are clear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
7-3  
Automatic Climate Control System  
The vehicle's heating, cooling, defrosting, and ventilation can be controlled  
with this system.  
Without Heated Seats  
A. Fan Control  
B. AUTO  
F. Temperature Control  
G. Power  
C. Air Delivery Mode Control  
D. Defrost  
H. Air Conditioning  
I. Rear Window Defogger  
J. Outside Air  
E. Recirculation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-4  
Climate Controls  
To place the system in  
automatic mode:  
1. Press AUTO.  
2. Set the temperature. Allow the  
system time to stabilize. Then  
adjust the temperature as  
needed.  
Manual Operation  
O (Power): Press to turn the  
climate control system on or off.  
With Heated Seats  
Automatic Operation  
9 (Fan Control): Turn to increase  
or decrease the fan speed.  
Adjusting the fan speed while in  
automatic mode places the fan  
under manual control. The AUTO  
indicator light turns off. The air  
delivery mode remains in automatic  
control.  
A. Fan Control  
B. AUTO  
The system automatically controls  
the fan speed, air delivery, air  
conditioning and recirculation to  
heat or cool the vehicle to the  
selected temperature.  
C. Air Delivery Mode Control  
D. Defrost  
E. Recirculation  
F. Temperature Control  
G. Power  
Temperature Control: Turn to  
increase or decrease the  
temperature inside the vehicle.  
When the AUTO indicator light is  
on, the system is in full automatic  
operation.  
H. Driver and Passenger Heated  
Seats  
I. Rear Window Defogger  
J. Air Conditioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
7-5  
Do not drive the vehicle until all the  
windows are clear.  
Rear Window Defogger  
H / G (Air Delivery Mode  
Control): Press mode up or mode  
down to cycle through the different  
air delivery modes. The current  
mode is shown on the display.  
< (Rear Defogger): Press to turn  
the rear window defogger on or off.  
The rear window defogger turns off  
after about 10 minutes. It can also  
be turned off by turning the ignition  
to ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/  
OFF. If turned on again, it runs  
for about five minutes before  
turning off.  
Air Conditioning  
# (Air Conditioning): Press to  
turn the air conditioning on or off.  
If the fan is turned off or the outside  
temperature falls below freezing, the  
air conditioning will not work. When  
in AUTO, the air conditioning will  
come on automatically as needed.  
Select from the following:  
F (Vent): Air is directed to the  
instrument panel outlets.  
* (Bi-Level): Air is directed to the  
instrument panel outlets and the  
floor outlets.  
Do not drive the vehicle until all the  
windows are clear.  
h (Recirculation): Press to turn  
on the recirculation. Press to  
alternate between recirculation and  
outside air, if the vehicle does not  
have a separate outside air button.  
7 (Floor): Air is directed to the  
floor outlets.  
Notice: Do not use a razor blade  
or sharp object to clear the inside  
rear window. Do not adhere  
anything to the defogger grid  
lines in the rear glass. These  
actions may damage the rear  
defogger. Repairs would not be  
covered by your warranty.  
W (Defog): Clears the windows of  
fog or moisture. Air is directed to the  
windshield and floor outlets.  
The indicator light turns on when  
recirculation is selected. Air is  
recirculated inside the vehicle.  
It helps quickly cool the air inside  
the vehicle or prevent outside air  
and odors from entering.  
0 (Defrost): Clears the  
windshield of fog or frost more  
quickly. Air is directed to the  
windshield and side window outlets.  
Selecting defrost disables the  
automatic mode.  
L / M (Driver and Passenger  
Heated Seats): For vehicles with  
heated seats, see Heated Front  
Seats on page 27.  
% (Outside Air, If Equipped):  
Press to turn on the outside air. An  
indicator light comes on. Outside air  
is circulated throughout the vehicle.  
For best results, clear all snow and  
ice from the windshield before  
defrosting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-6  
Climate Controls  
Sensors  
Air Vents  
Maintenance  
The solar sensor, located on top of  
the instrument panel near the  
windshield, monitors the solar heat.  
Use the air outlets, located in the  
center and on the side of the  
instrument panel, to direct the  
airflow. Use the thumbwheels  
located near the center air outlets,  
to open or close off the airflow.  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
The filter removes dust, pollen, and  
other airborne irritants from outside  
air that is pulled into the vehicle.  
The climate control system uses the  
information to adjust the  
temperature, fan speed,  
recirculation, and air delivery mode.  
Operation Tips  
The filter should be replaced as part  
of routine scheduled maintenance.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on  
page 102 for replacement  
intervals. To find out what type of  
filter to use, see Maintenance  
Replacement Parts on page 109.  
Do not cover the solar sensor or the  
system will not work properly.  
.
Clear away any ice, snow,  
or leaves from air inlets at the  
base of the windshield that could  
block the flow of air into the  
vehicle.  
.
Keep the path under the front  
seats clear of objects to help  
circulate the air inside of the  
vehicle more effectively.  
.
Use of nonGM approved hood  
deflectors can adversely affect  
the performance of the system.  
Check with your dealer before  
adding equipment to the outside  
of the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
7-7  
The passenger compartment air  
filter can be accessed by removing  
the entire glove box.  
4. Remove the glove box.  
8. Install the new air filter.  
5. Locate the service door for the  
passenger compartment air filter.  
9. Close the service door and  
latches.  
1. Open the glove box completely  
and locate the stop tab on top of  
the glove box door.  
6. Push the two tabs upwards and  
release the latches holding the  
service door. Lift the  
10. Reinstall the glove box.  
See your dealer if additional  
assistance is needed.  
service door.  
2. Push the stop tab upwards until  
the stop tab is under the  
7. Remove the old air filter.  
instrument panel assembly and  
the glove box is released.  
3. Unsnap the tabs beneath the  
glove box that connects it to the  
bottom of the instrument panel  
assembly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7-8  
Climate Controls  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-1  
Starting and Operating  
Brakes  
Driving and  
Operating  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . 8-28  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28  
Retained Accessory  
Antilock Brake  
System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40  
Brake Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40  
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . 8-41  
Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . 8-30  
Engine Coolant Heater . . . . . . . 8-31  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-32  
Shifting Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . 8-33  
Parking Over Things  
Driving Information  
Driving for Better Fuel  
Ride Control Systems  
Traction Control  
System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-41  
StabiliTrak System . . . . . . . . . . . 8-43  
Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Off-Road Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Driving on Wet Roads . . . . . . . 8-19  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . 8-20  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21  
If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . 8-23  
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . 8-24  
That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-33  
Cruise Control  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-44  
Engine Exhaust  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-34  
Running the Vehicle While  
Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-34  
Object Detection Systems  
Ultrasonic Parking Assist . . . . 8-46  
Rear Vision  
Automatic Transmission  
Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-49  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . 8-35  
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37  
Fuel Economy Mode . . . . . . . . . 8-37  
Fuel  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-53  
Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . 8-54  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . 8-54  
Drive Systems  
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-2  
Driving and Operating  
.
Always follow posted speed  
limits or drive more slowly when  
conditions require.  
California Fuel  
Driving Information  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-54  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . 8-54  
Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-55  
Driving for Better Fuel  
.
.
.
Keep vehicle tires properly  
inflated.  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-56 Economy  
Filling a Portable Fuel  
Driving habits can affect fuel  
Combine several trips into a  
single trip.  
Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-57  
mileage. Here are some driving tips  
to get the best fuel economy  
possible.  
Towing  
General Towing  
Replace the vehicle's tires with  
the same TPC Spec number  
molded into the tire's sidewall  
near the size.  
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-57  
Driving Characteristics and  
Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-58  
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-61  
Towing Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . 8-63  
Trailer Sway  
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate  
smoothly.  
.
.
Brake gradually and avoid  
Follow recommended scheduled  
maintenance.  
abrupt stops.  
.
Avoid idling the engine for long  
Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-64  
periods of time.  
.
Conversions and Add-Ons  
Add-On Electrical  
When road and weather  
conditions are appropriate, use  
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-64  
cruise control, if equipped.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-3  
Police records show that almost  
40 percent of all motor  
vehicle-related deaths involve  
alcohol. In most cases, these  
deaths are the result of someone  
who was drinking and driving.  
In recent years, more than  
Defensive Driving  
Drunk Driving  
Defensive driving means always  
expect the unexpected.The first  
step in driving defensively is to wear  
your safety belt, see Safety Belts on  
WARNING  
{
Drinking and then driving is very  
dangerous. Your reflexes,  
page 29  
.
perceptions, attentiveness, and  
judgment can be affected by even  
a small amount of alcohol. You  
can have a serious or even  
fatal collision if you drive after  
drinking. Do not drink and drive or  
ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if  
you are with a group, designate a  
driver who will not drink.  
17,000 annual motor vehicle-related  
deaths have been associated with  
the use of alcohol, with about  
250,000 people injured.  
WARNING  
{
Assume that other road users  
(pedestrians, bicyclists, and other  
drivers) are going to be careless  
and make mistakes. Anticipate  
what they might do and be ready.  
In addition:  
For persons under 21, it is against  
the law in every U.S. state to drink  
alcohol. There are good medical,  
psychological, and developmental  
reasons for these laws.  
.
Allow enough following  
distance between you and  
the driver in front of you.  
The obvious way to eliminate the  
leading highway safety problem is  
for people never to drink alcohol  
and then drive.  
Death and injury associated with  
drinking and driving is a global  
tragedy.  
.
Focus on the task of driving.  
Alcohol affects four things that  
anyone needs to drive a vehicle:  
judgment, muscular coordination,  
vision, and attentiveness.  
Driver distraction can cause  
collisions resulting in injury or  
possible death. These simple  
defensive driving techniques  
could save your life.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-4  
Driving and Operating  
Medical research shows that  
alcohol in a person's system can  
make crash injuries worse,  
And, of course, actual stopping  
distances vary greatly with the  
surface of the road, whether it is  
pavement or gravel; the condition of  
the road, whether it is wet, dry,  
or icy; tire tread; the condition of the  
brakes; the weight of the vehicle;  
and the amount of brake force  
applied.  
Braking  
See Brake System Warning Light  
on page 419  
.
especially injuries to the brain,  
spinal cord, or heart. This means  
that when anyone who has been  
drinking driver or passenger is  
in a crash, that person's chance of  
being killed or permanently disabled  
is higher than if the person had not  
been drinking.  
Braking action involves perception  
time and reaction time. Deciding to  
push the brake pedal is perception  
time. Actually doing it is  
reaction time.  
Avoid needless heavy  
braking. Some people drive in  
spurts heavy acceleration  
Average reaction time is about  
threefourths of a second. But that is  
only an average. It might be less  
with one driver and as long as two  
or three seconds or more with  
another. Age, physical condition,  
alertness, coordination, and  
eyesight all play a part. So do  
alcohol, drugs, and frustration. But  
even in threefourths of a second, a  
vehicle moving at 100 km/h  
(60 mph) travels 20 m (66 ft). That  
could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough  
space between the vehicle and  
others is important.  
Control of a Vehicle  
The following three systems  
followed by heavy braking rather  
than keeping pace with traffic. This  
is a mistake. The brakes might not  
have time to cool between hard  
stops. The brakes will wear out  
much faster with a lot of heavy  
braking. Keeping pace with the  
traffic and allowing realistic  
help to control the vehicle while  
driving brakes, steering, and  
accelerator. At times, as when  
driving on snow or ice, it is easy to  
ask more of those control systems  
than the tires and road can provide.  
Meaning, you can lose control of the  
vehicle. See StabiliTrak System on  
following distances eliminates a lot  
of unnecessary braking. That means  
better braking and longer brake life.  
page 843  
.
Adding nondealer/nonretailer  
accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories  
and Modifications on page 94.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-5  
If the engine ever stops while the  
vehicle is being driven, brake  
normally but do not pump the  
brakes. If the brakes are pumped,  
the pedal could get harder to push  
down. If the engine stops, there will  
still be some power brake assist but  
it will be used when the brake is  
applied. Once the power assist is  
used up, it can take longer to stop  
and the brake pedal will be harder  
to push.  
steering assist is lost because the  
electric power steering system is not  
functioning, the vehicle can be  
Hydraulic Power Steering  
(3.0L V6 Engine)  
If power steering assist is lost  
because the engine stops or the  
power steering system is not  
functioning, the vehicle can be  
steered but it will take more effort.  
If you turn the steering wheel in  
either direction several times until it  
stops, or hold the steering wheel in  
the stopped position for an  
extended amount of time, you may  
notice a reduced amount of power  
steering assist. The normal amount  
of power steering assist should  
return shortly after a few normal  
steering movements.  
steered but it will take more effort.  
Steering Tips  
It is important to take curves at a  
reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the  
condition of the tires and the road  
surface, the angle at which the  
curve is banked, and vehicle speed.  
While in a curve, speed is the one  
factor that can be controlled.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer  
accessories can affect vehicle  
performance. See Accessories  
and Modifications on page 94.  
The electric power steering system  
does not require regular  
maintenance. If you suspect  
steering system problems, such as  
abnormally high steering effort for a  
prolonged period of time, contact  
your dealer for service repairs.  
Steering  
If there is a need to reduce speed,  
do it before entering the curve, while  
the front wheels are straight.  
Electric Power Steering  
(2.4L L4 Engine)  
If the engine stalls while driving, the  
power steering assist system will  
continue to operate until you are  
able to stop the vehicle. If power  
Try to adjust the speed so you can  
drive through the curve. Maintain a  
reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve, and  
then accelerate gently into the  
straightaway.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-6  
Driving and Operating  
Steering in Emergencies  
Off-Road Recovery  
There are times when steering can  
be more effective than braking. For  
example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane,  
or a car suddenly pulls out from  
nowhere, or a child darts out from  
between parked cars and stops right  
in front of you. These problems can  
be avoided by braking if you can  
stop in time. But sometimes you  
cannot stop in time because there is  
no room. That is the time for  
The vehicle's right wheels can drop  
off the edge of a road onto the  
shoulder while driving.  
An emergency like this requires  
close attention and a quick decision.  
If holding the steering wheel at the  
recommended 9 and 3 o'clock  
positions, it can be turned a full  
180 degrees very quickly without  
removing either hand. But you have  
to act fast, steer quickly, and just as  
quickly straighten the wheel once  
you have avoided the object.  
evasive action steering around  
the problem.  
The vehicle can perform very well  
in emergencies like these. First  
apply the brakes. See Braking on  
page 84. It is better to remove as  
much speed as possible from a  
collision. Then steer around the  
problem, to the left or right  
If the level of the shoulder is only  
slightly below the pavement,  
recovery should be fairly easy. Ease  
off the accelerator and then, if there  
is nothing in the way, steer so that  
the vehicle straddles the edge of the  
The fact that such emergency  
situations are always possible is a  
good reason to practice defensive  
driving at all times and wear safety  
belts properly.  
depending on the space available.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-7  
pavement. Turn the steering wheel  
8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches), about  
one-eighth turn, until the right front  
tire contacts the pavement edge.  
Then turn the steering wheel to go  
straight down the roadway.  
Of course, traction is reduced when  
water, snow, ice, gravel, or other  
material is on the road. For safety,  
slow down and adjust your driving to  
these conditions. It is important to  
slow down on slippery surfaces  
because stopping distance is longer  
and vehicle control more limited.  
Skidding  
In a skid, a driver can lose control of  
the vehicle. Defensive drivers avoid  
most skids by taking reasonable  
care suited to existing conditions,  
and by not overdriving those  
conditions. But skids are always  
possible.  
Loss of Control  
While driving on a surface with  
reduced traction, try your best to  
avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing  
vehicle speed by shifting to a lower  
gear. Any sudden changes could  
cause the tires to slide. You might  
not realize the surface is slippery  
until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to  
recognize warning clues such as  
enough water, ice, or packed snow  
on the road to make a mirrored  
surface and slow down when you  
have any doubt.  
Let us review what driving experts  
say about what happens when the  
three control systems brakes,  
steering, and acceleration do not  
have enough friction where the tires  
meet the road to do what the driver  
has asked.  
The three types of skids correspond  
to the vehicle's three control  
systems. In the braking skid, the  
wheels are not rolling. In the  
steering or cornering skid, too much  
speed or steering in a curve causes  
tires to slip and lose cornering force.  
And in the acceleration skid, too  
much throttle causes the driving  
wheels to spin.  
In any emergency, do not give up.  
Keep trying to steer and constantly  
seek an escape route or area of  
less danger.  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease  
your foot off the accelerator pedal  
and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start  
steering quickly enough, the vehicle  
may straighten out. Always be ready  
for a second skid if it occurs.  
Remember: Antilock brakes help  
avoid only the braking skid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-8  
Driving and Operating  
At the very time you need special  
alertness and driving skills, your  
reflexes, perceptions, and judgment  
can be affected by even a small  
amount of alcohol. You could have a  
serious or even fatal accident  
if you drink and drive or ride with a  
driver who has been drinking.  
Before You Go Off-Roading  
Off-Road Driving  
.
Have all necessary maintenance  
Vehicles with allwheel drive can be  
used for offroad driving. Vehicles  
without allwheel drive should not be  
driven off-road except on a level,  
solid surface.  
and service work done.  
.
Make sure there is enough fuel,  
that fluid levels are where they  
should be, and that the spare  
tire is fully inflated.  
Many of the vehicle design features  
that help make the vehicle more  
responsive on paved roads during  
poor weather conditions also help  
make it better suited for offroad use  
than conventional passenger  
vehicles. The vehicle does not have  
features usually thought to be  
necessary for extended or severe  
offroad use such as special  
.
.
.
Be sure to read all the  
information about all-wheel-drive  
vehicles in this manual.  
Off-roading can be great fun but has  
some definite hazards. The greatest  
of these is the terrain itself. When  
off-road driving, traffic lanes are not  
marked, curves are not banked, and  
there are no road signs. Surfaces  
can be slippery, rough, uphill,  
or downhill.  
Make sure all underbody  
shields, if the vehicle has them,  
are properly attached.  
Know the local laws that apply to  
off-roading where you will be  
driving or check with law  
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt  
maneuvers. Failure to operate the  
vehicle correctly offroad could  
result in loss of vehicle control or  
vehicle rollover.  
underbody shielding and transfer  
case low gear range.  
enforcement people in the area.  
.
The airbag system is designed to  
work properly under a wide range of  
conditions, including offroad usage.  
Always wear your safety belt and  
observe safe driving speeds,  
Be sure to get the necessary  
permission if you will be on  
private land.  
Off-roading involves some new  
skills. That is why it is very  
important that you read these  
driving tips and suggestions to help  
make off-road driving safer and  
more enjoyable.  
especially on rough terrain.  
Drinking and driving can be very  
dangerous on any road and this is  
certainly true for off-road driving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-9  
There are some important things to  
remember about how to load your  
vehicle.  
Loading Your Vehicle for  
Off-Road Driving  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
Heavy loads on the roof raise  
the vehicle's center of gravity,  
making it more likely to roll  
over. You can be seriously or  
fatally injured if the vehicle  
rolls over. Put heavy loads  
inside the cargo area, not on  
the roof. Keep cargo in the  
cargo area as far forward and  
low as possible.  
.
The heaviest things should be  
WARNING  
{
on the floor, forward of the rear  
axle. Put heavier items as far  
forward as you can.  
.
Cargo on the load floor piled  
higher than the seatbacks  
can be thrown forward during  
a sudden stop. You or your  
passengers could be injured.  
Keep cargo below the top of  
the seatbacks.  
.
Be sure the load is properly  
secured, so things are not  
tossed around.  
You will find other important  
information under Vehicle Load  
Limits on page 824 and Tires on  
.
Unsecured cargo on the  
load floor can be tossed  
about when driving over  
rough terrain. You or your  
passengers can be struck by  
flying objects. Secure the  
cargo properly.  
page 940  
.
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-10  
Driving and Operating  
.
Always carry a litter bag and  
make sure all refuse is removed  
from any campsite before  
leaving.  
For vehicles with a winch, be sure to  
read the winch instructions. In a  
remote area, a winch can be handy  
if you get stuck but you will want to  
know how to use it properly.  
Environmental Concerns  
Off-road driving can provide  
wholesome and satisfying  
recreation. However, it also  
raises environmental concerns. We  
recognize these concerns and urge  
every off-roader to follow these  
basic rules for protecting the  
environment:  
.
.
Take extreme care with open  
fires (where permitted), camp  
stoves, and lanterns.  
Getting Familiar with Off-Road  
Driving  
Never park your vehicle over dry  
grass or other combustible  
materials that could catch fire  
from the heat of the vehicle's  
exhaust system.  
It is a good idea to practice in an  
area that is safe and close to home  
before you go into the wilderness.  
Off-roading requires some new and  
different skills.  
.
Always use established trails,  
roads, and areas that have been  
specially set aside for public  
off-road recreational driving and  
obey all posted regulations.  
Traveling to Remote Areas  
Tune your senses to different kinds  
of signals. Your eyes need to  
It makes sense to plan your trip,  
especially when going to a remote  
area. Know the terrain and plan  
your route. Get accurate maps of  
trails and terrain. Check to see if  
there are any blocked or closed  
roads.  
.
Avoid any driving practice that  
constantly sweep the terrain for  
unexpected obstacles. Your ears  
need to listen for unusual tire or  
engine sounds. Use your arms,  
hands, feet, and body to respond to  
vibrations and vehicle bounce.  
could damage shrubs, flowers,  
trees, or grasses or disturb  
wildlife. This includes  
wheel-spinning, breaking  
down trees, or unnecessary  
driving through streams or over  
soft ground.  
It is also a good idea to travel with  
at least one other vehicle in case  
something happens to one of them.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-11  
Controlling the vehicle is the key to  
successful off-road driving. One of  
the best ways to control the vehicle  
is to control the speed. At higher  
speeds:  
Surface Conditions: Off-roading  
surfaces can be hard-packed dirt,  
gravel, rocks, grass, sand, mud,  
snow, or ice. Each of these surfaces  
affects the vehicle's steering,  
acceleration, and braking in different  
ways. Depending on the surface,  
slipping, sliding, wheel spinning,  
delayed acceleration, poor traction,  
and longer braking distances can  
occur.  
WARNING  
{
When you are driving off-road,  
bouncing and quick changes in  
direction can easily throw you out  
of position. This could cause you  
to lose control and crash. So,  
whether you are driving on or off  
the road, you and your  
.
You approach things faster and  
have less time to react.  
.
There is less time to scan the  
terrain for obstacles.  
passengers should wear safety  
belts.  
.
The vehicle has more bounce  
when driving over obstacles.  
Surface Obstacles: Unseen or  
hidden obstacles can be hazardous.  
A rock, log, hole, rut, or bump can  
startle you if you are not prepared  
for them. Often these obstacles are  
hidden by grass, bushes, snow,  
or even the rise and fall of the  
terrain itself.  
.
More braking distance is  
Scanning the Terrain  
needed, especially on an  
unpaved surface.  
Off-road driving can take you over  
many different kinds of terrain. Be  
familiar with the terrain and its many  
different features.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-12  
Driving and Operating  
Some things to consider:  
Off-roading requires a different kind  
of alertness from driving on paved  
roads and highways. There are no  
road signs, posted speed limits,  
or signal lights. Use good judgment  
about what is safe and what is not.  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
Is the path ahead clear?  
.
Will the surface texture change  
them, you will roll over. You could  
be seriously injured or killed.  
If you have any doubt about the  
steepness, do not drive the hill.  
abruptly up ahead?  
.
Does the travel take you uphill or  
downhill?  
Driving on Hills  
.
Will you have to stop suddenly  
Approaching a Hill  
Off-road driving often takes you up,  
down, or across a hill. Driving safely  
on hills requires good judgment  
and an understanding of what the  
vehicle can and cannot do. There  
are some hills that simply cannot be  
driven, no matter how well built the  
vehicle.  
or change direction quickly?  
When you approach a hill, decide if  
it is too steep to climb, descend,  
or cross. Steepness can be hard to  
judge. On a very small hill, for  
example, there may be a smooth,  
constant incline with only a small  
change in elevation where you can  
easily see all the way to the top.  
On a large hill, the incline may get  
steeper as you near the top, but you  
might not see this because the crest  
of the hill is hidden by bushes,  
grass, or shrubs.  
When driving over obstacles or  
rough terrain, keep a firm grip on  
the steering wheel. Ruts, troughs,  
or other surface features can jerk  
the wheel out of your hands.  
When driving over bumps, rocks,  
or other obstacles, the wheels can  
leave the ground. If this happens,  
even with one or two wheels, you  
cannot control the vehicle as well or  
at all.  
WARNING  
{
Many hills are simply too steep  
for any vehicle. If you drive up  
them, you will stall. If you drive  
down them, you cannot control  
your speed. If you drive across  
Because you will be on an unpaved  
surface, it is especially important to  
avoid sudden acceleration, sudden  
turns, or sudden braking.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-13  
.
Ease up on the speed as you  
approach the top of the hill.  
Consider this as you approach a hill:  
Driving Uphill  
.
Is there a constant incline,  
Once you decide it is safe to drive  
up the hill:  
.
.
.
Attach a flag to the vehicle to be  
more visible to approaching  
traffic on trails or hills.  
or does the hill get sharply  
steeper in places?  
.
Use a low gear and get a firm  
.
Is there good traction on the  
grip on the steering wheel.  
Sound the horn as you approach  
the top of the hill to let opposing  
traffic know you are there.  
hillside, or will the surface cause  
tire slipping?  
.
Get a smooth start up the hill  
and try to maintain speed. Not  
using more power than needed  
can avoid spinning the wheels or  
sliding.  
.
Is there a straight path up or  
Use headlamps even during the  
day to make the vehicle more  
visible to oncoming traffic.  
down the hill so you will not  
have to make turning  
maneuvers?  
.
WARNING  
Are there obstructions on the hill  
that can block your path, such  
{
WARNING  
{
Turning or driving across steep  
hills can be dangerous. You could  
lose traction, slide sideways, and  
possibly roll over. You could be  
seriously injured or killed. When  
driving up hills, always try to go  
straight up.  
as boulders, trees, logs, or ruts?  
Driving to the top (crest) of a  
hill at full speed can cause an  
accident. There could be a  
drop-off, embankment, cliff,  
or even another vehicle. You  
could be seriously injured or  
killed. As you near the top of a  
hill, slow down and stay alert.  
.
What is beyond the hill? Is there  
a cliff, an embankment, a  
drop-off, a fence? Get out and  
walk the hill if you do not know.  
It is the smart way to find out.  
.
Is the hill simply too rough?  
.
Steep hills often have ruts,  
gullies, troughs, and exposed  
rocks because they are more  
susceptible to the effects of  
erosion.  
Try to drive straight up the hill if  
at all possible. If the path twists  
and turns, you might want to find  
another route.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-14  
Driving and Operating  
.
.
While backing down the hill, put  
your left hand on the steering  
wheel at the 12 o'clock position  
so you can tell if the wheels are  
straight and can maneuver as  
you back down. It is best to back  
down the hill with the wheels  
straight rather than in the left or  
right direction. Turning the wheel  
too far to the left or right will  
increase the possibility of a  
rollover.  
Never try to turn around if about  
to stall when going up a hill.  
If the hill is steep enough to stall  
the vehicle, it is steep enough  
to cause it to roll over. If you  
cannot make it up the hill, back  
straight down the hill.  
If the vehicle stalls, or is about to  
stall, and you cannot make it up  
the hill:  
.
Push the brake pedal to stop the  
vehicle and keep it from rolling  
backwards and apply the  
parking brake.  
If, after stalling, you try to back  
down the hill and decide you just  
cannot do it, set the parking brake,  
put your transmission in P (Park),  
and turn off the engine. Leave the  
vehicle and go get some help. Exit  
on the uphill side and stay clear of  
the path the vehicle would take if it  
rolled downhill.  
.
If the engine is still running, shift  
the transmission to R (Reverse),  
release the parking brake, and  
slowly back down the hill in  
R (Reverse).  
Things not to do if the vehicle stalls,  
or is about to stall, when going up  
a hill:  
.
If the engine has stopped  
running, you need to restart it.  
With the brake pedal pressed  
and the parking brake still  
applied, shift the transmission to  
P (Park) and restart the engine.  
Then, shift to R (Reverse),  
release the parking brake, and  
slowly back down the hill as  
straight as possible in  
.
Never attempt to prevent a stall  
by shifting into N (Neutral) to  
rev-up the engine and regain  
forward momentum. This will  
not work. The vehicle can roll  
backward very quickly and could  
go out of control.  
R (Reverse).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-15  
Vehicles are much more likely to  
stall when going uphill, but if it  
happens when going downhill:  
Driving Downhill  
WARNING  
{
When off-roading takes you  
downhill, consider:  
Heavy braking when going down  
a hill can cause your brakes to  
overheat and fade. This could  
cause loss of control and a  
1. Stop the vehicle by applying the  
regular brakes and apply the  
parking brake.  
.
How steep is the downhill? Will I  
be able to maintain vehicle  
control?  
serious accident. Apply the  
2. Shift to P (Park) and, while still  
braking, restart the engine.  
.
What is the surface like?  
brakes lightly when descending a  
hill and use a low gear to keep  
vehicle speed under control.  
Smooth? Rough? Slippery?  
Hard-packed dirt? Gravel?  
3. Shift back to a low gear, release  
the parking brake, and drive  
straight down.  
.
Are there hidden surface  
obstacles? Ruts? Logs?  
Boulders?  
Things not to do when driving down  
a hill:  
4. If the engine will not start, get  
out and get help.  
.
.
What is at the bottom of the hill?  
When driving downhill, avoid  
Is there a hidden creek bank or  
even a river bottom with large  
rocks?  
turns that take you across the  
incline of the hill. A hill that is not  
too steep to drive down might be  
too steep to drive across. The  
vehicle could roll over.  
If you decide you can go down a hill  
safely, try to keep the vehicle  
headed straight down. Use a low  
gear so engine drag can help the  
brakes so they do not have to do all  
the work. Descend slowly, keeping  
the vehicle under control at all  
times.  
.
Never go downhill with the  
transmission in N (Neutral),  
called free-wheeling. The brakes  
will have to do all the work and  
could overheat and fade.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-16  
Driving and Operating  
across an incline, the narrower  
track width the distance  
between the left and right  
wheels might not prevent the  
vehicle from tilting and rolling  
over. Driving across an incline  
puts more weight on the downhill  
wheels which could cause a  
downhill slide or a rollover.  
For these reasons, carefully  
consider whether to try to drive  
across an incline. Just because the  
trail goes across the incline does  
not mean you have to drive it. The  
last vehicle to try it might have  
rolled over.  
Driving Across an Incline  
An off-road trail will probably go  
across the incline of a hill. To decide  
whether to try to drive across the  
incline, consider the following:  
WARNING  
{
If you feel the vehicle starting to  
slide sideways, turn downhill. This  
should help straighten out the  
vehicle and prevent the side  
slipping. The best way to prevent  
this is to walk the coursefirst, so  
you know what the surface is like  
before driving it.  
Driving across an incline that is  
too steep will make your vehicle  
roll over. You could be seriously  
injured or killed. If you have any  
doubt about the steepness of the  
incline, do not drive across it.  
Find another route instead.  
.
Surface conditions can be a  
problem. Loose gravel, muddy  
spots, or even wet grass can  
cause the tires to slip sideways,  
downhill. If the vehicle slips  
sideways, it can hit something  
that will trip it a rock, a rut,  
etc. and roll over.  
.
A hill that can be driven straight  
.
up or down might be too steep to  
drive across. When going  
Hidden obstacles can make the  
steepness of the incline even  
worse. If you drive across a rock  
with the uphill wheels, or if the  
downhill wheels drop into a rut  
or depression, the vehicle can tilt  
even more.  
straight up or down a hill, the  
length of the wheel base the  
distance from the front wheels to  
the rear wheels reduces the  
likelihood the vehicle will tumble  
end over end. But when driving  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-17  
Hard packed snow and ice offer the  
worst tire traction. On these  
Stalling on an Incline  
Driving in Mud, Sand, Snow,  
or Ice  
surfaces, it is very easy to lose  
control. On wet ice, for example, the  
traction is so poor that you will have  
difficulty accelerating. And, if the  
vehicle does get moving, poor  
steering and difficult braking can  
cause it to slide out of control.  
WARNING  
{
When you drive in mud, snow,  
or sand, the wheels do not get good  
traction. Acceleration is not as  
quick, turning is more difficult, and  
braking distances are longer.  
Getting out on the downhill (low)  
side of a vehicle stopped across  
an incline is dangerous. If the  
vehicle rolls over, you could be  
crushed or killed. Always get out  
on the uphill (high) side of the  
vehicle and stay well clear of the  
rollover path.  
It is best to use a low gear when in  
mud the deeper the mud, the  
lower the gear. In really deep mud,  
keep the vehicle moving so it does  
not get stuck.  
WARNING  
{
Driving on frozen lakes, ponds,  
or rivers can be dangerous.  
Underwater springs, currents  
under the ice, or sudden thaws  
can weaken the ice. Your vehicle  
could fall through the ice and you  
and your passengers could  
drown. Drive your vehicle on safe  
surfaces only.  
If the vehicle stalls when crossing  
an incline, be sure you, and any  
passengers, get out on the uphill  
side, even if the door there is harder  
to open. If you get out on the  
downhill side and the vehicle starts  
to roll over, you will be right in  
its path.  
When driving on sand, wheel  
traction changes. On loosely packed  
sand, such as on beaches or sand  
dunes, the tires will tend to sink into  
the sand. This affects steering,  
accelerating, and braking. Drive at a  
reduced speed and avoid sharp  
turns or abrupt maneuvers.  
If you have to walk down the slope,  
stay out of the path the vehicle will  
take if it does roll over.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-18  
Driving and Operating  
Find out how deep the water is  
before driving through it. Do not try  
it if it is deep enough to cover the  
wheel hubs, axles, or exhaust  
pipe you probably will not get  
through. Deep water can damage  
the axle and other vehicle parts.  
Driving in Water  
After Off-Road Driving  
Remove any brush or debris that  
has collected on the underbody,  
chassis, or under the hood. These  
accumulations can be a fire hazard.  
WARNING  
{
Driving through rushing water can  
be dangerous. Deep water can  
sweep your vehicle downstream  
and you and your passengers  
could drown. If it is only shallow  
water, it can still wash away the  
ground from under your tires, and  
you could lose traction and roll  
the vehicle over. Do not drive  
through rushing water.  
After operation in mud or sand,  
have the brake linings cleaned and  
checked. These substances can  
cause glazing and uneven braking.  
Check the body structure, steering,  
suspension, wheels, tires, axles,  
and exhaust system for damage and  
check the fuel lines and cooling  
system for any leakage.  
If the water is not too deep, drive  
slowly through it. At faster speeds,  
water splashes on the ignition  
system and the vehicle can stall.  
Stalling can also occur if you get the  
tailpipe under water. If the tailpipe is  
under water, you will never be able  
to start the engine. When going  
through water, remember that when  
the brakes get wet, it might take  
longer to stop. See Driving on Wet  
Roads on page 819.  
The vehicle requires more frequent  
service due to off-road use. Refer to  
the Maintenance Schedule for  
additional information.  
Heavy rain can mean flash flooding,  
and flood waters demand extreme  
caution.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
Hydroplaning  
8-19  
Driving on Wet Roads  
WARNING (Continued)  
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water  
can build up under your vehicle's  
tires so they actually ride on the  
water. This can happen if the road is  
wet enough and you are going fast  
enough. When your vehicle is  
hydroplaning, it has little or no  
contact with the road.  
Rain and wet roads can reduce  
vehicle traction and affect your  
ability to stop and accelerate.  
Always drive slower in these types  
of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and  
deepstanding or flowing water.  
After driving through a large  
puddle of water or a car/vehicle  
wash, lightly apply the brake  
pedal until the brakes work  
normally.  
Flowing or rushing water creates  
strong forces. Driving through  
flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this  
happens, you and other vehicle  
occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be  
very cautious about trying to drive  
through flowing water.  
There is no hard and fast rule about  
hydroplaning. The best advice is to  
slow down when the road is wet.  
WARNING  
{
Wet brakes can cause crashes.  
They might not work as well in a  
quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could  
lose control of the vehicle.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-20  
Driving and Operating  
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Highway Hypnosis  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Besides slowing down, other wet  
weather driving tips include:  
Always be alert and pay attention to  
your surroundings while driving.  
If you become tired or sleepy, find a  
safe place to park your vehicle  
and rest.  
Driving on steep hills or through  
mountains is different than driving  
on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for  
driving in these conditions include:  
.
.
.
Allow extra following distance.  
Pass with caution.  
.
Keep the vehicle serviced and in  
Keep windshield wiping  
Other driving tips include:  
good shape.  
equipment in good shape.  
.
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
Check all fluid levels and brakes,  
.
.
Keep the windshield washer fluid  
reservoir filled.  
tires, cooling system, and  
transmission.  
.
Keep interior temperature cool.  
.
Keep your eyes moving scan  
Have good tires with proper  
.
Going down steep or long hills,  
the road ahead and to the sides.  
tread depth. See Tires on  
shift to a lower gear.  
.
page 940  
.
Check the rearview mirror and  
.
vehicle instruments often.  
Turn off cruise control.  
WARNING  
{
If you do not shift down, the  
brakes could get so hot that they  
would not work well. You would  
then have poor braking or even  
none going down a hill. You could  
crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep  
downhill slope.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-21  
The Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
on page 838 improves vehicle  
stability during hard stops on  
slippery roads, but apply the brakes  
sooner than when on dry pavement.  
Winter Driving  
WARNING  
{
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral)  
or with the ignition off is  
Drive carefully when there is snow  
or ice between the tires and the  
road, creating less traction or grip.  
Wet ice can occur at about 0°C  
(32°F) when freezing rain begins to  
fall, resulting in even less traction.  
Avoid driving on wet ice or in  
freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
dangerous. The brakes will have  
to do all the work of slowing down  
and they could get so hot that  
they would not work well. You  
would then have poor braking or  
even none going down a hill. You  
could crash. Always have the  
engine running and the vehicle in  
gear when going downhill.  
Allow greater following distance on  
any slippery road and watch for  
slippery spots. Icy patches can  
occur on otherwise clear roads in  
shaded areas. The surface of a  
curve or an overpass can remain icy  
when the surrounding roads are  
clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while  
on ice.  
Drive with caution, whatever the  
condition. Accelerate gently so  
traction is not lost. Accelerating too  
quickly causes the wheels to spin  
and makes the surface under the  
tires slick, so there is even less  
traction.  
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not  
swing wide or cut across the  
center of the road. Drive at  
speeds that let you stay in your  
own lane.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped,  
on slippery surfaces.  
.
.
Try not to break the fragile traction.  
If you accelerate too fast, the drive  
wheels will spin and polish the  
Top of hills: Be alert —  
something could be in your  
lane (stalled car, accident).  
surface under the tires even more.  
Pay attention to special road  
signs (falling rocks area, winding  
roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take  
appropriate action.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-22  
Driving and Operating  
Blizzard Conditions  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING (Continued)  
Being stuck in snow can be in a  
serious situation. Stay with the  
vehicle unless there is help nearby.  
If possible, use the Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 126  
To get help and keep everyone in  
the vehicle safe:  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
For more information about  
carbon monoxide, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 834.  
.
Clear away snow from around  
the base of your vehicle,  
especially any that is blocking  
the exhaust pipe.  
.
Snow can trap exhaust gases  
under your vehicle. This can  
cause deadly CO (carbon  
.
Check again from time to  
time to be sure snow does  
not collect there.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning  
monoxide) gas to get inside. CO  
could overcome you and kill you.  
You cannot see it or smell it, so  
you might not know it is in your  
vehicle. Clear away snow from  
around the base of your vehicle,  
especially any that is blocking the  
exhaust.  
flashers.  
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside  
.
Open a window about 5 cm  
mirror.  
(two inches) on the side of  
the vehicle that is away from  
the wind to bring in fresh air.  
WARNING  
{
.
Fully open the air outlets on  
or under the instrument  
panel.  
Snow can trap engine exhaust  
under the vehicle. This may  
cause exhaust gases to get  
inside. Engine exhaust contains  
carbon monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can  
cause unconsciousness and even  
death.  
Run the engine for short periods  
only as needed to keep warm, but  
be careful.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control  
system to a setting that  
circulates the air inside the  
vehicle and set the fan speed  
to the highest setting. See  
Climate Control System in the  
Index.  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-23  
To save fuel, run the engine for only  
short periods as needed to warm  
the vehicle and then shut the engine  
off and close the window most of  
the way to save heat. Repeat this  
until help arrives but only when you  
feel really uncomfortable from the  
cold. Moving about to keep warm  
also helps.  
Rocking the Vehicle to Get  
it Out  
If the Vehicle is Stuck  
Slowly and cautiously spin the  
wheels to free the vehicle when  
stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow.  
Turn the steering wheel left and  
right to clear the area around the  
front wheels. Turn off any traction  
system. Shift back and forth  
between R (Reverse) and a forward  
gear, spinning the wheels as little as  
possible. To prevent transmission  
wear, wait until the wheels stop  
spinning before shifting gears.  
Release the accelerator pedal while  
shifting, and press lightly on the  
accelerator pedal when the  
transmission is in gear. Slowly  
spinning the wheels in the forward  
and reverse directions causes a  
rocking motion that could free the  
vehicle. If that does not get the  
vehicle out after a few tries, it might  
need to be towed out. If the vehicle  
does need to be towed out, see  
Towing the Vehicle on page 972.  
If stuck too severely for the traction  
system to free the vehicle, turn the  
traction system off and use the  
rocking method.  
If it takes some time for help to  
arrive, now and then when you run  
the engine, push the accelerator  
pedal slightly so the engine runs  
faster than the idle speed. This  
keeps the battery charged to restart  
the vehicle and to signal for help  
with the headlamps. Do this as little  
as possible to save fuel.  
WARNING  
{
If the vehicle's tires spin at high  
speed, they can explode, and you  
or others could be injured. The  
vehicle can overheat, causing an  
engine compartment fire or other  
damage. Spin the wheels as little  
as possible and avoid going  
above 55 km/h (35 mph) as  
shown on the speedometer.  
For information about using tire  
chains on the vehicle, see Tire  
Chains on page 958.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-24  
Driving and Operating  
pillar (B-pillar). With the driver's  
door open, you will find the label  
attached near the door lock  
post. The Tire and Loading  
Information label shows the  
number of occupant seating  
positions (A), and the maximum  
vehicle capacity weight (B) in  
kilograms and pounds.  
Vehicle Load Limits  
WARNING (Continued)  
It is very important to know how  
much weight the vehicle can  
carry. This weight is called the  
vehicle capacity weight and  
includes the weight of all  
the way the vehicle handles.  
These could cause you to lose  
control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the  
life of the vehicle.  
occupants, cargo and all  
nonfactoryinstalled options.  
Two labels on the vehicle  
show how much weight it may  
properly carry, the Tire and  
Loading Information label and  
the Certification label.  
Tire and Loading Information  
Label  
The Tire and Loading  
Information label also shows the  
tire size of the original  
equipment tires (C) and the  
recommended cold tire inflation  
pressures (D). For more  
information on tires and inflation  
see Tires on page 940 and Tire  
WARNING  
{
Do not load the vehicle any  
heavier than the Gross  
Pressure on page 946  
.
Vehicle Weight Rating  
(GVWR), or either the  
maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).  
If you do, parts on the vehicle  
can break, and it can change  
There is also important loading  
information on the Certification  
label. It tells you the Gross  
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)  
and the Gross Axle Weight  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Tire and  
Loading Information label is  
attached to the vehicle's center  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-25  
Rating (GAWR) for the front and  
rear axle. See Certification  
Labellater in this section.  
there will be five 150 lb  
passengers in your vehicle,  
the amount of available cargo  
and luggage load capacity  
is 650 lbs (1400 750  
Steps for Determining Correct  
Load Limit  
(5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
1. Locate the statement The  
combined weight of  
5. Determine the combined  
weight of luggage and cargo  
being loaded on the vehicle.  
That weight may not safely  
exceed the available cargo  
and luggage load capacity  
calculated in Step 4.  
occupants and cargo should  
never exceed XXX kg or  
XXX lbson your vehicle's  
placard.  
Example 1  
2. Determine the combined  
weight of the driver and  
passengers that will be riding  
in your vehicle.  
A. Vehicle Capacity Weight for  
Example 1 = 453 kg  
(1,000 lbs).  
6. If your vehicle will be towing  
a trailer, the load from your  
trailer will be transferred to  
your vehicle. Consult this  
manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo  
and luggage load capacity of  
your vehicle.  
B. Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 68 kg  
(150 lbs) × 2 = 136 kg  
(300 lbs).  
3. Subtract the combined  
weight of the driver and  
passengers from XXX kg or  
XXX lbs.  
C. Available Occupant and  
Cargo Weight = 317 kg  
(700 lbs).  
4. The resulting figure equals  
the available amount of cargo  
and luggage load capacity.  
For example, if the XXX”  
See Trailer Towing on page 861  
for important information on  
towing a trailer, towing safety  
rules and trailering tips.  
amount equals 1400 lbs and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-26  
Driving and Operating  
vehicle's capacity weight and  
seating positions. The combined  
weight of the driver, passengers,  
and cargo should never exceed  
the vehicle's capacity weight.  
Certification Label  
Example 2  
Example 3  
A. Vehicle Capacity Weight for  
Example 2 = 453 kg  
(1,000 lbs).  
A. Vehicle Capacity Weight for  
Example 3 = 453 kg  
(1,000 lbs).  
B. Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 68 kg  
(150 lbs) × 5 = 340 kg  
(750 lbs).  
B. Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 91 kg  
(200 lbs) × 5 = 453 kg  
(1,000 lbs).  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Certification  
label is attached to the lower  
center pillar on the driver side of  
the vehicle or on the rear edge  
of the driver door. The label tells  
the gross weight capacity of the  
vehicle, called the Gross Vehicle  
C. Available Cargo  
C. Available Cargo Weight =  
0 kg (0 lbs).  
Weight = 113 kg (250 lbs).  
Refer to the vehicle's Tire and  
Loading Information label for  
specific information about the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-27  
Weight Rating (GVWR). The  
GVWR includes the weight of  
the vehicle, all occupants, fuel,  
and cargo. Never exceed the  
GVWR for the vehicle, or the  
Gross Axle Weight Rating  
(GAWR) for either the front or  
rear axle.  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
the way the vehicle handles.  
These could cause you to lose  
control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the  
life of the vehicle.  
Never stack heavier  
things, like suitcases,  
inside the vehicle so that  
some of them are above  
the tops of the seats.  
.
.
.
Do not leave an  
unsecured child restraint  
in the vehicle.  
If the vehicle is carrying a heavy  
load, it should be spread out.  
See Steps for Determining  
Correct Load Limitearlier in this  
section.  
WARNING  
{
Things you put inside the  
vehicle can strike and injure  
people in a sudden stop or  
turn, or in a crash.  
When you carry something  
inside the vehicle, secure  
it whenever you can.  
WARNING  
{
Do not leave a seat folded  
down unless you need to.  
.
Put things in the cargo  
Do not load the vehicle any  
heavier than the Gross  
Vehicle Weight Rating  
area of the vehicle. In the  
cargo area, put them as  
far forward as you can. Try  
to spread the weight  
evenly.  
(GVWR), or either the  
maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).  
If you do, parts on the vehicle  
can break, and it can change  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-28  
Driving and Operating  
can be used. Vehicle speeds  
above 110 km/h (68 mph)  
should be limited to  
Ignition Positions  
Starting and  
Operating  
five minutes per use.  
New Vehicle Break-In  
.
Avoid making hard stops for  
the first 322 km (200 miles) or  
so. During this time the new  
brake linings are not yet  
broken in. Hard stops with  
new linings can mean  
premature wear and earlier  
replacement. Follow this  
breaking-in guideline every  
time you get new brake  
linings.  
Notice: The vehicle does not  
need an elaborate break-in. But it  
will perform better in the long run  
if you follow these guidelines:  
.
Do not drive at any one  
constant speed, fast or slow,  
for the first 805 km  
(500 miles). Do not make  
full-throttle starts. Avoid  
downshifting to brake or  
slow the vehicle.  
The ignition switch has four different  
positions.  
.
Do not tow a trailer during  
break-in. See Driving  
Notice: Using a tool to force the  
key to turn in the ignition could  
cause damage to the switch or  
break the key. Use the correct  
key, make sure it is all the way in,  
and turn it only with your hand.  
If the key cannot be turned by  
hand, see your dealer.  
.
During the first 1 000 km  
Characteristics and Towing  
Tips on page 858 for the  
trailer towing capabilities of  
your vehicle and more  
information.  
(600 miles), avoid using more  
than moderate acceleration  
in lower gears and avoid  
vehicle speeds above  
110 km/h (68 mph).  
Following breakin, engine speed  
and load can be gradually  
increased.  
.
Between the first 1 000 km  
(600 miles) and 5 000 km  
(3,000 miles), heavy  
To shift out of P (Park), turn the  
ignition to ON/RUN and apply the  
brake pedal.  
acceleration in lower gears  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-29  
A (LOCK/OFF): This is the only  
position from which the key can be  
removed. This locks the steering  
wheel, ignition and automatic  
transmission.  
C (ON/RUN): The ignition switch  
stays in this position when the  
engine is running. This position can  
be used to operate the electrical  
accessories, including the  
ventilation fan and 12 volt power  
outlet, as well as to display some  
warning and indicator lights.  
Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP)  
These vehicle accessories can be  
used for up to 10 minutes after the  
engine is turned off:  
On vehicles with an automatic  
transmission, the shift lever must be  
in P (Park) to turn the ignition switch  
to the LOCK/OFF position.  
.
Audio System  
.
Power Windows  
The battery could be drained if the  
key is left in the ACC/ACCESSORY  
or ON/RUN position with the engine  
off. The vehicle might not start if the  
battery is allowed to drain for an  
extended period of time.  
.
Sunroof (if equipped)  
The ignition switch can bind in the  
LOCK/OFF position with the wheels  
turned off center. If this happens,  
move the steering wheel from right  
to left while turning the key to ACC/  
ACCESSORY. If this does not work,  
then the vehicle needs service.  
Power to the audio system will  
continue to operate for up to  
10 minutes or until the driver door is  
opened.  
D (START): This position starts the  
engine. When the engine starts,  
release the key. The ignition switch  
will return to ON/RUN for normal  
driving.  
Power to the power windows and  
sunroof will continue to operate for  
up to 10 minutes or until any door is  
opened.  
B (ACC/ACCESSORY): This  
position provides power to some of  
the electrical accessories. It unlocks  
the steering wheel and ignition. The  
transmission is also unlocked in this  
position on automatic transmission  
vehicles. To move the key from  
ACC/ACCESSORY to LOCK/OFF,  
push in the key and then turn it to  
LOCK/OFF.  
All these features will work when  
the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/  
ACCESSORY.  
A warning tone sounds when the  
driver door is opened if the ignition  
is still in ACC/ACCESSORY and the  
key is in the ignition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-30  
Driving and Operating  
The vehicle has a  
Notice: Cranking the engine for  
long periods of time, by returning  
the key to the START position  
immediately after cranking has  
ended, can overheat and damage  
the cranking motor, and drain the  
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds  
between each try, to let the  
Starting the Engine  
Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. This feature assists in  
starting the engine and protects  
components. If the ignition key is  
turned to the START position,  
and then released when the  
engine begins cranking, the  
engine will continue cranking for  
a few seconds or until the  
vehicle starts. If the engine does  
not start and the key is held in  
START for many seconds,  
cranking will be stopped after  
15 seconds to prevent cranking  
motor damage. To prevent gear  
damage, this system also  
prevents cranking if the engine  
is already running. Engine  
cranking can be stopped by  
turning the ignition switch to  
ACC/ACCESSORY or  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or  
N (Neutral). The engine will not start  
in any other position. To restart the  
vehicle when it is already moving,  
use N (Neutral) only.  
Notice: Do not try to shift to  
cranking motor cool down.  
P (Park) if the vehicle is moving.  
If you do, you could damage the  
transmission. Shift to P (Park)  
only when the vehicle is stopped.  
2. If the engine does not start after  
5 to 10 seconds, especially in  
very cold weather (below 18°C  
or 0°F), it could be flooded with  
too much gasoline. Push the  
Starting Procedure  
1. With your foot off the accelerator  
pedal, turn the ignition key to  
START. When the engine starts,  
let go of the key. The idle speed  
will go down as the engine  
warms. Do not race the engine  
immediately after starting it.  
Operate the engine and  
accelerator pedal all the way to  
the floor and holding it there as  
you hold the key in START for a  
maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at  
least 15 seconds between each  
try, to allow the cranking motor  
to cool. When the engine starts,  
let go of the key and accelerator.  
LOCK/OFF.  
transmission gently to allow  
the oil to warm up and lubricate  
all moving parts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-31  
If the vehicle starts briefly but  
then stops again, repeat the  
procedure. This clears the extra  
gasoline from the engine. Do not  
race the engine immediately  
after starting it. Operate the  
engine and transmission gently  
until the oil warms up and  
Engine Coolant Heater  
The engine coolant heater,  
WARNING  
{
Plugging the cord into an  
if available, can help in cold weather  
conditions at or below 18°C (0°F)  
for easier starting and better fuel  
economy during engine warm-up.  
Plug in the coolant heater at least  
four hours before starting the  
vehicle. An internal thermostat in  
the plug-end of the cord will prevent  
engine coolant heater operation at  
temperatures above 18°C (0°F).  
ungrounded outlet could cause an  
electrical shock. Also, the wrong  
kind of extension cord could  
overheat and cause a fire. You  
could be seriously injured. Plug  
the cord into a properly grounded  
three-prong 110-volt AC outlet.  
If the cord will not reach, use a  
heavy-duty three-prong extension  
cord rated for at least 15 amps.  
lubricates all moving parts.  
Notice: The engine is designed to  
work with the electronics in the  
vehicle. If you add electrical parts  
or accessories, you could change  
the way the engine operates.  
Before adding electrical  
To Use The Engine Coolant  
Heater  
4. Before starting the engine, be  
sure to unplug and store the  
cord as it was before to keep it  
away from moving engine parts.  
If you do not it could be  
equipment, check with your  
1. Turn off the engine.  
dealer. If you do not, the engine  
might not perform properly. Any  
resulting damage would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the  
electrical cord.  
The electrical cord is located on  
the passenger side of the engine  
compartment, in front of the air  
cleaner.  
damaged.  
The length of time the heater should  
remain plugged in depends on  
several factors. Ask a dealer in the  
area where you will be parking the  
vehicle for the best advice on this.  
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded  
110-volt AC outlet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-32  
Driving and Operating  
Use this procedure to shift into  
P (Park):  
Leaving the Vehicle With the  
Engine Running  
Shifting Into Park  
1. Hold the brake pedal down and  
set the parking brake.  
WARNING  
{
WARNING  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of  
the vehicle if the shift lever is not  
fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can  
roll. If you have left the engine  
running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be  
injured. To be sure the vehicle will  
not move, even when you are on  
fairly level ground, use the steps  
that follow. If you are pulling a  
trailer, see Driving Characteristics  
and Towing Tips on page 858.  
See Parking Brake on  
page 840 for more information.  
It can be dangerous to leave the  
vehicle with the engine running.  
The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in  
P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it  
could overheat and even catch  
fire. You or others could be  
2. Hold the button on the shift lever  
and push the lever toward the  
front of the vehicle into P (Park).  
3. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.  
4. Remove the key.  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle  
with the engine running.  
If you have to leave the vehicle with  
the engine running, the vehicle must  
be in P (Park) and the parking  
brake set.  
Release the button and check that  
the shift lever cannot be moved out  
of P (Park).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-33  
Torque Lock  
Shifting Out of Park  
To shift out of P (Park):  
Parking Over Things  
That Burn  
Torque lock is when the weight of  
the vehicle puts too much force on  
the parking pawl in the  
1. Apply the brake pedal.  
2. Press the shift lever button.  
3. Move the shift lever.  
WARNING  
{
transmission. This happens when  
parking on a hill and shifting the  
transmission into P (Park) is not  
done properly and then it is difficult  
to shift out of P (Park). To prevent  
torque lock, set the parking brake  
and then shift into P (Park). To find  
out how, see Shifting Into Park”  
listed previously.  
Things that can burn could touch  
hot exhaust parts under the  
vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass,  
or other things that can burn.  
If you still are unable to shift out of  
P (Park):  
1. Fully release the shift lever  
button.  
2. Hold the brake pedal down and  
press the shift lever button  
again.  
If torque lock does occur, the  
vehicle may need to be pushed  
uphill by another vehicle to relieve  
the parking pawl pressure, so you  
can shift out of P (Park).  
3. Move the shift lever.  
If you still cannot move the shift  
lever from P (Park), see your dealer  
for service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-34  
Driving and Operating  
Running the Vehicle  
While Parked  
It is better not to park with the  
engine running. But if you ever have  
to, here are some things to know.  
Engine Exhaust  
WARNING (Continued)  
.
.
WARNING  
{
The vehicles exhaust system  
has been modified, damaged  
or improperly repaired.  
Engine exhaust contains Carbon  
Monoxide (CO) which cannot be  
seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and  
even death.  
There are holes or openings  
in the vehicle body from  
damage or after-market  
modifications that are not  
completely sealed.  
WARNING  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed  
area with poor ventilation is  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust  
contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled.  
It can cause unconsciousness  
and even death. Never run the  
engine in an enclosed area that  
has no fresh air ventilation. For  
more information, see Engine  
Exhaust on page 834.  
.
The vehicle idles in areas  
If unusual fumes are detected or  
if it is suspected that exhaust is  
coming into the vehicle:  
with poor ventilation (parking  
garages, tunnels, deep snow  
that may block underbody  
airflow or tail pipes).  
.
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
.
The exhaust smells or  
sounds strange or different.  
.
Have the vehicle repaired  
immediately.  
.
The exhaust system leaks  
due to corrosion or damage.  
Never park the vehicle with the  
engine running in an enclosed  
area such as a garage or a  
building that has no fresh air  
ventilation.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-35  
Automatic  
Transmission  
WARNING  
WARNING  
{
{
It can be dangerous to get out of  
the vehicle if the automatic  
It is dangerous to get out of the  
vehicle if the shift lever is not fully  
in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
transmission shift lever is not fully  
in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll. Do  
not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you  
have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can  
move suddenly. You or others  
could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when  
you are on fairly level ground,  
always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park).  
Do not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you  
have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can  
move suddenly. You or others  
could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when  
you are on fairly level ground,  
always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park).  
See Shifting Into Park on  
The automatic transmission shift  
lever is located on the console  
between the seats.  
page 832. If you are pulling a  
trailer, see Driving Characteristics  
and Towing Tips on page 858.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure  
the vehicle will not move. See  
Shifting Into Park on page 832.  
P (Park): This position locks the  
front wheels. Use P (Park) when  
starting the engine because the  
vehicle cannot move easily.  
If parking on a hill and pulling a  
trailer, see Driving Characteristics  
and Towing Tips on page 858.  
The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control  
system. You must fully apply the  
regular brake first and then press  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-36  
Driving and Operating  
the shift lever button before shifting  
from P (Park) when the ignition key  
is in ON/RUN. If you cannot shift out  
of P (Park), ease pressure on the  
shift lever, then push the shift lever  
all the way into P (Park) as you  
maintain brake application. Then  
press the shift lever button and  
move the shift lever into another  
gear. See Shifting Out of Park on  
N (Neutral): In this position the  
engine and transmission do not  
connect. Use N (Neutral) to restart a  
vehicle that is already moving.  
D (Drive): This position is for  
normal driving. It provides the best  
fuel economy. If you need more  
power for passing, and you are:  
.
Going less than 56 km/h  
WARNING  
{
(35 mph), push the accelerator  
pedal about halfway down.  
Shifting into a drive gear while the  
engine is running at high speed is  
dangerous. Unless your foot is  
firmly on the brake pedal, the  
vehicle could move very rapidly.  
You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift  
into a drive gear while the engine  
is running at high speed.  
.
Going about 56 km/h (35 mph) or  
more, push the accelerator all  
the way down.  
page 833  
.
Notice: If the vehicle seems to  
accelerate slowly or not shift  
gears when you go faster, and  
you continue to drive the vehicle  
that way, you could damage the  
transmission. Have the vehicle  
serviced right away. You can  
drive in L (Low) when you are  
driving less than 56 km/h (35 mph)  
and D (Drive) for higher speeds  
until then.  
R (Reverse): Use this gear to  
back up.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse)  
while the vehicle is moving  
forward could damage the  
transmission. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only  
after the vehicle is stopped.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or  
N (Neutral) with the engine  
running at high speed may  
damage the transmission. The  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the  
engine is not running at high  
speed when shifting the vehicle.  
To rock the vehicle back and forth to  
get out of snow, ice or sand without  
damaging the transmission, see If  
the Vehicle is Stuck on page 823.  
M (Manual Mode): Allows the  
driver to select the range of gear  
positions. If the vehicle has this  
feature, see Manual Mode on  
page 837  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-37  
When shifting to M (Manual Mode),  
the transmission will shift to a preset  
lower gear range. For this preset  
range, the highest gear available is  
displayed next to the M in the DIC.  
See Driver Information Center (DIC)  
on page 424 for more information.  
All gears below that number are  
available to use. For example, when  
4 (Fourth) is shown next to the M,  
1 (First) through 4 (Fourth) gears are  
shifted automatically. To shift to  
5 (Fifth) gear, press the + (Plus)  
button or shift into D (Drive).  
Manual Mode  
Fuel Economy Mode  
The vehicle may have a Fuel  
Economy Mode. When engaged,  
fuel economy mode can improve the  
vehicle's fuel economy.  
Electronic Range Select  
(ERS) Mode  
ERS or manual mode allows for the  
selection of the range of gear  
positions. Use this mode when  
driving down hill or towing a trailer  
to limit the top gear and vehicle  
speed. The shift position indicator  
within the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) will display a number next to  
the M indicating the highest  
available gear under manual mode  
and the driving conditions when  
manual mode was selected.  
M (Manual Mode) will prevent  
shifting to a lower gear range if the  
engine speed is too high. If vehicle  
speed is not reduced within the time  
allowed, the lower gear range shift  
will not be completed. Slow the  
vehicle, then press the (Minus)  
button to the desired lower gear  
range.  
To use this feature:  
1. Move the shift lever to  
M (Manual Mode).  
Press the eco(economy) button  
by the shift lever to turn this feature  
on or off. The ecolight in the  
instrument cluster will come on  
when engaged. See Fuel Economy  
2. Press the plus/minus button on  
the shift lever, to increase or  
decrease the gear range  
available.  
While using the ERS, cruise control  
can be used.  
Light on page 422  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-38  
Driving and Operating  
For vehicles with a Driver  
Drive Systems  
Brakes  
Information Center (DIC) an  
ECO Mode Onmessage displays.  
See Fuel System Messages on  
page 430 for more information.  
All-Wheel Drive  
Antilock Brake  
System (ABS)  
This vehicle has the Antilock Brake  
System (ABS), an advanced  
electronic braking system that helps  
prevent a braking skid.  
With this feature, engine power is  
always sent to all four wheels. It is  
fully automatic, and adjusts itself as  
needed for road conditions.  
When Fuel Economy Mode is on:  
.
The transmission will upshift  
sooner and downshift later.  
When using a compact spare tire on  
an AWD vehicle, the system  
automatically detects the compact  
spare and disables AWD. To restore  
AWD operation and prevent  
excessive wear on system, replace  
the compact spare with a full-size  
tire as soon as possible. See  
Compact Spare Tire on page 968  
for more information.  
.
The torque converter clutch will  
When the engine is started and the  
vehicle begins to drive away, ABS  
checks itself. A momentary motor or  
clicking noise might be heard while  
this test is going on, and it might  
even be noticed that the brake  
apply sooner and stay on longer.  
.
The gas pedal will be less  
sensitive.  
.
The vehicle's computer will more  
aggressively shut off fuel to the  
engine under deceleration.  
pedal moves a little. This is normal.  
.
.
The engine idle speed will be  
lower.  
Driving performance is more  
conservative.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
Using ABS  
8-39  
As the brakes are applied, the  
computer keeps receiving updates  
on wheel speed and controls  
braking pressure accordingly.  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold  
the brake pedal down firmly and let  
ABS work. The ABS pump or motor  
might be heard operating, and the  
brake pedal might be felt to pulsate,  
but this is normal.  
Remember: ABS does not change  
the time needed to get a foot up to  
the brake pedal or always decrease  
stopping distance. If you get too  
close to the vehicle in front of you,  
there will not be enough time to  
apply the brakes if that vehicle  
suddenly slows or stops. Always  
leave enough room up ahead to  
stop, even with ABS.  
If there is a problem with ABS, this  
warning light stays on. See Antilock  
Brake System (ABS) Warning Light  
Braking in Emergencies  
on page 420  
.
ABS allows the driver to steer and  
brake at the same time. In many  
emergencies, steering can help  
more than even the very best  
braking.  
If driving safely on a wet road and it  
becomes necessary to slam on the  
brakes and continue braking to  
avoid a sudden obstacle, a  
computer senses that the wheels  
are slowing down. If one of the  
wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work the  
brakes at each wheel.  
ABS can change the brake pressure  
to each wheel, as required, faster  
than any driver could. This can help  
the driver steer around the obstacle  
while braking hard.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-40  
Driving and Operating  
Notice: Driving with the parking  
brake on can overheat the brake  
system and cause premature  
wear or damage to brake system  
parts. Make sure that the parking  
brake is fully released and the  
brake warning light is off before  
driving.  
Parking Brake  
Brake Assist  
This vehicle has a brake assist  
feature designed to assist the driver  
in stopping or decreasing vehicle  
speed in emergency driving  
conditions. This feature uses the  
stability system hydraulic brake  
control module to supplement the  
power brake system under  
conditions where the driver has  
quickly and forcefully applied the  
brake pedal in an attempt to quickly  
stop or slow down the vehicle. The  
stability system hydraulic brake  
control module increases brake  
pressure at each corner of the  
vehicle until the ABS activates.  
Minor brake pedal pulsations or  
pedal movement during this time  
is normal and the driver should  
continue to apply the brake pedal  
as the driving situation dictates.  
The brake assist feature will  
automatically disengage when the  
brake pedal is released or brake  
pedal pressure is quickly  
To release the parking brake, hold  
the regular brake pedal down, then  
push down momentarily on the  
parking brake pedal until you feel  
the pedal release. Slowly pull your  
foot up off the park brake pedal.  
If the parking brake is not released  
when you begin to drive, the brake  
system warning light will be on and  
a chime will sound warning you that  
the parking brake is still on.  
To set the parking brake, hold the  
regular brake pedal down, then  
push the parking brake pedal down.  
If the ignition is on, the brake  
system warning light will come on.  
See Brake System Warning Light  
If you are towing a trailer and are  
parking on a hill, see Driving  
Characteristics and Towing Tips on  
on page 419  
.
page 858  
.
decreased.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-41  
The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working, but this is  
normal.  
Hill Start Assist (HSA)  
Ride Control Systems  
This vehicle has a Hill Start Assist  
(HSA) feature, which may be useful  
when the vehicle is stopped on a  
grade. This feature is designed to  
prevent the vehicle from rolling,  
either forward or rearward, during  
vehicle drive off. After driver  
completely stops and holds the  
vehicle in a complete standstill on a  
grade, HSA will be automatically  
activated. During the transition  
period between when the driver  
releases the brake pedal and starts  
to accelerate to drive off on a grade,  
HSA holds the braking pressure to  
ensure that there is no rolling back.  
The brakes will automatically  
Traction Control  
System (TCS)  
The vehicle has a Traction Control  
System (TCS) that limits wheel spin.  
On a front-wheel-drive vehicle, the  
system operates if it senses that  
one or both of the front wheels are  
spinning or beginning to lose  
traction. On an All-Wheel-Drive  
(AWD) vehicle, the system will  
operate if it senses that any of the  
wheels are spinning or beginning to  
lose traction. When this happens,  
the system brakes the spinning  
wheel(s) and/or reduces engine  
power to limit wheel spin.  
The TCS/StabiliTrak warning light  
will flash to indicate that the traction  
control system is active.  
This warning light comes on if there  
is a problem with TCS, and the  
system will not limit wheel spin.  
Adjust your driving accordingly.  
release when the accelerator pedal  
is applied within the two second  
window. It will not activate if the  
vehicle is in a drive gear and facing  
downhill or if the vehicle is facing  
uphill and in R (Reverse).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-42  
Driving and Operating  
TCS automatically comes on  
On AWD vehicles, when TCS is  
turned off, the system may still  
make noise. This is normal and  
necessary with AWD hardware.  
whenever the vehicle is started. To  
limit wheel spin, especially in  
slippery road conditions, the system  
should always be left on. But, TCS  
can be turned off if needed.  
It may be necessary to turn the  
system off if the vehicle ever gets  
stuck in sand, mud or snow and  
rocking the vehicle is required. See  
If the Vehicle is Stuck on page 823  
for more information. See also  
Winter Driving on page 821 for  
information on using TCS when  
driving in snowy or icy conditions.  
Traction control can be turned off by  
pressing and releasing the TCS/  
StabiliTrak button, on the console,  
until the TCS/StabiliTrak light comes  
on the instrument panel and  
Traction Control Offappears in the  
DIC. Press the button again to turn  
the system back on. For information  
on turning StabiliTrak off and on,  
see StabiliTrak Systemfollowing in  
this section.  
Notice: Do not repeatedly brake  
or accelerate heavily when TCS is  
off. The vehicle's driveline could  
be damaged.  
Adding nonGM accessories can  
affect the vehicle's performance.  
See Accessories and Modifications  
on page 94 for more information.  
The TCS off light comes on and  
Traction Control Offis displayed  
on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) to indicate that the traction  
control system has been turned off.  
See Ride Control System Messages  
on page 431  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-43  
This also occurs when traction  
control is activated. A noise may  
be heard or vibration may be felt in  
the brake pedal. This is normal.  
Continue to steer the vehicle in the  
intended direction.  
StabiliTrak System  
The vehicle has a vehicle stability  
enhancement system called  
StabiliTrak. It is an advanced  
computer controlled system that  
assists with directional control of the  
vehicle in difficult driving conditions.  
StabiliTrak can be turned off by  
pressing and holding the TCS/  
StabiliTrak button, on the console,  
until the TCS Off and StabiliTrak Off  
lights come on the instrument panel  
and StabiliTrak Offappears in the  
DIC. For information on turning TCS  
off and on, see Traction Control  
System (TCS)earlier in this  
section.  
If there is a problem detected with  
StabiliTrak, a Service StabiliTrak”  
message will be displayed on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC).  
When this message is displayed  
and the StabiliTrak light comes on,  
the system is not operational.  
Driving should be adjusted  
StabiliTrak activates when the  
computer senses a difference  
between the intended path and the  
direction the vehicle is actually  
traveling. StabiliTrak selectively  
applies braking pressure at any one  
of the vehicle's brakes to help steer  
the vehicle in the intended direction.  
accordingly. See Ride Control  
System Messages on page 431  
.
If cruise control is being used when  
StabiliTrak activates, the cruise  
control will automatically disengage.  
Press the cruise control button to  
reengage when road conditions  
allow. See Cruise Control on  
StabiliTrak comes on automatically  
whenever the vehicle is started. To  
assist with directional control of the  
vehicle, the system should always  
be left on.  
page 844 for more information.  
When the stability control system  
activates, the Traction Control  
System (TCS)/StabiliTrak light will  
flash on the instrument panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-44  
Driving and Operating  
Cruise Control  
WARNING  
{
With cruise control, the vehicle can  
maintain a speed of about 40 km/h  
(25 mph) or more without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator. Cruise  
control does not work at speeds  
below 40 km/h (25 mph).  
Cruise control can be dangerous  
where you cannot drive safely at  
a steady speed. So, do not use  
the cruise control on winding  
roads or in heavy traffic.  
Cruise control can be dangerous  
on slippery roads. On such roads,  
fast changes in tire traction can  
cause excessive wheel slip, and  
you could lose control. Do not use  
cruise control on slippery roads.  
If the brakes are applied, the cruise  
control is turned off.  
If the vehicle has a StabiliTrak® or  
traction control system and begins  
to limit wheel spin while using  
cruise control, the cruise control  
automatically disengages. See  
StabiliTrak System on page 843 or  
Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 841. When road conditions  
allow you to safely use it again, the  
cruise control can be turned  
back on.  
The cruise control buttons are  
located on the steering wheel.  
5 (On/Off): Press to turn the  
cruise control system on and off.  
\ (Cancel): Press to disengage  
cruise control without erasing the  
set speed from memory.  
RES/+ (Resume/Accel): Move the  
thumbwheel up to resume a set  
speed or to accelerate to a higher  
speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-45  
.
To increase the speed in small  
amounts, move the thumbwheel  
up toward RES/+ briefly and  
then release it. Each time this is  
done, the vehicle goes about  
1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.  
SET/(Set/Coast): Move the  
thumbwheel down toward SET/−  
to set a speed and activate cruise  
control, or to make the vehicle  
decelerate.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
If the cruise control is set at a  
desired speed and then the brakes  
are applied or the Cancel button is  
pressed, the cruise control is  
disengaged without erasing the  
set speed from memory.  
Setting Cruise Control  
Reducing Speed While Using  
Cruise Control  
If the cruise button is on when not in  
use, it could get bumped and go into  
cruise when not desired. Keep the  
cruise button turned off when cruise  
control is not being used.  
Once the vehicle reaches about  
40 km/h (25 mph) or more, move  
the thumbwheel up toward RES/+  
briefly. The vehicle returns to the  
speed selected previously and stays  
there.  
If the cruise control system is  
already activated,  
.
Move the thumbwheel down  
toward SET/and hold until the  
desired lower speed is reached,  
then release it.  
To set a speed:  
1. Press 5 to turn the cruise  
Increasing Speed While Using  
Cruise Control  
control system on.  
.
To slow down in very small  
2. Get to the speed desired.  
amounts, move the thumbwheel  
down toward SET/briefly and  
then release it. Each time this is  
done, the vehicle goes about  
1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.  
If the cruise control system is  
already activated,  
3. Move the thumbwheel down  
toward SET/and release it.  
The desired set speed briefly  
appears in the instrument panel  
cluster.  
.
Move the thumbwheel up  
toward RES/+ and hold it until  
the vehicle accelerates to the  
desired speed, and then  
release it.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-46  
Driving and Operating  
Passing Another Vehicle While  
Using Cruise Control  
Ending Cruise Control  
Object Detection  
Systems  
There are three ways to end cruise  
control:  
Use the accelerator pedal to  
increase the vehicle's speed.  
When you take your foot off the  
pedal, the vehicle will slow down to  
the previous set cruise speed.  
.
Step lightly on the brake pedal  
Ultrasonic Parking Assist  
or clutch; when cruise control  
disengages, the indicator light  
will go off.  
For vehicles with the Ultrasonic  
Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system,  
it assists the driver with parking  
and avoiding objects while in  
R (Reverse). URPA operates at  
speeds less than 8 km/h (5 mph),  
and the sensors on the rear bumper  
detect objects up to 2.5 m (8 ft)  
behind the vehicle, and at least  
20 cm (8 in) off the ground.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
.
Press \.  
How well the cruise control works  
on hills depends upon the vehicle  
speed, load, and the steepness of  
the hills. When going up steep hills,  
you might have to step on the  
accelerator pedal to maintain the  
vehicle speed. When going  
downhill, you might have to brake or  
shift to a lower gear to maintain the  
vehicle's speed. When the brakes  
are applied the cruise control  
shuts off.  
.
Press 5 to turn the cruise  
control system off completely.  
The cruise control cannot be  
resumed.  
Erasing Speed Memory  
The cruise control set speed is  
erased from memory by pressing  
the 5 button or if the ignition is  
turned off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-47  
The display is located in the  
headliner.  
If the vehicle is traveling faster then  
8 km/h (5 mph) in reverse, the red  
light on the rear display flashes.  
WARNING  
{
URPA uses three color-coded lights  
to provide distance and system  
information.  
The Ultrasonic Rear Parking  
Assist (URPA) system does not  
replace driver vision. It cannot  
detect:  
Objects must be at least 20 cm (8 in)  
off the ground, below liftgate level,  
and within 2.5 m (8 ft) from the rear  
bumper to be detected. The  
distance may be less during warmer  
or humid weather.  
.
Objects that are below the  
bumper, underneath the  
vehicle, or if they are too  
close or far from the vehicle  
A single beep sounds the first time  
an object is detected between 0.6 m  
(23 in) and 2.5 m (8 ft) away.  
Beeping occurs continuously when  
the vehicle is 0.6 m (23 in) or closer  
to an object.  
.
Children, pedestrians,  
bicyclists, or pets.  
If you do not use proper care  
before and while backing; vehicle  
damage, injury, or death could  
occur. Even with URPA, always  
check behind the vehicle before  
backing up. While backing, be  
sure to look for objects and check  
the vehicle's mirrors.  
How the System Works  
URPA comes on automatically and  
the display briefly illuminates to  
indicate the system is working when  
the shift lever is moved into  
R (Reverse).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-48  
Driving and Operating  
The following describes how the URPA display lights appear as the vehicle  
gets closer to a detected object:  
When the System Does Not  
Seem to Work Properly  
Description  
amber light  
Metric  
2.5 m  
1.0 m  
English  
8 ft  
If the URPA system does not  
activate due to a temporary  
condition, the message Park Assist  
Off displays on the DIC and a red  
light is shown on the rear URPA  
display when the shift lever is  
moved into R (Reverse). This can  
occur under the following  
amber/amber lights  
40 in  
amber/amber/red lights and  
continuous beeping for  
five seconds  
0.6 m  
0.3 m  
23 in  
1 ft  
amber/amber/red lights flashing  
and continuous beeping for  
five seconds  
conditions:  
.
The ultrasonic sensors are not  
clean. Keep the vehicle's rear  
bumper free of mud, dirt, snow,  
ice and slush. For cleaning  
instructions, see Exterior Care  
Park Assist Off displays on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC) to  
indicate that URPA is off, see Driver  
Information Center (DIC) on  
The settings are:  
.
on page 975  
.
On: Turns URPA on  
Off: Turns URPA off  
.
.
.
A trailer was attached to the  
vehicle, or an object was  
page 424 for more information.  
Tow Bar: Use when a tow bar is  
attached to the vehicle  
hanging out of the liftgate during  
the last drive cycle, a red light  
may come on in the rear display.  
Once the attached object is  
removed, URPA will return to  
normal operation.  
System Settings  
Tow Bar  
Each time the vehicle is started  
URPA defaults to the On setting.  
When the tow bar setting is used,  
an area of 16 cm (6 in) around the  
hitch is not detected by the system.  
Use the Vehicle Personalization on  
page 434 menu to  
configure URPA.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-49  
.
A tow bar is attached to the  
vehicle and the tow bar setting is  
not being used, or an odd  
shaped tow bar is attached to  
the vehicle and the tow bar  
setting is being used.  
Rear Vision  
Camera (RVC)  
WARNING (Continued)  
Do not back the vehicle by only  
looking at the RVC screen, or use  
the screen during longer, higher  
speed backing maneuvers or  
where there could be cross-traffic.  
Your judged distances using the  
screen will differ from actual  
distances.  
The vehicle may have a Rear Vision  
Camera (RVC) system. Read this  
entire section before using it.  
.
.
The vehicle's bumper is  
damaged. Take the vehicle to  
your dealer to repair the system.  
The RVC can assist the driver when  
backing up by displaying a view of  
the area behind the vehicle.  
Other conditions may affect  
system performance, such as  
vibrations from a jackhammer or  
the compression of air brakes on  
a very large truck.  
WARNING  
{
So if you do not use proper care  
before backing up, you could hit a  
vehicle, child, pedestrian,  
bicyclist, or pet, resulting in  
vehicle damage, injury, or death.  
Even though the vehicle has the  
RVC system, always check  
carefully before backing up by  
checking behind and around the  
vehicle.  
The Rear Vision Camera (RVC)  
system does not replace driver  
vision. RVC does not:  
If the system is still disabled, after  
driving forward at least 25 km/h  
(15 mph), take the vehicle to your  
dealer.  
.
Detect objects that are  
outside the camera's field of  
view, below the bumper,  
or underneath the vehicle.  
.
Detect children, pedestrians,  
bicyclists, or pets.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-50  
Driving and Operating  
Turning the Rear Vision Camera  
System On or Off  
Vehicles Without a Navigation  
System  
Vehicles With a Navigation  
System  
To turn the rear vision camera  
system on or off:  
When the key is in the ON/RUN  
position and the driver shifts the  
vehicle into R (Reverse), the video  
image automatically appears on the  
inside rear view mirror. Once the  
driver shifts out of R (Reverse),  
the video image automatically  
disappears from the inside rear view  
mirror.  
An image appears on the navigation  
screen with the message Check  
Surroundings for Safetywhen the  
vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).  
The navigation screen goes to the  
previous screen after approximately  
10 seconds once the vehicle is  
shifted out of R (Reverse).  
1. Shift into P (Park).  
2. Press the CONFIG button.  
3. Select Display.  
To cancel the delay, do one of the  
following:  
Turning the Rear Vision Camera  
System Off or On  
.
Press a hard key on the  
navigation system.  
To turn off the RVC system, press  
.
and hold z, located on the inside  
rearview mirror, until the left  
indicator light turns off. The RVC  
display is now disabled.  
Shift into P (Park).  
.
Reach a vehicle speed of  
8 km/h (5 mph).  
To turn the RVC system on again,  
press and hold z until the left  
indicator light illuminates. The RVC  
system display is now enabled and  
the display will appear in the mirror  
normally.  
4. Select Camera. When a check  
mark appears next to the  
Camera option, then the RVC  
system is on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-51  
Symbols  
Guidelines  
Rear Vision Camera Location  
The navigation system may have a  
feature that lets the driver view  
symbols on the navigation screen  
while using the RVC. The Ultrasonic  
Rear Park Assist (URPA) system  
must not be disabled to use the  
caution symbols. The error message  
Rear Parking Assist Symbols  
Unavailablemay display if URPA  
has been disabled and the symbols  
have been turned on. See  
The RVC system has a guideline  
overlay that can help the driver align  
the vehicle when backing into a  
parking spot.  
To turn the guidelines on or off:  
1. Shift into P (Park).  
2. Press the CONFIG button.  
3. Select Display.  
4. Select Guidelines. When a  
check mark appears next to the  
Guidelines option, guidelines will  
appear.  
Ultrasonic Parking Assist on  
page 846  
.
The camera is located above the  
license plate.  
The symbols appear and may cover  
an object when viewing the  
navigation screen when an object is  
detected by the URPA system.  
Rear Vision Camera Error  
Messages  
The area displayed by the camera is  
limited.  
SERVICE REAR VISION CAMERA  
SYSTEM: This message can  
display on the navigation screen  
when the system is not receiving  
information it requires from other  
vehicle systems.  
To turn the symbols on or off:  
1. Shift into P (Park).  
It does not display objects that are  
close to either corner or under the  
bumper and can vary depending on  
vehicle orientation or road  
2. Press the CONFIG button.  
3. Select Display.  
conditions. The distance of the  
image that appears on the screen is  
different from the actual distance.  
If any other problem occurs or if a  
problem persists, see your dealer.  
4. Select Symbols. When a check  
mark appears next to the  
Symbols option, symbols will  
appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-52  
Driving and Operating  
.
The back of the vehicle is in an  
accident, the position and  
mounting angle of the camera  
can change or the camera can  
be affected. Be sure to have the  
camera and its position and  
mounting angle checked at your  
dealer.  
The following illustration shows the  
field of view that the camera  
provides.  
A. View displayed by the camera.  
B. Corner of the rear bumper.  
When the System Does Not  
Seem To Work Properly  
The RVC system may not work  
properly or display a clear image if:  
.
The RVC is turned off. See  
The RVC system display in the  
rearview mirror may turn off or not  
appear as expected due to one of  
the following conditions. If this  
occurs the left indicator light on the  
mirror will flash.  
Turning the Rear Camera  
System On or Offearlier in this  
section.  
.
It is dark.  
.
The sun or the beam of  
headlights is shining directly into  
the camera lens.  
.
A slow flash may indicate a loss  
of video signal, or no video  
signal present during the reverse  
cycle.  
.
Ice, snow, mud, or anything else  
builds up on the camera lens.  
Clean the lens, rinse it with  
water, and wipe it with a soft  
cloth.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-53  
.
A fast flash may indicate that the  
display has been on for the  
maximum allowable time during  
a reverse cycle, or the display  
has reached an over  
Fuel  
Use of the recommended fuel is an  
important part of the proper  
maintenance of this vehicle. To help  
keep the engine clean and maintain  
optimum vehicle performance, we  
recommend the use of gasoline  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline.  
temperature limit.  
The fast flash conditions are  
used to protect the video device  
from high temperature  
conditions. Once conditions  
return to normal the device will  
reset and the green indicator will  
stop flashing.  
Look for the TOP TIER label on the  
fuel pump to ensure gasoline meets  
enhanced detergency standards  
developed by auto companies. A list  
of marketers providing TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline can be found at  
www.toptiergas.com.  
During any of these fault conditions,  
the display will be blank and the  
indicator will continue to flash as  
long as the vehicle is in R (Reverse)  
or until the conditions return to  
normal.  
Pressing and holding z when the  
left indicator light is flashing will turn  
off the video display along with the  
left indicator light.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-54  
Driving and Operating  
Recommended Fuel  
California Fuel  
Requirements  
Fuels in Foreign  
Countries  
If you plan on driving in another  
country outside the United States or  
Canada, the proper fuel might be  
hard to find. Never use leaded  
gasoline or any other fuel not  
recommended in the previous text  
on fuel. Costly repairs caused by  
use of improper fuel would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Use regular unleaded gasoline with  
a posted octane rating of 87 or  
higher. If the octane rating is less  
than 87, an audible knocking noise,  
commonly referred to as spark  
knock, might be heard when driving.  
If this occurs, use a gasoline rated  
at 87 octane or higher as soon as  
possible. If heavy knocking is heard  
when using gasoline rated at  
87 octane or higher, the engine  
needs service.  
If the vehicle is certified to meet  
California Emissions Standards, it is  
designed to operate on fuels that  
meet California specifications. See  
the underhood emission control  
label. If this fuel is not available in  
states adopting California emissions  
standards, the vehicle will operate  
satisfactorily on fuels meeting  
federal specifications, but emission  
control system performance might  
be affected. The malfunction  
To check the fuel availability, ask an  
auto club, or contact a major oil  
company that does business in the  
country where you will be driving.  
Gasoline Specifications  
indicator lamp could turn on and the  
vehicle might fail a smogcheck test.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on  
page 416. If this occurs, return to  
your authorized dealer for diagnosis.  
If it is determined that the condition  
is caused by the type of fuel used,  
repairs might not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
At a minimum, gasoline should meet  
ASTM specification D 4814 in the  
United States or CAN/CGSB3.5  
or 3.511 in Canada. Some  
gasolines contain an  
octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl  
manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).  
We recommend against the use of  
gasolines containing MMT. See Fuel  
Additives on page 855 for  
additional information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-55  
For customers who do not use TOP  
TIER Detergent Gasoline regularly,  
one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel  
tank at every engine oil change, can  
help clean deposits from fuel  
injectors and intake valves. GM Fuel  
System Treatment PLUS is the only  
gasoline additive recommended by  
General Motors. It is available at  
your dealer.  
Notice: This vehicle was not  
Fuel Additives  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines  
in the United States are now  
designed for fuel that contains  
methanol. Do not use fuel  
containing methanol. It can  
corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic  
and rubber parts. That damage  
would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
required to contain additives that  
help prevent engine and fuel system  
deposits from forming, allowing the  
emission control system to work  
properly. In most cases, nothing  
should have to be added to the fuel.  
However, some gasolines contain  
only the minimum amount of  
additive required to meet U.S.  
Environmental Protection Agency  
regulations. To help keep fuel  
injectors and intake valves clean,  
or if the vehicle experiences  
problems due to dirty injectors or  
valves, look for gasoline that is  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline. Look for the TOP  
TIER label on the fuel pump to  
ensure gasoline meets enhanced  
detergency standards developed by  
the auto companies. A list of  
Some gasolines that are  
not reformulated for low  
emissions can contain an  
Gasolines containing oxygenates,  
such as ethers and ethanol, and  
reformulated gasolines might be  
available in your area. We  
recommend that you use these  
gasolines, if they comply with the  
specifications described earlier.  
However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more than  
10% ethanol must not be used in  
vehicles that were not designed for  
those fuels.  
octane-enhancing additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese  
tricarbonyl (MMT); ask the attendant  
where you buy gasoline whether the  
fuel contains MMT. We recommend  
against the use of such gasolines.  
Fuels containing MMT can reduce  
the life of spark plugs and the  
performance of the emission control  
system could be affected. The  
malfunction indicator lamp might  
turn on. If this occurs, return to your  
dealer for service.  
marketers providing TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline can be found at  
www.toptiergas.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-56  
Driving and Operating  
The fuel cap is behind the fuel door  
on the vehicle's passenger side.  
Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise  
to remove. Do not release the cap  
too soon or it will spring back.  
Reinstall the cap by turning it  
clockwise until it clicks.  
Do not top off or overfill the tank and  
wait a few seconds before removing  
the nozzle. Clean fuel from painted  
surfaces as soon as possible. See  
Exterior Care on page 975.  
Filling the Tank  
WARNING  
{
Fuel vapor burns violently and a  
fuel fire can cause bad injuries.  
To help avoid injuries to you and  
others, read and follow all the  
instructions on the fuel pump  
island. Turn off the engine when  
refueling. Do not smoke near fuel  
or when refueling the vehicle. Do  
not use cellular phones. Keep  
sparks, flames, and smoking  
materials away from fuel. Do not  
leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is  
against the law in some places.  
Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away  
from the fuel pump; never let  
children pump fuel.  
WARNING  
{
If the cap is not properly installed,  
the Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
come on. See Malfunction Indicator  
Lamp on page 416 for more  
information.  
If a fire starts while you are  
refueling, do not remove the  
nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by  
notifying the station attendant.  
Leave the area immediately.  
WARNING  
{
Notice: If a new fuel cap is  
Fuel can spray out on you if you  
open the fuel cap too quickly.  
If you spill fuel and then  
something ignites it, you could be  
badly burned. This spray can  
happen if the tank is nearly full,  
and is more likely in hot weather.  
Open the fuel cap slowly and wait  
for any hiss noise to stop. Then  
unscrew the cap all the way.  
needed, be sure to get the right  
type of cap from your dealer. The  
wrong type fuel cap might not fit  
properly, might cause the  
malfunction indicator lamp to  
light, and could damage the fuel  
tank and emissions system. See  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp on  
page 416  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-57  
Filling a Portable Fuel  
Container  
Towing  
WARNING (Continued)  
General Towing  
Information  
Only use towing equipment that has  
been designed for the vehicle.  
Contact your dealer or trailering  
dealer for assistance with preparing  
the vehicle for towing a trailer.  
.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact  
with the inside of the fill  
opening before operating the  
nozzle. Contact should be  
maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
WARNING  
{
Never fill a portable fuel container  
while it is in the vehicle. Static  
electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel  
vapor. You can be badly burned  
and the vehicle damaged if this  
occurs. To help avoid injury to you  
and others:  
.
.
Do not smoke while  
pumping fuel.  
See the following trailer towing  
information in this section:  
Do not use a cellular phone  
while pumping fuel.  
.
For information on driving while  
.
towing a trailer, see Driving  
Characteristics and  
Towing Tips.  
Dispense fuel only into  
approved containers.  
.
Do not fill a container while it  
.
For maximum vehicle and trailer  
is inside a vehicle, in a  
vehicle's trunk, pickup bed,  
or on any surface other than  
the ground.  
weights, see Trailer Towing.  
.
For information on equipment to  
tow a trailer, see Towing  
Equipment.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-58  
Driving and Operating  
For information on towing a disabled  
vehicle, see Towing the Vehicle on  
page 972. For information on  
towing the vehicle behind another  
vehicle such as a motorhome,  
see Recreational Vehicle Towing on  
The following information has  
important trailering tips and rules for  
your safety and that of your  
passengers. Read this section  
carefully before pulling a trailer.  
WARNING (Continued)  
the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer  
only if all the steps in this section  
have been followed. Ask your  
dealer for advice and information  
about towing a trailer with the  
vehicle.  
Pulling A Trailer  
page 972  
.
Here are some important points:  
Driving Characteristics  
and Towing Tips  
.
There are many laws, including  
speed limit restrictions that apply  
to trailering. Check for legal  
requirements with state or  
provincial police.  
The vehicle can tow a trailer when  
equipped with the proper trailer  
towing equipment. For trailering  
capacity, see Trailer Towing”  
following in this section. Trailering  
changes handling, acceleration,  
braking, durability and fuel  
economy. With the added weight,  
the engine, transmission, wheel  
assemblies and tires are forced to  
work harder and under greater  
loads. The trailer also adds wind  
resistance, increasing the pulling  
requirements. For safe trailering,  
correctly use the proper trailering  
equipment.  
WARNING  
{
The driver can lose control when  
pulling a trailer if the correct  
equipment is not used or the  
vehicle is not driven properly.  
For example, if the trailer is too  
heavy, the brakes may not work  
well or even at all. The driver  
and passengers could be  
.
Do not tow a trailer at all during  
the first 1 600 km (1,000 miles)  
the new vehicle is driven. The  
engine, axle or other parts could  
be damaged.  
.
During the first 800 km  
(500 miles) that a trailer is  
towed, do not drive over 80 km/h  
(50 mph) and do not make starts  
at full throttle. This reduces wear  
on the vehicle.  
seriously injured. The vehicle may  
also be damaged; the resulting  
repairs would not be covered by  
(Continued)  
.
The vehicle can tow in D (Drive).  
Use a lower gear if the  
transmission shifts too often.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
Following Distance  
8-59  
.
.
Do not use the Fuel Saver Mode  
when towing.  
Check all trailer hitch parts and  
attachments, safety chains,  
Stay at least twice as far behind the  
vehicle ahead as you would when  
driving the vehicle without a trailer.  
This can help to avoid situations  
that require heavy braking and  
sudden turns.  
electrical connectors, lamps, tires  
and mirror adjustments. If the trailer  
has electric brakes, start the vehicle  
and trailer moving and then apply  
the trailer brake controller by hand  
to be sure the brakes are working.  
Obey speed limit restrictions.  
Do not drive faster than the  
maximum posted speed for  
trailers, or no more than 90 km/h  
(55 mph), to reduce wear on the  
vehicle.  
Passing  
.
During the trip, check regularly to be  
sure that the load is secure, and the  
lamps and trailer brakes are working  
properly.  
For vehicles with the Ultra Rear  
Parking Assist (URPA) system,  
turn the system off when towing  
a trailer. If the tow bar is  
More passing distance is needed  
when towing a trailer. Because the  
rig is longer, it is necessary to go  
farther beyond the passed vehicle  
before returning to the lane.  
installed while not towing a  
Towing with a Stability Control  
System  
trailer, change the URPA system  
to the Tow Barsetting. See  
Ultrasonic Parking Assist on  
page 846 for more information.  
Backing Up  
When towing, the sound of the  
stability control system might be  
heard. The system is reacting to the  
vehicle movement caused by the  
trailer, which mainly occurs during  
cornering. This is normal when  
towing heavier trailers.  
Hold the bottom of the steering  
wheel with one hand. To move the  
trailer to the left, move that hand to  
the left. To move the trailer to the  
right, move your hand to the right.  
Always back up slowly and,  
if possible, have someone  
Driving with a Trailer  
Towing a trailer requires experience.  
Get familiar with handling and  
braking with the added trailer  
weight. The vehicle is now longer  
and not as responsive as the  
vehicle is by itself.  
guide you.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-60  
Driving and Operating  
are burned out. Check occasionally  
to be sure the trailer bulbs are still  
working.  
engine off. If the overheat warning  
comes on, see Engine Overheating  
Making Turns  
Notice: Making very sharp turns  
while trailering could cause the  
trailer to come in contact with the  
vehicle. The vehicle could be  
damaged. Avoid making very  
sharp turns while trailering.  
on page 918  
.
Driving On Grades  
Parking on Hills  
Reduce speed and shift to a lower  
gear before starting down a long or  
steep downgrade. If the  
transmission is not shifted down, the  
brakes might have to be used so  
much that they would get hot and no  
longer work well.  
WARNING  
{
Parking the vehicle on a hill with  
the trailer attached can be  
When turning with a trailer, make  
wider turns than normal so the  
trailer will not strike soft shoulders,  
curbs, road signs, trees or other  
objects. Use the turn signal well in  
advance and avoid jerky or sudden  
maneuvers.  
dangerous. If something goes  
wrong, the rig could start to move.  
People can be injured, and both  
the vehicle and the trailer can be  
damaged. When possible, always  
park the rig on a flat surface.  
The vehicle can tow in D (Drive).  
Use a lower gear if the transmission  
shifts too often.  
Turn Signals When Towing  
a Trailer  
When towing at high altitude on  
steep uphill grades, engine coolant  
will boil at a lower temperature than  
at normal altitudes. If the engine is  
turned off immediately after towing  
at high altitude on steep uphill  
grades, the vehicle may show signs  
similar to engine overheating. To  
avoid this, let the engine run while  
parked, preferably on level ground,  
with the transmission in P (Park) for  
a few minutes before turning the  
If parking the rig on a hill:  
The turn signal indicators on the  
instrument panel flash whenever  
signaling a turn or lane change.  
Properly hooked up, the trailer  
lamps also flash, telling other  
drivers the vehicle is turning,  
changing lanes or stopping.  
1. Press the brake pedal, but do  
not shift into P (Park) yet. Turn  
the wheels into the curb if facing  
downhill or into traffic if facing  
uphill.  
2. Have someone place chocks  
under the trailer wheels.  
When towing a trailer, the arrows  
on the instrument panel flash for  
turns even if the bulbs on the trailer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
Trailer Towing  
8-61  
3. When the wheel chocks are in  
place, release the brake pedal  
until the chocks absorb the load.  
Maintenance When Trailer  
Towing  
Before pulling a trailer, there are  
three important considerations that  
have to do with weight:  
The vehicle needs service more  
often when pulling a trailer. See this  
manual's Maintenance Schedule or  
Index for more information. Things  
that are especially important in  
trailer operation are automatic  
transmission fluid, engine oil, axle  
lubricant, belts, cooling system and  
brake system. Inspect these before  
and during the trip.  
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then  
apply the parking brake and shift  
into P (Park).  
.
The weight of the trailer  
.
The weight of the trailer tongue  
5. Release the brake pedal.  
.
The total weight on the vehicle's  
Leaving After Parking on a Hill  
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.  
2. Start the engine.  
tires  
Weight of the Trailer  
How heavy can a trailer safely be?  
3. Shift into a gear.  
Check periodically to see that all  
hitch nuts and bolts are tight.  
Speed, altitude, road grades,  
outside temperature, special  
equipment, and the amount of  
tongue weight the vehicle can carry  
must be considered. See Weight of  
the Trailer Tonguelater in this  
section for more information.  
4. Release the parking brake.  
5. Let up on the brake pedal.  
Engine Cooling When Trailer  
Towing  
6. Drive slowly until the trailer is  
clear of the chocks.  
The cooling system may temporarily  
overheat during severe operating  
conditions. See Engine Overheating  
7. Stop and have someone pick up  
and store the chocks.  
Maximum trailer weight is calculated  
assuming only the driver is in the  
tow vehicle and it has all the  
on page 918  
.
required trailering equipment.  
The weight of additional optional  
equipment, passengers and cargo in  
the tow vehicle must be subtracted  
from the maximum trailer weight.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-62  
Driving and Operating  
Use the following chart to determine how much the vehicle can weigh,  
based upon the vehicle model and options.  
If there are a lot of options,  
equipment, passengers or cargo in  
the vehicle, it will reduce the tongue  
weight the vehicle can carry, which  
will also reduce the trailer weight the  
vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer,  
the tongue load must be added to  
the GVW because the vehicle will  
be carrying that weight, too. See  
Vehicle Load Limits on page 824.  
Maximum Trailer  
Weight with Trailer  
Brakes†  
GCWR*  
Vehicle  
L4 Engine, FWD  
L4 Engine, AWD  
V6 Engine, FWD  
V6 Engine, AWD  
680 kg (1,500 lbs)  
680 kg (1,500 lbs)  
1 588 kg (3,500 lbs)  
1 588 kg (3,500 lbs)  
2 625 kg (5,787 lbs)  
2 700 kg (5,952 lbs)  
3 600 kg (7,937 lbs)  
3 700 kg (8,157 lbs)  
For trailers without trailer brakes the maximum trailer weight is 454 kg  
(1,000 lbs) and the GCWR is 2 300 kg (5,071 lbs). See Towing Equipment  
on page 863 for more information.  
*The Gross Combination Weight  
Rating (GCWR) is the total  
Weight of the Trailer Tongue  
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is  
an important weight to measure  
because it affects the total gross  
weight of the vehicle. The Gross  
Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes the  
curb weight of the vehicle, any  
cargo carried in it, and the people  
who will be riding in the vehicle.  
allowable weight of the completely  
loaded vehicle and trailer including  
any passengers, cargo, equipment  
and conversions. The GCWR for the  
vehicle should not be exceeded.  
If a weight-carrying hitch or a  
weight-distributing hitch is being  
used, the trailer tongue (A) should  
weigh 10 to 15 percent of the total  
loaded trailer weight (B).  
Ask your dealer for our trailering  
information or advice. See  
Customer Assistance Offices on  
page 123 for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving and Operating  
8-63  
After loading the trailer, weigh the  
trailer and then the tongue,  
separately, to see if the weights are  
proper. If they are not, adjustments  
might be made by moving some  
items around in the trailer.  
Total Weight on the Vehicle's  
Tires  
Towing Equipment  
Hitches  
Inflate the vehicle's tires to the  
upper limit for cold tires. These  
numbers can be found on the  
Certification label or see Vehicle  
Load Limits on page 824 for more  
information. Do not go over the  
GVW limit for the vehicle, or the  
GAWR, including the weight of the  
trailer tongue. If using a weight  
distributing hitch, do not go over the  
rear axle limit before applying the  
weight distribution spring bars.  
Use the correct hitch equipment.  
See your dealer or a hitch dealer for  
assistance.  
Trailering may be limited by the  
vehicle's ability to carry tongue  
weight. Tongue weight cannot cause  
the vehicle to exceed the GVWR  
(Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) or  
the RGAWR (Rear Gross Axle  
Weight Rating). The effect of  
additional weight may reduce the  
trailering capacity more than the  
total of the additional weight.  
.
The rear bumper on the vehicle  
is not intended for hitches. Do  
not attach rental hitches or other  
bumper-type hitches to it. Use  
only a frame-mounted hitch that  
does not attach to the bumper.  
.
Will any holes be made in the  
body of the vehicle when the  
trailer hitch is installed? If there  
are, seal the holes when the  
hitch is removed. If the holes are  
not sealed, dirt, water, and  
deadly carbon monoxide (CO)  
from the exhaust can get into the  
vehicle. See Engine Exhaust on  
It is important that the vehicle  
does not exceed any of its  
ratings GCWR, GVWR, RGAWR,  
Maximum Trailer Rating or Tongue  
Weight. The only way to be sure it is  
not exceeding any of these ratings  
is to weigh the vehicle and trailer.  
page 834  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-64  
Driving and Operating  
Safety Chains  
Trailer Sway  
Control (TSC)  
The vehicle has a Trailer Sway  
Control (TSC) feature as part of the  
StabiliTrak system. If TSC detects  
that the trailer is swaying, the  
vehicle's brakes are automatically  
applied.  
Conversions and  
Add-Ons  
Always attach chains between the  
vehicle and the trailer. Cross the  
safety chains under the tongue of  
the trailer to help prevent the tongue  
from contacting the road if it  
becomes separated from the hitch.  
Leave enough slack so the rig can  
turn. Never allow safety chains to  
drag on the ground.  
Add-On Electrical  
Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything  
electrical to the vehicle unless  
you check with your dealer first.  
Some electrical equipment can  
damage the vehicle and the  
damage would not be covered by  
the vehicle's warranty. Some  
add-on electrical equipment can  
keep other components from  
working as they should.  
Trailer Brakes  
Does the trailer have its own  
brakes? Be sure to read and follow  
the instructions for the trailer brakes  
so they are installed, adjusted and  
maintained properly.  
When TSC is applying the brakes,  
the TCS/StabiliTrak indicator light  
flashes to notify the driver to reduce  
speed. See Traction Control System  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light on  
page 421. If the trailer continues to  
sway, StabiliTrak will reduce engine  
torque to help slow the vehicle.  
Add-on equipment can drain the  
vehicle battery, even if the vehicle is  
not operating.  
Because the vehicle has antilock  
brakes, do not tap into the vehicle's  
brake system. If this is done, both  
brake systems will not work well,  
or at all.  
The vehicle has an airbag system.  
Before attempting to add anything  
electrical to the vehicle, see  
Servicing the Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 234 and Adding  
Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 235.  
TSC will not function if StabiliTrak is  
turned off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-1  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . 9-13  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15  
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . 9-18  
Power Steering Fluid (2.4L  
L4 Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20  
Power Steering Fluid (3.0L  
V6 Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24  
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24  
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Automatic Transmission Shift  
Lock Control System  
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Ignition Transmission Lock  
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Park Brake and P (Park)  
Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . . 9-26  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . 9-26  
Headlamp Aiming  
Vehicle Care  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27  
Bulb Replacement  
General Information  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
California Proposition  
65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Accessories and  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 9-30  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,  
Sidemarker, and Parking  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-30  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31  
Taillamps, Turn Signal,  
Sidemarker, Stoplamps,  
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
and Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . 9-32  
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . 9-33  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Vehicle Checks  
Doing Your Own  
Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5  
Engine Compartment  
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6  
Engine Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . 9-11  
Automatic Transmission  
Electrical System  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Engine Compartment Fuse  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Instrument Panel Fuse  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-2  
Vehicle Care  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54  
Different Size Tires and  
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-55  
Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-56  
Wheel Alignment and Tire  
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-57  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . 9-57  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-58  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . 9-59  
Tire Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . 9-68  
Wheels and Tires  
Towing  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40  
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . 9-40  
Tire Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42  
Tire Terminology and  
Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 9-72  
Recreational Vehicle  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-72  
Appearance Care  
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-75  
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-79  
Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-43  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-46  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-47  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-49  
Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-52  
Tire Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-52  
When It Is Time for New  
Jump Starting  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-69  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-3  
California Proposition  
65 Warning  
California Perchlorate  
Materials Requirements  
General Information  
For service and parts needs, visit  
your dealer. You will receive  
genuine GM parts and GM-trained  
and supported service people.  
Most motor vehicles, including this  
one, contain and/or emit chemicals  
known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or  
other reproductive harm. Engine  
exhaust, many parts and systems,  
many fluids, and some component  
wear by-products contain and/or  
emit these chemicals.  
Certain types of automotive  
applications, such as airbag  
initiators, seat belt pretensioners,  
and lithium batteries contained in  
remote keyless transmitters, may  
contain perchlorate materials.  
Special handling may be necessary.  
For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/  
perchlorate.  
Genuine GM parts have one of  
these marks:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-4  
Vehicle Care  
GM Accessories are designed to  
complement and function with other  
systems on the vehicle. Your GM  
dealer can accessorize the vehicle  
using genuine GM Accessories.  
When you go to your GM dealer and  
ask for GM Accessories, you will  
know that GM-trained and  
Accessories and  
Modifications  
Vehicle Checks  
Doing Your Own  
Service Work  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer  
accessories to the vehicle can affect  
vehicle performance and safety,  
including such things as airbags,  
braking, stability, ride and handling,  
emissions systems, aerodynamics,  
durability, and electronic systems  
like antilock brakes, traction control,  
and stability control. Some of these  
accessories could even cause  
malfunction or damage not covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
WARNING  
{
supported service technicians will  
perform the work using genuine GM  
Accessories.  
You can be injured and the  
vehicle could be damaged if you  
try to do service work on a vehicle  
without knowing enough about it.  
Also, see Adding Equipment to the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
.
Be sure you have sufficient  
page 235  
.
knowledge, experience,  
the proper replacement  
parts, and tools before  
attempting any vehicle  
maintenance task.  
Damage to vehicle components  
resulting from the installation or use  
of nonGM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, is not  
covered under the terms of the  
vehicle warranty and may affect  
remaining warranty coverage for  
affected parts.  
.
Be sure to use the proper  
nuts, bolts, and other  
fasteners. English and metric  
fasteners can be easily  
confused. If the wrong  
fasteners are used, parts can  
later break or fall off. You  
could be hurt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-5  
If doing some of your own service  
work, use the proper service  
Hood  
To open the hood:  
manual. It tells you much more  
about how to service the vehicle  
than this manual can. To order the  
proper service manual, see Service  
Publications Ordering Information on  
page 1212  
.
This vehicle has an airbag system.  
Before attempting to do your own  
service work, see Servicing the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
2. Move the secondary hood  
release lever to the right to  
page 234  
.
Keep a record with all parts receipts  
and list the mileage and the date of  
any service work performed. See  
Maintenance Records on  
release the striker. The lever is  
near the middle of the hood.  
1. Pull the release handle with the  
symbol on it. It is below the  
instrument panel, to the left of  
the steering wheel.  
3. Lift the hood.  
page 1010  
.
Before closing the hood, check all  
filler caps are properly installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-6  
Vehicle Care  
Engine Compartment Overview  
2.4L L4 Engine  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-7  
A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on  
page 913  
E. Brake Fluid Reservoir. See  
I. Battery on page 924.  
.
Brakes on page 921.  
J. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and  
Pressure Cap. See Engine  
Coolant on page 915.  
B. Engine Cover on page 99.  
F. Engine Compartment Fuse  
Block on page 934.  
C. Engine Oil Dipstick (out of  
view). See Engine Oil on  
G. Remote Positive (+) Terminal.  
K. Windshield Washer Fluid  
page 910  
.
See Jump Starting on  
Reservoir. See Washer Fluid on  
page 969  
.
page 921.  
D. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See Engine  
Oil on page 910.  
H. Remote Negative () Terminal.  
See Jump Starting on  
page 969  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-8  
Vehicle Care  
3.0L V6 Engine  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Engine Cover  
9-9  
A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on  
page 913  
G. Engine Compartment Fuse  
Block on page 934.  
.
3.0L V6 Engine Cover  
B. Power Steering Fluid (2.4L L4  
Engine) on page 920 or  
H. Remote Positive (+) Terminal.  
See Jump Starting on  
Power Steering Fluid (3.0L  
V6 Engine) on page 920.  
page 969.  
I. Remote Negative () Terminal.  
See Jump Starting on  
C. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See Engine  
Oil on page 910.  
page 969  
.
D. Engine Cover on page 99.  
J. Battery on page 924.  
E. Engine Oil Dipstick (out of  
K. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and  
Pressure Cap. See Engine  
Coolant on page 915.  
view). See Engine Oil on  
page 910  
.
F. Brake Fluid Reservoir. See  
L. Windshield Washer Fluid  
Brakes on page 921.  
Reservoir. See Washer Fluid on  
page 921  
.
To remove:  
1. Remove the oil fill cap.  
2. Hold cover on both sides and  
pull upward.  
3. Lift and remove the engine  
cover.  
4. Install cover by aligning on oil fill  
tube, then firmly pushing down  
onto the intake manifold.  
5. Install the oil fill cap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-10  
Vehicle Care  
When to Add Engine Oil  
Engine Oil  
Checking Engine Oil  
It is a good idea to check the engine  
oil level at each fuel fill. In order to  
get an accurate reading, the oil  
must be warm and the vehicle must  
be on level ground.  
See Engine Compartment Overview  
on page 96 for the location of the  
engine oil fill cap.  
If the oil is below the cross-hatched  
area at the tip of the dipstick, add at  
least one liter/quart of the  
recommended oil. This section  
explains what kind of oil to use. For  
engine oil crankcase capacity, see  
Capacities and Specifications on  
The engine oil dipstick handle is a  
yellow loop. See Engine  
Compartment Overview on  
page 96 for the location of the  
engine oil dipstick.  
Add enough oil to put the level  
somewhere in the proper operating  
range. Push the dipstick all the way  
back in when through.  
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use  
1. Turn off the engine and give the  
oil several minutes to drain back  
into the oil pan. If this is not  
done, the oil dipstick might not  
show the actual level.  
page 112  
.
Look for three things:  
.
Notice: Do not add too much oil.  
If the engine has so much oil that  
the oil level gets above the  
cross-hatched area that shows  
the proper operating range, the  
engine could be damaged.  
GM6094M  
Use only an oil that meets GM  
Standard GM6094M.  
2. Pull out the dipstick and clean it  
with a paper towel or cloth, then  
push it back in all the way.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the  
vehicle. These numbers on an  
oil container show its viscosity,  
or thickness. Do not use other  
viscosity oils such as  
Remove it again, keeping the tip  
down, and check the level.  
SAE 20W-50.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-11  
.
American Petroleum Institute  
(API) starburst symbol  
Cold Temperature Operation  
Engine Oil Life System  
If in an area of extreme cold, where  
the temperature falls below 29°C  
(20°F), use either an SAE 5W-30  
synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30  
engine oil. Both provide easier cold  
starting for the engine at extremely  
low temperatures. Always use an oil  
that meets the required  
When to Change Engine Oil  
This vehicle has a computer system  
that indicates when to change the  
engine oil and filter. This is based  
on engine revolutions and engine  
temperature, and not on mileage.  
Based on driving conditions, the  
mileage at which an oil change is  
indicated can vary considerably. For  
the oil life system to work properly,  
the system must be reset every time  
the oil is changed.  
Oils meeting these requirements  
should have the starburst  
symbol on the container. This  
symbol indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API).  
specification, GM6094M.  
Engine Oil Additives / Engine  
Oil Flushes  
Do not add anything to the oil. The  
recommended oils with the starburst  
symbol that meet GM standards are  
all that is needed for good  
When the system has calculated  
that oil life has been diminished, it  
indicates that an oil change is  
necessary. A Change Engine Oil  
Soonmessage comes on. See  
Engine Oil Messages on  
page 430. Change the oil as soon  
as possible within the next 1 000 km  
(600 miles). It is possible that,  
Notice: Use only engine oil  
identified as meeting GM  
Standard GM6094M and showing  
the American Petroleum Institute  
Certified For Gasoline Engines  
starburst symbol. Failure to use  
the recommended oil can result  
in engine damage not covered by  
the vehicle warranty.  
performance and engine protection.  
Engine oil system flushes are not  
recommended and could cause  
engine damage not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
if driving under the best conditions,  
the oil life system might not indicate  
that an oil change is necessary for  
over a year. However, the engine oil  
and filter must be changed at least  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-12  
Vehicle Care  
once a year and at this time the  
system must be reset. Your dealer  
has trained service people who will  
perform this work using genuine  
parts and reset the system. It is also  
important to check the oil regularly  
and keep it at the proper level.  
If the vehicle has Driver Information  
Center (DIC) buttons:  
Used oil can be a threat to the  
environment. If you change your  
own oil, be sure to drain all the oil  
from the filter before disposal. Never  
dispose of oil by putting it in the  
trash, pouring it on the ground, into  
sewers, or into streams or bodies of  
water. Recycle it by taking it to a  
place that collects used oil.  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN,  
with the engine off.  
2. Press the DIC menu button until  
Remaining Oil Lifedisplays.  
3. Press and hold the set/clear  
If the system is ever reset  
button until 100%is displayed.  
accidentally, the oil must be  
changed at 5 000 km (3,000 miles)  
since the last oil change.  
Remember to reset the oil life  
system whenever the oil is changed.  
4. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
The system is reset when the  
Change Engine Oil Soonmessage  
goes off.  
How to Check Automatic  
Transmission Fluid  
How to Reset the Engine Oil  
Life System  
What to Do with Used Oil  
It is not necessary to check the  
transmission fluid level.  
Used engine oil contains elements  
that can be unhealthy for your skin  
and could even cause cancer. Do  
not let used oil stay on your skin.  
Clean your skin and nails with soap  
and water, or a good hand cleaner.  
Wash or properly dispose of clothing  
or rags. See the manufacturer's  
warnings about the use and  
Reset the system whenever the  
engine oil is changed so that the  
system can calculate the next  
engine oil change. To reset the  
system:  
A transmission fluid leak is the only  
reason for fluid loss. If a leak  
occurs, take the vehicle to your  
dealer service department and have  
it repaired as soon as possible.  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN with  
the engine off.  
2. Fully press and release the  
accelerator pedal three times  
within five seconds.  
disposal of oil products.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-13  
There is a special procedure for  
checking and changing the  
transmission fluid. Because this  
procedure is difficult, this should be  
done at your dealer service  
To inspect or replace the engine air  
cleaner/filter:  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
See Engine Compartment Overview  
on page 96 for the location of the  
engine air cleaner/filter.  
1. Open the hood. See Hood on  
page 95  
.
2. Locate the air filter housing on  
the front passenger side of the  
engine compartment. See  
department. Contact your dealer for  
additional information or the  
procedure can be found in the  
service manual. To purchase a  
service manual, see Service  
Publications Ordering Information on  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
Engine Compartment Overview  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the  
Maintenance II intervals and replace  
it at the first oil change after each  
80 000 km (50,000 mile) interval.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on  
page 102 for more information.  
If driving in dusty/dirty conditions,  
inspect the filter at each engine oil  
change.  
on page 96  
.
page 1212  
.
Change the fluid and filter at the  
intervals listed in Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 102, and be  
sure to use the fluid listed in  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 107.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter,  
remove the filter from the vehicle  
and lightly shake the filter to release  
loose dust and dirt. If the filter  
remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required.  
3. Remove the four air cleaner  
housing cover screws.  
4. Pull straight up on cover, and  
while holding the cover, remove  
the air filter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-14  
Vehicle Care  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is  
off, dirt can easily get into the  
engine, which could damage it.  
Always have the air cleaner/filter  
in place when you are driving.  
How to Reinstall Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
1. Install the air cleaner into the air  
cleaner housing. The outer air  
cleaner filter seal must be fitted  
properly in the air cleaner  
housing.  
Cooling System  
2. Align the air cleaner housing  
cover tabs to the air cleaner  
housing.  
3. Install the air cleaner housing  
cover using the four screws.  
3.0 L V6 Engine  
A. Engine Cooling Fans  
WARNING  
{
B. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and  
Pressure Cap  
Operating the engine with the air  
cleaner/filter off can cause you or  
others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it  
helps to stop flames if the engine  
backfires. Use caution when  
WARNING  
{
2.4 L L4 Engine  
An electric engine cooling fan  
under the hood can start up even  
when the engine is not running  
and can cause injury. Keep  
hands, clothing, and tools away  
from any underhood electric fan.  
A. Engine Cooling Fan  
B. Engine Coolant Surge Tank and  
Pressure Cap  
working on the engine and do not  
drive with the air cleaner/filter off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Engine Coolant  
The cooling system in the vehicle is  
filled with DEX-COOL® engine  
coolant. This coolant is designed to  
remain in the vehicle for five years  
or 240 000 km (150,000 miles),  
whichever occurs first.  
9-15  
If the coolant inside the coolant  
surge tank is boiling, do not do  
anything else until it cools down.  
Park the vehicle on a level surface.  
If there seems to be no leak, with  
the engine on, check to see if the  
electric engine cooling fan is  
running. If the engine is  
overheating, the fan should be  
running. If it is not, your vehicle  
needs service. Turn off the engine.  
The coolant level should be at the  
COLD FILL line. If it is not, there  
might be a leak at the radiator  
hoses, heater hoses, radiator, water  
pump, or somewhere else in the  
cooling system.  
Notice: Using coolant other than  
DEX-COOL® can cause premature  
engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine  
coolant could require changing  
sooner, at 50 000 km  
(30,000 miles) or 24 months,  
whichever occurs first. Any  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Always use  
DEX-COOL® (silicate-free) coolant  
in the vehicle.  
The following explains the cooling  
system and how to check and add  
coolant when it is low. If there is a  
problem with engine overheating,  
see Engine Overheating on  
WARNING  
{
page 918  
.
Heater and radiator hoses, and  
other engine parts, can be very  
hot. Do not touch them. If you do,  
you can be burned.  
Do not run the engine if there is a  
leak. If you run the engine, it  
could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you  
could be burned. Get any leak  
fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-16  
Vehicle Care  
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean,  
drinkable water and DEX-COOL®  
coolant. If using this mixture,  
nothing else needs to be added.  
This mixture:  
What to Use  
Checking Coolant  
The vehicle must be on a level  
surface when checking the coolant  
level.  
WARNING  
{
Adding only plain water to the  
cooling system can be  
Check to see if coolant is visible in  
the coolant surge tank. If the coolant  
inside the coolant surge tank is  
boiling, do not do anything else until  
it cools down. If coolant is visible  
but the coolant level is not at or  
above the COLD mark, add a  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
water and DEX-COOL® coolant at  
the coolant surge tank, but be sure  
the cooling system is cool before  
this is done. See Engine  
.
Gives freezing protection down  
dangerous. Plain water, or some  
other liquid such as alcohol, can  
boil before the proper coolant  
mixture will. The vehicle's coolant  
warning system is set for the  
proper coolant mixture. With plain  
water or the wrong mixture, the  
engine could get too hot but you  
would not get the overheat  
to 37°C (34°F), outside  
temperature.  
.
Gives boiling protection up to  
129°C (265°F), engine  
temperature.  
.
Protects against rust and  
corrosion.  
.
Will not damage aluminum parts.  
warning. The engine could catch  
fire and you or others could be  
burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and  
.
Helps keep the proper engine  
Overheating on page 918 for more  
information.  
temperature.  
Notice: If an improper coolant  
mixture is used, the engine could  
overheat and be badly damaged.  
The repair cost would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Too much water in the mixture  
can freeze and crack the engine,  
radiator, heater core, and other  
parts.  
The coolant surge tank is located in  
the engine compartment on the  
driver side of the vehicle. See  
Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 96 for more information on  
location.  
DEX-COOL® coolant.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-17  
If coolant is needed, add the proper  
DEX-COOL® coolant mixture at the  
coolant surge tank.  
How to Add Coolant to the  
Coolant Surge Tank  
WARNING  
{
An electric engine cooling fan  
under the hood can start up even  
when the engine is not running  
and can cause injury. Keep  
hands, clothing, and tools away  
from any underhood electric fan.  
WARNING  
{
You can be burned if you spill  
coolant on hot engine parts.  
Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts  
are hot enough. Do not spill  
coolant on a hot engine.  
The coolant surge tank pressure  
cap can be removed when the  
cooling system, including the surge  
tank pressure cap and upper  
radiator hose, is no longer hot.  
WARNING  
{
Notice: This vehicle has a  
specific coolant fill procedure.  
Failure to follow this procedure  
could cause the engine to  
overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
Steam and scalding liquids from a  
hot cooling system can blow out  
and burn you badly. They are  
under pressure, and if you turn  
the surge tank pressure  
cap even a little they can  
come out at high speed. Never  
turn the cap when the cooling  
system, including the surge tank  
pressure cap, is hot. Wait for the  
cooling system and surge tank  
pressure cap to cool if you ever  
have to turn the pressure cap.  
1. Turn the pressure cap slowly  
counterclockwise. If a hiss is  
heard, wait for that to stop.  
A hiss means there is still some  
pressure left.  
2. Keep turning the cap and  
remove it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-18  
Vehicle Care  
time, the coolant level inside the  
coolant surge tank may be  
lower. If the level is lower, add  
more of the proper mixture to the  
coolant surge tank until the level  
reaches the line pointed to on  
the front of the coolant  
Engine Overheating  
The vehicle has an indicator to warn  
of engine overheating. There is an  
engine coolant temperature warning  
light on the vehicle's instrument  
panel. See Engine Coolant  
Temperature Gauge on page 414.  
surge tank.  
Decide whether to lift the hood  
when this warning appears, or get  
service help instead.  
5. Replace the pressure cap.  
Be sure the pressure cap is  
handtight and full seated.  
If lifting the hood , make sure the  
vehicle is parked on a level surface.  
Notice: If the pressure cap is not  
tightly installed, coolant loss and  
possible engine damage may  
occur. Be sure the cap is properly  
and tightly secured.  
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with  
the proper mixture to the COLD  
FILL line.  
Then check to see if the engine  
cooling fans are running. If the  
engine is overheating, both fans  
should be running. If they are not,  
do not continue to run the engine  
and have the vehicle serviced.  
4. With the coolant surge tank  
pressure cap off, start the  
engine and let it run until the  
upper radiator hose starts  
getting hot. Watch out for the  
engine cooling fan(s). By this  
If coolant is needed, add the proper  
DEX-COOL® coolant mixture at the  
coolant surge tank.  
Notice: Engine damage from  
running the engine without  
coolant is not covered by the  
warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-19  
3. In heavy traffic, let the engine  
idle in N (Neutral) while stopped.  
If it is safe to do so, pull off the  
road, shift to P (Park) or  
N (Neutral) and let the  
If Steam Is Coming From The  
Engine Compartment  
If No Steam Is Coming From  
The Engine Compartment  
If an engine overheat warning is  
displayed but no steam can be seen  
or heard, the problem may not be  
too serious. Sometimes the engine  
can get a little too hot when the  
vehicle:  
WARNING  
{
engine idle.  
Steam from an overheated engine  
can burn you badly, even if you  
just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear  
steam coming from it. Just turn it  
off and get everyone away from  
the vehicle until it cools down.  
Wait until there is no sign of  
steam or coolant before you open  
the hood.  
If the temperature overheat gauge is  
no longer in the overheat zone or an  
overheat warning no longer  
displays, the vehicle can be driven.  
Continue to drive the vehicle slow  
for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe  
vehicle distance from the vehicle in  
front. If the warning does not come  
back on, continue to drive normally.  
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.  
.
Stops after high-speed driving.  
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.  
.
Tows a trailer.  
If the overheat warning is displayed  
with no sign of steam:  
If the warning continues, pull over,  
stop, and park the vehicle  
right away.  
If you keep driving when your  
engine is overheated, the liquids  
in it can catch fire. You or others  
could be badly burned. Stop your  
engine if it overheats, and get out  
of the vehicle until the engine  
is cool.  
1. Turn the air conditioning off.  
2. Turn the heater on to the highest  
temperature and to the highest  
fan speed. Open the windows as  
necessary.  
If there is no sign of steam, idle the  
engine for three minutes while  
parked. If the warning is still  
displayed, turn off the engine until it  
cools down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-20  
Vehicle Care  
4. Unscrew the cap and wipe the  
dipstick with a clean rag.  
When to Check Power Steering  
Fluid  
Power Steering Fluid  
(2.4L L4 Engine)  
The vehicle has electric power  
steering and does not use power  
steering fluid.  
5. Replace the cap and completely  
tighten it.  
The power steering fluid does not  
need to be checked unless there is  
a leak in the system. Have the  
system inspected and repaired if  
there is a fluid loss.  
6. Remove the cap again and look  
at the fluid level on the dipstick.  
Power Steering Fluid  
(3.0L V6 Engine)  
The fluid level should be between  
MAX and MIN line at room  
temperature. If the fluid is on or  
How to Check Power Steering  
Fluid  
below MIN line, add fluid.  
To check:  
What to Use  
1. Turn the engine off and let it  
cool down.  
For the proper fluid, see  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 107.  
2. Remove the engine cover. Refer  
to Engine Cover on page 99.  
The power steering fluid reservoir is  
to the rear of the engine  
compartment on the passenger side  
of the vehicle. See Engine  
3. Wipe the cap and the top of the  
reservoir clean.  
Compartment Overview on  
page 96  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Brakes  
This vehicle has disc brakes. Disc  
brake pads have built-in wear  
indicators that make a high-pitched  
warning sound when the brake pads  
are worn and new pads are needed.  
The sound can come and go or be  
heard all the time the vehicle is  
moving, except when applying the  
brake pedal firmly.  
9-21  
Notice:  
Washer Fluid  
.
When using concentrated  
What to Use  
washer fluid, follow the  
manufacturer's instructions  
for adding water.  
Read the manufacturer's  
instructions before refilling the  
windshield washer fluid. If operating  
the vehicle in an area where the  
temperature may fall below freezing,  
use a fluid that has sufficient  
protection against freezing.  
.
Do not mix water with  
ready-to-use washer fluid.  
Water can cause the solution  
to freeze and damage the  
washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system.  
Also, water does not clean as  
well as washer fluid.  
Adding Washer Fluid  
WARNING  
{
The brake wear warning sound  
means that soon the brakes will  
not work well. That could lead to  
an accident. When the brake  
wear warning sound is heard,  
have the vehicle serviced.  
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only  
three-quarters full when it is  
very cold. This allows for  
fluid expansion if freezing  
occurs, which could damage  
the tank if it is  
Open the cap with the washer  
symbol on it and add washer fluid  
until full. See Engine Compartment  
Overview on page 96 for  
reservoir location.  
completely full.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with  
worn-out brake pads could result  
in costly brake repair.  
.
Do not use engine coolant  
(antifreeze) in the windshield  
washer. It can damage the  
vehicle's windshield washer  
system and paint.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-22  
Vehicle Care  
Some driving conditions or climates  
can cause a brake squeal when the  
brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean  
Brake Adjustment  
Brake Fluid  
Every time the brakes are applied,  
with or without the vehicle moving,  
the brakes adjust for wear.  
something is wrong with the brakes.  
Replacing Brake System Parts  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are  
necessary to help prevent brake  
pulsation. When tires are rotated,  
inspect brake pads for wear and  
evenly tighten wheel nuts in the  
proper sequence to torque  
The braking system on a vehicle is  
complex. Its many parts have to be  
of top quality and work well together  
if the vehicle is to have really good  
braking. The vehicle was designed  
and tested with top-quality brake  
parts. When parts of the braking  
system are replaced, be sure to get  
new, approved replacement parts.  
If this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example,  
installing disc brake pads that are  
wrong for the vehicle, can change  
the balance between the front and  
rear brakes for the worse. The  
braking performance expected can  
change in many other ways if the  
wrong replacement brake parts are  
installed.  
The brake master cylinder reservoir  
is filled with DOT 3 brake fluid as  
indicated on the reservoir cap. See  
Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 96 for the location of the  
reservoir.  
specifications in Capacities and  
Specifications on page 112.  
Brake linings should always be  
replaced as complete axle sets.  
There are only two reasons why the  
brake fluid level in the reservoir  
might go down:  
Brake Pedal Travel  
See your dealer if the brake pedal  
does not return to normal height,  
or if there is a rapid increase in  
pedal travel. This could be a sign  
that brake service might be  
required.  
.
The brake fluid level goes down  
because of normal brake lining  
wear. When new linings are  
installed, the fluid level goes  
back up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-23  
.
A fluid leak in the brake  
When the brake fluid falls to a low  
level, the brake warning light comes  
on. See Brake System Warning  
Light on page 419.  
Notice:  
hydraulic system can also cause  
a low fluid level. Have the brake  
hydraulic system fixed, since a  
leak means that sooner or later  
the brakes will not work well.  
.
Using the wrong fluid can  
badly damage brake  
hydraulic system parts. For  
example, just a few drops of  
mineral-based oil, such as  
engine oil, in the brake  
What to Add  
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid  
from a sealed container. See  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 107.  
Do not top off the brake fluid.  
Adding fluid does not correct a leak.  
If fluid is added when the linings are  
worn, there will be too much fluid  
when new brake linings are  
installed. Add or remove brake fluid,  
as necessary, only when work is  
done on the brake hydraulic system.  
hydraulic system can  
damage brake hydraulic  
system parts so badly that  
they will have to be replaced.  
Do not let someone put in  
the wrong kind of fluid.  
Always clean the brake fluid  
reservoir cap and the area around  
the cap before removing it. This  
helps keep dirt from entering the  
reservoir.  
.
If brake fluid is spilled on the  
vehicle's painted surfaces,  
the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to  
spill brake fluid on the  
vehicle. If you do, wash it off  
immediately.  
WARNING  
{
WARNING  
{
If too much brake fluid is added, it  
can spill on the engine and burn,  
if the engine is hot enough. You  
or others could be burned, and  
the vehicle could be damaged.  
Add brake fluid only when work is  
done on the brake hydraulic  
system.  
With the wrong kind of fluid in the  
brake hydraulic system, the  
brakes might not work well. This  
could cause a crash. Always use  
the proper brake fluid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-24  
Vehicle Care  
Infrequent Usage: Remove the  
black, negative () cable from the  
battery to keep the battery from  
running down.  
How to Check Lubricant  
Battery  
Refer to the replacement number on  
the original battery label when a  
new battery is needed.  
Extended Storage: Remove the  
black, negative () cable from the  
battery or use a battery trickle  
charger.  
DANGER  
{
Battery posts, terminals, and  
related accessories contain lead  
and lead compounds, chemicals  
known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and reproductive  
harm. Wash hands after handling.  
All-Wheel Drive  
Transfer Case  
When to Check and Change  
Lubricant  
To get an accurate reading, the  
vehicle should be on a level  
surface.  
Vehicle Storage  
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule  
to determine how often to check the  
lubricant and when to change it.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on  
WARNING  
{
If the level is below the bottom of  
the filler plug hole, located on the  
transfer case, you will need to add  
some lubricant. Add enough  
lubricant to raise the level to the  
bottom of the filler plug hole. A fluid  
loss could indicate a problem; check  
and have it repaired, if needed.  
Batteries have acid that can burn  
you and gas that can explode.  
You can be badly hurt if you are  
not careful. See Jump Starting on  
page 969 for tips on working  
around a battery without  
page 102  
.
getting hurt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-25  
What to Use  
3. Try to start the engine in each  
gear. The vehicle should start  
only in P (Park) or N (Neutral).  
If the vehicle starts in any other  
position, contact your dealer for  
service.  
Be ready to apply the regular  
brake immediately if the vehicle  
begins to move.  
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule  
to determine what kind of lubricant  
to use. See Recommended Fluids  
and Lubricants on page 107.  
3. With the engine off, turn the  
ignition to ON/RUN, but do not  
start the engine. Without  
applying the regular brake, try to  
move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the  
shift lever moves out of P (Park),  
contact your dealer for service.  
Starter Switch Check  
Automatic Transmission  
Shift Lock Control  
System Check  
WARNING  
{
When you are doing this  
inspection, the vehicle could  
move suddenly. If the vehicle  
moves, you or others could be  
injured.  
WARNING  
{
Ignition Transmission  
Lock Check  
While parked, and with the parking  
brake set, try to turn the ignition to  
LOCK/OFF in each shift lever  
position.  
When you are doing this  
inspection, the vehicle could  
move suddenly. If the vehicle  
moves, you or others could be  
injured.  
1. Before starting this check, be  
sure there is enough room  
around the vehicle.  
.
The ignition should turn to  
LOCK/OFF only when the shift  
lever is in P (Park).  
1. Before starting this check, be  
sure there is enough room  
2. Firmly apply both the parking  
brake and the regular brake.  
See Parking Brake on  
around the vehicle. It should be  
parked on a level surface.  
.
The ignition key should come  
page 840  
.
out only in LOCK/OFF.  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.  
Do not use the accelerator  
pedal, and be ready to turn off  
the engine immediately if it  
starts.  
See Parking Brake on  
Contact your dealer if service is  
required.  
page 840  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-26  
Vehicle Care  
.
To check the P (Park)  
Front Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Park Brake and P (Park)  
Mechanism Check  
mechanism's holding ability:  
With the engine running, shift to  
P (Park). Then release the  
parking brake followed by the  
regular brake.  
To replace the front wiper blades:  
WARNING  
{
1. Lift the wiper arm from the  
windshield until no further  
movement is possible.  
When you are doing this check,  
the vehicle could begin to move.  
You or others could be injured  
and property could be damaged.  
Make sure there is room in front  
of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular  
brake at once should the vehicle  
begin to move.  
Contact your dealer if service is  
required.  
Wiper Blade Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be  
inspected for wear and cracking.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on  
page 102 for more information.  
2. Press the square button on the  
top side, at the end of the wiper  
arm, and pull the wiper blade out  
of the end of the wiper arm.  
Replacement blades come in  
different types and are removed in  
different ways. For proper type and  
length, see Maintenance  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the  
vehicle facing downhill. Keeping  
your foot on the regular brake, set  
the parking brake.  
3. Install the wiper blade connector  
by sliding into the end of the  
wiper arm until the square button  
on the wiper blade clicks into  
place with the wiper arm.  
Replacement Parts on page 109.  
.
To check the parking brake's  
Notice: Allowing the wiper blade  
arm to touch the windshield when  
no wiper blade is installed could  
damage the windshield. Any  
damage that occurs would not be  
covered by your warranty. Do not  
allow the wiper blade arm to  
touch the windshield.  
holding ability: With the engine  
running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot  
pressure from the regular brake  
pedal. Do this until the vehicle is  
held by the parking brake only.  
4. Place the wiper arm with the  
wiper blade in place back on the  
windshield.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-27  
4. Place the wiper blade into the  
wiper arm aligning the blade  
attachment rivet with the arm  
attachment.  
Rear Wiper Blade Replacement  
Headlamp Aiming  
The headlamp aiming system has  
been preset at the factory.  
To replace the rear wiper blade:  
1. Lift the wiper arm from the  
liftgate glass until no further  
movement is possible.  
If the vehicle is damaged in an  
accident, the aim of the headlamps  
may be affected and adjustment  
may be necessary.  
5. Align the wiper blade with the  
arm and hold both ends of the  
arm while gently squeezing until  
the blade snaps into place.  
2. Hold the wiper arm at the tip with  
one hand and hold the wiper  
blade at the tip with the  
other hand.  
It is recommended that a dealer  
adjust the headlamps. To re-aim the  
headlamps yourself, use the  
following procedure.  
Do not apply excessive force  
during this operation.  
3. Pull down on the wiper blade.  
The blade will pull away from  
the arm.  
Reposition the blade in the arm  
and repeat, if blade is not  
correctly positioned.  
The vehicle should be properly  
prepared as follows. The vehicle:  
6. Place the wiper arm with the  
wiper blade attached back on  
the liftgate glass.  
.
Should be placed so the  
headlamps are 7.6 m (25 ft) from  
a light colored wall.  
.
Must have all four tires on a  
level surface which is level all  
the way to the wall.  
.
Should be placed so it is  
perpendicular to the wall or other  
flat surface.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-28  
Vehicle Care  
.
Should not have any snow, ice,  
or mud on it.  
To adjust the vertical aim, do the  
following:  
.
.
.
Should be fully assembled and  
all other work stopped while  
headlamp aiming is being  
performed.  
1. Open the hood. See Hood on  
page 95 for more information.  
Should be normally loaded with  
a full tank of fuel and one person  
or 75 kg (160 lbs) sitting on the  
driver's seat.  
Tires should be properly inflated.  
4. At the wall measure from the  
ground upward (A) to the  
recorded distance from  
Step 3 and mark it.  
Headlamp aiming is done with the  
vehicle's low-beam headlamps. The  
high-beam headlamps will be  
correctly aimed if the low-beam  
headlamps are aimed properly.  
5. Draw or tape a horizontal line (B)  
on the wall the width of the  
vehicle at the height of the mark  
in Step 4.  
2. Locate the aim dot on the lens of  
the lowbeam headlamp.  
3. Measure the distance from the  
ground to the aim dot on the  
lowbeam headlamp. Record the  
distance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-29  
Notice: Do not cover a headlamp  
to improve beam cut-off when  
aiming. Covering a headlamp may  
cause excessive heat build-up  
which may cause damage to the  
headlamp.  
6. Turn on the low-beam  
headlamps and place a piece of  
cardboard or equivalent in front  
of the headlamp not being  
adjusted. This allows only the  
beam of light from the headlamp  
being adjusted to be seen on the  
flat surface.  
7. Locate the vertical headlamp  
aiming screws, which are under  
the hood near each headlamp  
assembly.  
9. Make sure that the light from the  
headlamp is positioned at the  
bottom edge of the horizontal  
tape line. The lamp on the  
left (A) shows the correct  
The adjustment screw can be  
turned with a E8 Torx® socket.  
headlamp aim. The lamp on the  
right (B) shows the incorrect  
headlamp aim.  
8. Turn the vertical aiming screw  
until the headlamp beam is  
aimed to the horizontal tape line.  
Turn it clockwise or  
10. Repeat Steps 7 through 9 for  
the opposite headlamp.  
counterclockwise to raise or  
lower the angle of the beam.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-30  
Vehicle Care  
To replace:  
Headlamps, Front Turn  
Signal, Sidemarker, and  
Parking Lamps  
Bulb Replacement  
For the proper type of replacement  
1. Turn the tire to reach the access  
port cap located on front of  
wheel well cover.  
bulbs, see Replacement Bulbs on  
page 934  
.
For any bulb changing procedure  
not listed in this section, contact  
your dealer.  
A. Low Beam Headlamp  
B. High Beam headlamp  
C. Park/Turn Signal Lamp  
D. Side Marker Lamp  
A. Screw  
B. Access Port Cap  
2. Remove screw (A) and turn  
access port cap (B)  
counterclockwise to remove.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-31  
3. If replacing low/high headlamp  
bulb, remove the dust cover cap  
from the back of the headlamp  
housing by turning the cap  
counterclockwise.  
3. Remove the old bulb from the  
bulb socket and push the new  
bulb straight into the bulb socket  
until it connects.  
Fog Lamps  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
4. Push the bulb socket into the fog  
lamp assembly and turn  
4. Turn the bulb socket  
counterclockwise to remove from  
lamp assembly.  
clockwise to lock it into place.  
5. Reconnect the bulb socket to the  
electrical connector.  
5. Remove the bulb from the  
socket or disconnect bulb  
assembly from harness  
connector.  
6. Install new bulb.  
7. Reinstall the lamp socket to  
lamp assembly turning  
clockwise.  
1. Locate the fog lamp assembly  
under the front facia.  
8. Replace the dust cover cap on  
headlamps.  
2. Disconnect the bulb socket from  
the electrical connector, turn and  
pull out the bulb assembly.  
9. Reinstall the wheel well cover  
access port cap and secure by  
installing screw.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-32  
Vehicle Care  
To replace one of these lamps:  
5. Disconnect the lamp wiring  
harness.  
Taillamps, Turn Signal,  
Sidemarker, Stoplamps,  
and Back-Up Lamps  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate  
(Manual) on page 18 or  
Liftgate (Power) on page 18.  
6. Turn the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and pull it out.  
A. Sidemarker  
A. Screw  
7. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
B. Stoplamp/Turn Signal Lamp/  
Taillamp  
B. Screw Cover  
8. Install the new bulb.  
2. Remove the two screw  
covers (B) from the taillamp  
assembly.  
C. Back-up Lamp  
9. Push the bulb socket in and turn  
it clockwise.  
3. Remove the two screws (A)  
securing the taillamp assembly.  
10. Reverse steps 2 through 5 to  
reinstall lamp assembly.  
4. Pull taillamp assembly out of  
vehicle body.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-33  
3. Pull the lamp assembly down to  
remove from liftgate.  
5. Pull the bulb (B) straight out of  
the bulb socket.  
License Plate Lamp  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
6. Push the replacement bulb  
straight into the bulb socket and  
turn the bulb socket clockwise to  
install into lamp assembly.  
1. Open the liftgate partway. See  
Liftgate (Manual) on page 18  
or Liftgate (Power) on  
page 18 for more information.  
7. Turn the lamp assembly into the  
liftgate engaging the clip side  
first.  
8. Push on the lamp side opposite  
the clip until the lamp assembly  
snaps into place.  
A. Bulb Socket  
B. Bulb  
C. Lamp Assembly  
4. Turn the bulb socket (A)  
counterclockwise to remove from  
lamp assembly (C).  
Passenger side shown, driver side  
similar  
2. Push the left end of the lamp  
assembly towards the right.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-34  
Vehicle Care  
Replacement Bulbs  
Engine Compartment  
Fuse Block  
Electrical System  
Bulb  
Exterior Lamp  
Number  
Fuses  
Back-Up Lamp  
Fog Lamp Front  
921  
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are  
protected from short circuits by  
fuses. This greatly reduces the  
chance of damage caused by  
electrical problems.  
H11  
Headlamp  
High Beam  
HB3  
Headlamp  
Low Beam  
Look at the silver-colored band  
H11  
W5WLL  
T20  
inside the fuse. If the band is broken  
or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure  
to replace a bad fuse with a new  
one of the identical size and rating.  
License Plate Lamp  
Parking Lamp/Turn  
Signal Front  
There are two fuse blocks in the  
vehicle: one in the engine  
compartment and one in the  
instrument panel.  
To remove the fuse block cover,  
squeeze the clips on the cover and  
lift it straight up.  
Sidemarker Front  
and Rear  
194  
Taillamp/Turn Signal  
Lamp/Stop Lamp  
3157K  
The vehicle may not be equipped  
with all of the fuses and relays  
shown.  
There is a fuse puller located in the  
engine compartment fuse block.  
See Engine Compartment Fuse  
Block on page 934. It can be used  
to easily remove fuses from the fuse  
block.  
For replacement bulbs not listed  
here, contact your dealer.  
Notice: Spilling liquid on any  
electrical components on the  
vehicle may damage it. Always  
keep the covers on any electrical  
component.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-35  
J-Case  
Usage  
Fuses  
6
Power Seat Left  
Instrument Panel  
Fuse Block 1  
7
8
Instrument Panel  
Fuse Block 2  
9
Starter  
10  
11  
Brake Booster  
Sunroof  
Antilock Brake  
System Pump  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Instrument Panel  
Fuse Block 3  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block  
Power Windows  
Left  
J-Case  
Fuses  
Usage  
J-Case  
Fuses  
Usage  
Antilock Brake  
System Module  
1
2
3
Cool Fan 1  
Power Windows –  
Right  
4
5
Cool Fan 2  
Rear Defog  
Memory Seat  
Module  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-36  
Vehicle Care  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Transmission  
Control Module  
Battery  
28  
29  
Wiper  
PreCatalytic  
Converter Oxygen  
Sensor  
16  
41  
Rear Wiper  
Air Conditioning  
Compressor  
30  
17  
18  
Trailer Parking Light  
Transmission  
Control Module  
42  
43  
44  
Engine Control  
Module Battery  
31  
32  
Rear Latch  
Horn  
Mirror  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
Heated Mirror  
Trailer Left  
Chassis Control  
Module Ignition  
Right HighBeam  
Headlamp  
33  
34  
45  
46  
Spare  
Lift Gate Module  
Power Lumbar  
Trailer Right  
Left HighBeam  
Headlamp  
Rear Drive Module  
Lift Gate Module  
Logic  
35  
36  
37  
38  
Ignition Even Coil  
Ignition Odd Coil  
Windshield Washer  
Front Fog Lamps  
47  
Canister Vent  
Instrument Panel  
Fuse Block Ignition  
48  
49  
50  
Memory Mirror  
Module  
25  
26  
27  
Heated Seat Front  
Regulated Voltage  
Control Battery  
Sensor  
Post Catalytic  
Converter Oxygen  
Sensor  
Chassis Control  
Module  
39  
40  
Engine Control  
Module  
Rear Accessory  
Power Outlet  
51  
52  
Engine Control  
Module  
Rear Vision Camera  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-37  
To reinstall the door, insert the tabs  
on the bottom of the door into the  
console first, then push the door  
back into its original location.  
Midi Fuse  
Usage  
Mini Relays  
Usage  
Cooling Fan High  
Brake Booster  
Electric Power  
Steering  
65  
66  
53  
The vehicle may not be equipped  
with all of the fuses and relays  
shown.  
Micro  
Relays  
Usage  
Instrument Panel Fuse  
Block  
54  
55  
Rear Defogger  
Cooling Fan Low  
Head Lamp  
High Beam  
56  
57  
58  
Cooling Fan Control  
Wiper On/Off  
Control  
Air Conditioning  
Compressor  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
Wiper Speed  
Fog Lamp  
Engine Control  
Starter  
The instrument panel fuse block  
is located on the passenger  
side panel of the center console.  
To access the fuses, open the fuse  
panel door from the passenger side  
by pulling it out.  
Run/Crank  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-38  
Vehicle Care  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Body Control  
Module 7  
6
Noise Control  
Module  
7
8
Body Control  
Module 4  
9
Radio  
10  
SEO Battery  
Ultrasonic Rear  
Parking Aid Module  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Heater, Ventilation  
and Air Conditioning  
Battery  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block  
Auxiliary Power  
Front  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Heater, Ventilation  
and Air Conditioning  
Ignition  
1
2
3
Steering Wheel DM  
Spare  
Body Control  
Module 1  
4
5
Infotainment  
Spare  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-39  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
Display  
Mini Fuses  
Usage  
JCase  
Fuses  
Usage  
15  
Body Control  
Module 3  
30  
31  
32  
29  
Front Blower Motor  
Body Control  
Module 5  
16  
17  
Amplifier  
Body Control  
Module 8  
40  
Auxiliary  
Power Rear  
Discrete Logic  
Ignition Switch  
Relays  
Usage  
Instrument Panel  
Cluster Ignition  
Communications  
Integration Module  
18  
19  
20  
33  
41  
LOG Relay  
Retained Accessory  
Power Relay  
PDI Module  
Body Control  
Module 2  
42  
34  
35  
36  
Body Control  
Module 6  
SDM Battery  
SEO Retained  
Accessory Power  
Data Link  
Connection  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
SDM Ignition  
Spare  
Instrument Panel  
Cluster Battery  
37  
IOS Module  
(Passenger Sensing  
System)  
Spare  
38  
39  
PRNDL  
Spare  
Spare  
Spare  
Spare  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-40  
Vehicle Care  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Wheels and Tires  
WARNING (Continued)  
Useful information about a tire is  
molded into its sidewall. The  
examples below show a typical  
passenger vehicle tire and a  
compact spare tire sidewall.  
.
Underinflated tires pose the  
same danger as overloaded  
tires. The resulting accident  
could cause serious injury.  
Check all tires frequently to  
maintain the recommended  
pressure. Tire pressure  
should be checked when your  
tires are cold. See Tire  
Pressure on page 946.  
Tires  
Your new vehicle comes with  
high-quality tires made by a  
leading tire manufacturer. If you  
ever have questions about your  
tire warranty and where to  
obtain service, see your vehicle  
Warranty booklet for details. For  
additional information refer to  
the tire manufacturer.  
.
Overinflated tires are more  
likely to be cut, punctured  
or broken by a sudden  
impact such as when you  
hit a pothole. Keep tires at  
the recommended pressure.  
WARNING  
{
Poorly maintained and improperly  
used tires are dangerous.  
.
.
Worn, old tires can cause  
accidents. If your tread is  
badly worn, or if your tires  
have been damaged,  
replace them.  
Overloading your tires can  
cause overheating as a result  
of too much flexing. You  
could have an air-out and a  
serious accident. See Vehicle  
Load Limits on page 824.  
Passenger (PMetric) Tire Example  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a  
combination of letters and  
numbers used to define a  
particular tire's width, height,  
aspect ratio, construction type,  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-41  
and service description. See the  
Tire Identification Number (TIN).  
Tire Sizeillustration later in this The TIN shows the  
section for more detail.  
manufacturer and plant code,  
tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is  
molded onto both sides of the  
tire, although only one side may  
have the date of manufacture.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire  
Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original  
equipment tires designed to  
GM's specific tire performance  
criteria have a TPC specification  
code molded onto the sidewall.  
(E) Tire Ply Material: The type  
of cord and number of plies in  
GM's TPC specifications meet or the sidewall and under the tread.  
Compact Spare Tire Example  
exceed all federal safety  
guidelines.  
(F) Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading (UTQG): Tire  
(A) Tire Ply Material: The type  
of cord and number of plies in  
the sidewall and under the tread.  
(C) DOT (Department of  
Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation  
(DOT) code indicates that the  
tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of  
manufacturers are required to  
grade tires based on three  
performance factors: treadwear,  
traction, and temperature  
resistance. For more information  
see Uniform Tire Quality  
(B) Temporary Use Only: The  
compact spare tire or temporary  
use tire has a tread life of  
approximately 5 000 km  
Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
Grading on page 956  
.
(3,000 miles) and should not be  
driven at speeds over 105 km/h  
(65 mph). The compact spare  
tire is for emergency use when a  
regular road tire has lost air and  
gone flat. If your vehicle has a  
(G) Maximum Cold Inflation  
Load Limit: Maximum load that  
can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to  
support that load.  
(D) Tire Identification Number  
(TIN): The letters and numbers  
following the DOT (Department  
of Transportation) code is the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-42  
Vehicle Care  
compact spare tire, see  
Compact Spare Tire on  
page 968 and If a Tire Goes Flat spare tire should be inflated to  
(E) Tire Inflation: The  
temporary use tire or compact  
Tire Designations  
Tire Size  
on page 959  
.
420 kPa (60 psi). For more  
information on tire pressure and  
inflation see Tire Pressure on  
The following illustration shows  
an example of a typical  
passenger vehicle tire size.  
(C) Tire Identification Number  
(TIN): The letters and numbers  
following the DOT (Department  
of Transportation) code is the  
Tire Identification Number (TIN).  
The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code,  
tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is  
page 946  
.
(F) Tire Size : A combination of  
letters and numbers define a  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio,  
construction type, and service  
description. The letter T as the  
first character in the tire size  
means the tire is for temporary  
use only.  
(A) Passenger (PMetric) Tire:  
The United States version of a  
metric tire sizing system. The  
letter P as the first character in  
the tire size means a passenger  
vehicle tire engineered to  
molded onto both sides of the  
tire, although only one side may  
have the date of manufacture.  
(G) TPC Spec (Tire  
Performance Criteria  
(D) Maximum Cold Inflation  
Load Limit: Maximum load that  
can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to  
support that load.  
Specification): Original  
equipment tires designed to  
GM's specific tire performance  
criteria have a TPC specification  
code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or  
exceed all federal safety  
guidelines.  
standards set by the U.S. Tire  
and Rim Association.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit  
number indicates the tire section  
width in millimeters from  
sidewall to sidewall.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-43  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit  
number that indicates the tire  
heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size  
aspect ratio is 60, as shown in  
item C of the illustration, it would  
mean that the tire's sidewall is  
60 percent as high as it is wide.  
certified to carry. The speed  
rating is the maximum speed a  
tire is certified to carry a load.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of  
cords that is located between  
the plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other  
reinforcing materials.  
Tire Terminology and  
Definitions  
Air Pressure: The amount of  
air inside the tire pressing  
outward on each square inch of  
the tire. Air pressure is  
Bead: The tire bead contains  
steel wires wrapped by steel  
cords that hold the tire onto  
the rim.  
(D) Construction Code: A  
letter code is used to indicate  
the type of ply construction in  
the tire. The letter R means  
radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias  
ply construction; and the letter B  
means beltedbias ply  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire  
in which the plies are laid at  
alternate angles less than  
90 degrees to the centerline of  
the tread.  
expressed in psi (pounds per  
square inch) or kPa (kilopascal).  
Accessory Weight: This  
means the combined weight of  
optional accessories. Some  
examples of optional  
accessories are, automatic  
transmission, power steering,  
power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air  
Cold Tire Pressure: The  
amount of air pressure in a tire,  
measured in psi (pounds per  
square inch) or kPa (kilopascal)  
before a tire has built up heat  
from driving. See Tire Pressure  
construction.  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of  
the wheel in inches.  
(F) Service Description: These  
characters represent the load  
index and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents  
the load carry capacity a tire is  
conditioning.  
on page 946  
.
Aspect Ratio: The relationship  
of a tire's height to its width.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-44  
Vehicle Care  
Curb Weight: The weight of a  
motor vehicle with standard and  
optional equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil,  
and coolant, but without  
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight  
Rating for the front axle. See  
Vehicle Load Limits on  
Maximum Inflation Pressure:  
The maximum air pressure to  
which a cold tire can be inflated.  
The maximum air pressure is  
molded onto the sidewall.  
page 824  
.
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight  
Rating for the rear axle. See  
Vehicle Load Limits on  
passengers and cargo.  
Maximum Load Rating: The  
load rating for a tire at the  
maximum permissible inflation  
pressure for that tire.  
DOT Markings: A code molded  
into the sidewall of a tire  
page 824  
.
signifying that the tire is in  
compliance with the U.S.  
Department of Transportation  
(DOT) motor vehicle safety  
standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification  
Number (TIN), an alphanumeric  
designator which can also  
identify the tire manufacturer,  
production plant, brand, and  
date of production.  
Intended Outboard Sidewall:  
The side of an asymmetrical tire,  
that must always face outward  
when mounted on a vehicle.  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle  
Weight: The sum of curb  
weight, accessory weight,  
vehicle capacity weight, and  
production options weight.  
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric  
unit for air pressure.  
Normal Occupant Weight: The  
number of occupants a vehicle  
is designed to seat multiplied by  
68 kg (150 lbs). See Vehicle  
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: A  
tire used on light duty trucks and  
some multipurpose passenger  
vehicles.  
Load Limits on page 824  
.
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight  
Rating. See Vehicle Load Limits  
Load Index: An assigned  
number ranging from 1 to 279  
that corresponds to the load  
carrying capacity of a tire.  
Occupant Distribution:  
Designated seating positions.  
on page 824  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-45  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The  
side of an asymmetrical tire that  
has a particular side that faces  
outward when mounted on a  
vehicle. The side of the tire that  
contains a whitewall, bears  
white lettering, or bears  
manufacturer, brand, and/or  
model name molding that is  
higher or deeper than the same  
moldings on the other sidewall  
of the tire.  
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic  
tire in which the ply cords that  
extend to the beads are laid at  
90 degrees to the centerline of  
the tread.  
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow  
bands, sometimes called wear  
bars, that show across the tread  
of a tire when only 1.6 mm  
(1/16 inch) of tread remains.  
See When It Is Time for New  
Rim: A metal support for a tire  
and upon which the tire beads  
are seated.  
Tires on page 953  
.
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading Standards): A tire  
information system that provides  
consumers with ratings for a  
tire's traction, temperature,  
and treadwear. Ratings are  
determined by tire  
Sidewall: The portion of a tire  
between the tread and the bead.  
Speed Rating: An  
alphanumeric code assigned to  
a tire indicating the maximum  
speed at which a tire can  
operate.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A  
tire used on passenger cars and  
some light duty trucks and  
multipurpose vehicles.  
manufacturers using  
government testing procedures.  
The ratings are molded into the  
sidewall of the tire. See Uniform  
Tire Quality Grading on  
Traction: The friction between  
the tire and the road surface.  
The amount of grip provided.  
Recommended Inflation  
Pressure: Vehicle  
manufacturer's recommended  
tire inflation pressure as shown  
on the tire placard. See Tire  
Pressure on page 946 and  
Vehicle Load Limits on  
page 956  
.
Tread: The portion of a tire that  
comes into contact with  
the road.  
page 824  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-46  
Vehicle Care  
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The  
number of designated seating  
positions multiplied by 68 kg  
(150 lbs) plus the rated cargo  
load. See Vehicle Load Limits on  
If your tires have too much air  
(overinflation), you can get  
the following:  
Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount of  
air pressure to operate  
effectively.  
.
Unusual wear  
.
Poor handling  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell  
you that underinflation or  
overinflation is all right. It is  
not. If your tires do not have  
enough air (underinflation),  
you can get the following:  
page 824  
.
.
Rough ride  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the  
Tire: Load on an individual tire  
due to curb weight, accessory  
weight, occupant weight, and  
cargo weight.  
.
Needless damage from  
road hazards  
A vehicle specific Tire and  
Loading Information label is  
attached to your vehicle. This  
label shows your vehicle's  
original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressures for  
your tires when they are cold.  
The recommended cold tire  
inflation pressure, shown on the  
label, is the minimum amount of  
air pressure needed to support  
your vehicle's maximum load  
carrying capacity.  
.
Too much flexing  
Vehicle Placard: A label  
permanently attached to a  
vehicle showing the vehicle's  
capacity weight and the original  
equipment tire size and  
recommended inflation pressure.  
See Tire and Loading  
.
Too much heat  
.
Tire overloading  
.
Premature or  
irregular wear  
.
Poor handling  
Information Labelunder Vehicle  
.
Reduced fuel economy  
Load Limits on page 824  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-47  
For additional information  
regarding how much weight your  
vehicle can carry, and an  
How to Check  
If you overfill the tire, release air  
by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the tire valve.  
Recheck the tire pressure with  
the tire gauge.  
Use a good quality pocket-type  
gauge to check tire pressure.  
You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by  
example of the Tire and Loading  
Information label, see Vehicle  
Load Limits on page 824 . How  
you load your vehicle affects  
vehicle handling and ride  
comfort. Never load your vehicle  
with more weight than it was  
designed to carry.  
looking at them. Radial tires may Be sure to put the valve caps  
look properly inflated even when  
they are underinflated. Check  
the tire's inflation pressure when  
the tires are cold. Cold means  
your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no  
more than 1.6 km (1 mile).  
back on the valve stems. They  
help prevent leaks by keeping  
out dirt and moisture.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
System  
When to Check  
Check your tires once a month  
or more. Do not forget to check  
the compact spare tire, if the  
vehicle has one. The compact  
spare should be at 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For additional  
information regarding the  
compact spare tire, see  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS) uses radio and sensor  
technology to check tire pressure  
levels. The TPMS sensors monitor  
the air pressure in your vehicle's  
tires and transmit tire pressure  
readings to a receiver located in the  
vehicle.  
Remove the valve cap from the  
tire valve stem. Press the tire  
gauge firmly onto the valve to  
get a pressure measurement.  
If the cold tire inflation pressure  
matches the recommended  
pressure on the Tire and  
Loading Information label, no  
further adjustment is necessary.  
If the inflation pressure is low,  
add air until you reach the  
recommended amount.  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation  
Compact Spare Tire on  
page 968  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-48  
Vehicle Care  
pressure label. (If your vehicle has  
tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or  
tire inflation pressure label, you  
should determine the proper tire  
inflation pressure for those tires.)  
Please note that the TPMS is not a  
substitute for proper tire  
wheels on the vehicle that prevent  
the TPMS from functioning properly.  
Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more  
tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or  
alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function  
properly.  
maintenance, and it is the driver's  
responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if underinflation has  
not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire  
pressure telltale.  
As an added safety feature, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a  
tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire  
pressure telltale when one or  
more of your tires is significantly  
underinflated.  
Your vehicle has also been  
equipped with a TPMS malfunction  
indicator to indicate when the  
See Tire Pressure Monitor  
Operation on page 949 for  
additional information.  
system is not operating properly.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator is  
combined with the low tire pressure  
telltale. When the system detects a  
malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then  
remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon  
subsequent vehicle startups as  
long as the malfunction exists.  
Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and  
Industry Canada  
Accordingly, when the low tire  
pressure telltale illuminates, you  
should stop and check your tires as  
soon as possible, and inflate them  
to the proper pressure. Driving on a  
significantly underinflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can  
lead to tire failure. Underinflation  
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the  
vehicle's handling and stopping  
ability.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on  
page 1216 for information regarding  
Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC)  
Rules and RSS-210/211 of Industry  
Canada.  
When the malfunction indicator is  
illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire  
pressure as intended. TPMS  
malfunctions may occur for a variety  
of reasons, including the installation  
of replacement or alternate tires or  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-49  
inflate the tires to the recommended  
pressure shown on the tire loading  
information label. See Vehicle Load  
Limits on page 824.  
A Tire and Loading Information  
label, attached to your vehicle,  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
Operation  
shows the size of your vehicle's  
original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressure for your  
vehicle's tires when they are cold.  
See Vehicle Load Limits on  
page 824, for an example of the  
Tire and Loading Information label  
and its location on your vehicle.  
Also see Tire Pressure on  
This vehicle may have a Tire  
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS).  
The TPMS is designed to warn the  
driver when a low tire pressure  
condition exists. TPMS sensors are  
mounted onto each tire and wheel  
assembly, excluding the spare tire  
and wheel assembly. The TPMS  
sensors monitor the air pressure in  
the vehicle's tires and transmits the  
tire pressure readings to a receiver  
located in the vehicle.  
At the same time a message to  
check the pressure in a specific tire  
appears on the Driver Information  
Center (DIC) display. The low tire  
pressure warning light and the DIC  
warning message come on at each  
ignition cycle until the tires are  
inflated to the correct inflation  
page 946  
.
pressure. Using the DIC, tire  
Your vehicle's TPMS can warn you  
about a low tire pressure condition  
but it does not replace normal tire  
maintenance. See Tire Inspection  
on page 952, Tire Rotation on  
page 952 and Tires on page 940.  
pressure levels can be viewed by  
the driver. For additional information  
and details about the DIC operation  
and displays see Driver Information  
Center (DIC) on page 424.  
The low tire pressure warning light  
may come on in cool weather when  
the vehicle is first started, and then  
turn off as you start to drive. This  
could be an early indicator that the  
air pressure in the tire(s) are getting  
low and need to be inflated to the  
proper pressure.  
Notice: Liquid tire sealants could  
damage the Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS) sensors. Sensor  
damage caused by using a tire  
sealant is not covered by your  
warranty. Do not use liquid tire  
sealants.  
When a low tire pressure condition  
is detected, the TPMS illuminates  
the low tire pressure warning light  
located on the instrument panel  
cluster. If the warning light comes  
on, stop as soon as possible and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-50  
Vehicle Care  
.
.
The TPMS sensor matching  
process was started but not  
completed or not completed  
successfully after rotating the  
vehicle's tires. The DIC message  
and TPMS malfunction light  
should go off once the TPMS  
sensor matching process is  
performed successfully. See  
TPMS Sensor Matching  
Operating electronic devices or  
being near facilities using radio  
wave frequencies similar to the  
TPMS could cause the TPMS  
sensors to malfunction.  
TPMS Malfunction Light and  
Message  
The TPMS will not function properly  
if one or more of the TPMS sensors  
are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the  
low tire warning light flashes for  
about one minute and then stays on  
for the remainder of the ignition  
cycle. A DIC warning message is  
also displayed. The low tire warning  
light and DIC warning message  
come on at each ignition cycle until  
the problem is corrected. Some of  
the conditions that can cause the  
malfunction light and DIC message  
to come on are:  
If the TPMS is not functioning it  
cannot detect or signal a low tire  
condition. See your dealer for  
service if the TPMS malfunction  
light and DIC message comes on  
and stays on.  
Processlater in this section.  
.
One or more TPMS sensors are  
missing or damaged. The DIC  
message and the TPMS  
malfunction light should go off  
when the TPMS sensors are  
installed and the sensor  
matching process is performed  
successfully. See your dealer for  
service.  
TPMS Sensor Matching  
Process  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique  
identification code. Any time you  
rotate your vehicle's tires or replace  
one or more of the TPMS sensors,  
the identification codes will need to  
be matched to the new tire/wheel  
position. The sensors are matched  
to the tire/wheel positions in the  
following order: driver side front tire,  
passenger side front tire, passenger  
side rear tire, and driver side rear  
tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool.  
See your dealer for service.  
.
One of the road tires has been  
replaced with the spare tire. The  
spare tire does not have a  
TPMS sensor. The TPMS  
malfunction light and DIC  
message should go off once you  
reinstall the road tire containing  
the TPMS sensor.  
.
Replacement tires or wheels do  
not match your vehicle's original  
equipment tires or wheels. Tires  
and wheels other than those  
recommended for your vehicle  
could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying  
New Tires on page 954.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-51  
The TPMS sensors can also be  
matched to each tire/wheel position  
by increasing or decreasing the  
tire's air pressure. If increasing the  
tire's air pressure, do not exceed  
the maximum inflation pressure  
indicated on the tire's sidewall.  
The TPMS sensor matching process  
is outlined below:  
6. Start with the driver side  
front tire.  
1. Set the parking brake.  
7. Remove the valve cap from the  
valve cap stem. Activate the  
TPMS sensor by increasing or  
decreasing the tire's air pressure  
for five seconds, or until a horn  
chirp sounds. The horn chirp,  
which may take up to  
2. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN with  
the engine off.  
3. Use the MENU button to select  
the Vehicle Information Menu in  
the Driver Information Center  
(DIC). Use the arrow keys to  
scroll to the Tire Pressure  
screen.  
To decrease air-pressure out of a  
tire you can use the pointed end of  
the valve cap, a pencil-style air  
pressure gage, or a key.  
30 seconds to sound, confirms  
that the sensor identification  
code has been matched to this  
tire and wheel position.  
You have two minutes to match the  
first tire/wheel position, and  
4. Press the SET/CLR button to  
begin the sensor matching  
process.  
five minutes overall to match all four  
tire/wheel positions. If it takes longer  
than two minutes, to match the first  
tire and wheel, or more than  
five minutes to match all four tire  
and wheel positions the matching  
process stops and you need to  
start over.  
8. Proceed to the passenger side  
front tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 7.  
A message asking if you are  
sure you want to begin this  
process should appear.  
9. Proceed to the passenger side  
rear tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 7.  
5. Press the SET/CLR button again  
to confirm the selection.  
The horn sounds twice to signal  
the receiver is in relearn mode  
and the Tire Learning Active  
message displays on the DIC  
screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-52  
Vehicle Care  
10. Proceed to the driver side rear  
tire, and repeat the procedure  
in Step 7. The horn sounds two  
times to indicate the sensor  
identification code has been  
matched to the driver side rear  
tire, and the TPMS sensor  
matching process is no longer  
active. The Tire Learning  
of wear or damage. See When  
It Is Time for New Tires on  
page 953 for more information.  
Tire Rotation  
Tires should be rotated every  
8 000 to 13 000 km (5,000 to  
8,000 miles). See Scheduled  
Active message on the DIC  
display screen goes off.  
Maintenance on page 102  
.
The purpose of a regular tire  
rotation is to achieve a uniform  
wear for all tires on the vehicle.  
This will ensure that the vehicle  
continues to perform most like it  
did when the tires were new.  
11. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.  
When rotating the vehicle's tires,  
always use the correct rotation  
pattern shown here.  
12. Set all four tires to the  
recommended air pressure  
level as indicated on the Tire  
and Loading Information label.  
Do not include the compact  
spare tire in the tire rotation.  
13. Put the valve caps back on the  
valve stems.  
Any time you notice unusual  
wear, rotate the tires as soon as  
possible and check wheel  
alignment. Also check for  
damaged tires or wheels. See  
When It Is Time for New Tires  
on page 953 and Wheel  
After the tires have been  
rotated, adjust the front and rear  
inflation pressures as shown on  
the Tire and Loading Information  
label. See Tire Pressure on  
page 946 and Vehicle Load  
Tire Inspection  
We recommend that you  
regularly inspect your vehicle's  
tires, including the spare tire,  
if the vehicle has one, for signs  
Limits on page 824  
.
Replacement on page 957  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-53  
The vehicle needs new tires if any  
of the following statements are true:  
Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor  
When It Is Time for New  
Tires  
System. See Tire Pressure  
Monitor Operation on page 949  
.
.
You can see the indicators at  
Various factors, such as  
three or more places around  
the tire.  
Make certain that all wheel nuts  
are properly tightened. See  
Wheel Nut Torqueunder  
maintenance, temperatures, driving  
speeds, vehicle loading, and road  
conditions influence when you need  
new tires.  
.
You can see cord or fabric  
showing through the tire's  
rubber.  
Capacities and Specifications on  
page 112  
.
.
The tread or sidewall is cracked,  
cut, or snagged deep enough to  
show cord or fabric.  
WARNING  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the  
parts to which it is fastened, can  
make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come  
off and cause an accident. When  
changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the  
wheel attaches to the vehicle. In  
an emergency, use a cloth or a  
paper towel to do this; but be sure  
to use a scraper or wire brush  
later, if needed, to get all the rust  
or dirt off. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
.
The tire has a bump, bulge,  
or split.  
.
The tire has a puncture, cut,  
or other damage that cannot be  
repaired well because of the size  
or location of the damage.  
The rubber in tires degrades over  
time. This is also true for the spare  
tire, if the vehicle has one, even if it  
is not being used. Multiple  
conditions affect how fast this aging  
takes place, including temperatures,  
loading conditions, and inflation  
pressure maintenance. With proper  
care and maintenance tires typically  
One way to tell when it is time for  
new tires is to check the treadwear  
indicators, which appear when the  
tires have only 1.6 mm (1/16 inch) or  
less of tread remaining.  
on page 959  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-54  
Vehicle Care  
wear out before they degrade due to  
age. If you are unsure about the  
need to replace the tires as they get  
older, consult the tire manufacturer  
for more information.  
GM's exclusive TPC Spec  
See Tire Inspection on page 952  
and Tire Rotation on page 952  
for information on proper tire  
rotation.  
system considers over a dozen  
critical specifications that impact  
the overall performance of your  
vehicle, including brake system  
performance, ride and handling,  
traction control, and tire  
WARNING  
{
Buying New Tires  
Mixing tires could cause you  
to lose control while driving.  
If you mix tires of different  
sizes, brands, or types (radial  
and bias-belted tires), the  
vehicle may not handle  
properly, and you could have  
a crash. Using tires of different  
sizes, brands, or types may  
also cause damage to your  
vehicle. Be sure to use the  
correct size, brand, and type  
of tires on all wheels. It is all  
right to drive with your  
GM has developed and matched  
specific tires for your vehicle.  
The original equipment tires  
installed on your vehicle, when it  
was new, were designed to meet  
General Motors Tire  
pressure monitoring  
performance. GM's TPC Spec  
number is molded onto the tire's  
sidewall near the tire size. If the  
tires have an allseason tread  
design, the TPC Spec number  
will be followed by an MS for  
mud and snow. See Tire  
Performance Criteria  
Specification (TPC Spec)  
system rating. If you need  
replacement tires, GM strongly  
recommends that you get tires  
with the same TPC Spec rating.  
This way, your vehicle will  
continue to have tires that are  
designed to give the same  
performance and vehicle safety,  
during normal use, as the  
original tires.  
Sidewall Labeling on page 940  
for additional information.  
GM recommends replacing tires  
in sets of four. This is because  
uniform tread depth on all tires  
will help keep your vehicle  
performing most like it did when  
the tires were new. Replacing  
less than a full set of tires can  
affect the braking and handling  
performance of your vehicle.  
compact spare temporarily, as  
it was developed for use on  
your vehicle. See Compact  
Spare Tire on page 968  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-55  
Additionally, if your vehicle has  
NonTPC Spec rated tires may  
give a lowpressure warning that  
is higher or lower than the  
proper warning level you would  
get with TPC Spec rated tires.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor  
WARNING  
{
electronic systems such as antilock  
brakes, rollover airbags, traction  
control, and electronic stability  
control, the performance of these  
systems can be affected.  
If you use bias-ply tires on the  
vehicle, the wheel rim flanges  
could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire  
and/or wheel could fail  
suddenly, causing a crash.  
Use only radial-ply tires with  
the wheels on the vehicle.  
System on page 947  
.
WARNING  
{
Your vehicle's original  
If you add different sized wheels,  
your vehicle may not provide an  
acceptable level of performance  
and safety if tires not  
equipment tires are listed on the  
Tire and Loading Information  
Label. See Vehicle Load Limits  
on page 824 , for more  
If you must replace your  
recommended for those wheels  
are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and  
suffer serious injury. Only use GM  
specific wheel and tire systems  
developed for your vehicle, and  
have them properly installed by a  
GM certified technician.  
vehicle's tires with those that do  
not have a TPC Spec number,  
make sure they are the same  
size, load range, speed rating,  
and construction type (radial and  
biasbelted tires) as your  
information about the Tire and  
Loading Information Label and  
its location on your vehicle.  
Different Size Tires and  
Wheels  
If you add wheels or tires that are a  
different size than your original  
equipment wheels and tires, this  
could affect the way your vehicle  
performs, including its braking, ride  
and handling characteristics,  
vehicle's original tires.  
Vehicles that have a tire  
pressure monitoring system  
could give an inaccurate  
lowpressure warning if  
nonTPC Spec rated tires are  
installed on your vehicle.  
See Buying New Tires on  
page 954 and Accessories and  
Modifications on page 94 for  
additional information.  
stability, and resistance to rollover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-56  
Vehicle Care  
(UTQG) system does not apply  
to deep tread, winter-type snow  
tires, space-saver, or temporary  
use spare tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of  
10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm),  
or to some limited-production  
tires.  
Treadwear  
Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading  
Quality grades can be found  
where applicable on the tire  
sidewall between tread shoulder  
and maximum section width. For  
example:  
The treadwear grade is a  
comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test  
course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and  
a half (1½) times as well on the  
government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative  
performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of  
their use, however, and may  
depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
While the tires available on  
General Motors passenger cars  
and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they  
must also conform to federal  
safety requirements and  
additional General Motors Tire  
Performance Criteria (TPC)  
standards.  
The following information relates  
to the system developed by the  
United States National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA), which grades tires by  
treadwear, traction, and  
temperature performance. This  
applies only to vehicles sold in  
the United States. The grades  
are molded on the sidewalls of  
most passenger car tires. The  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
driving habits, service practices  
and differences in road  
characteristics and climate.  
All Passenger Car Tires Must  
Conform to Federal Safety  
Requirements In Addition To  
These Grades.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-57  
Traction AA, A, B, C  
conditions on a specified indoor  
laboratory test wheel. Sustained  
high temperature can cause the  
material of the tire to degenerate  
and reduce tire life, and  
excessive temperature can lead  
to sudden tire failure. The grade  
C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all  
passenger car tires must meet  
under the Federal Motor Safety  
Standard No. 109. Grades B and  
A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory  
test wheel than the minimum  
required by law. Warning: The  
temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is  
properly inflated and not  
overloaded. Excessive speed,  
underinflation, or excessive  
loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat  
buildup and possible tire failure.  
Wheel Alignment and Tire  
Balance  
The traction grades, from  
highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,  
and C. Those grades represent  
the tire's ability to stop on wet  
pavement as measured under  
controlled conditions on  
The tires and wheels on the vehicle  
were aligned and balanced carefully  
at the factory to give the longest tire  
life and best overall performance.  
Adjustments to wheel alignment and  
tire balancing will not be necessary  
on a regular basis. However, if there  
is unusual tire wear or the vehicle  
pulls to one side or the other, the  
alignment should be checked.  
If the vehicle vibrates when driving  
on a smooth road, the tires and  
wheels might need to be  
specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and  
concrete. A tire marked C may  
have poor traction performance.  
Warning: The traction grade  
assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction  
tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering,  
rebalanced. See your dealer for  
proper diagnosis.  
hydroplaning, or peak traction  
characteristics.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent,  
cracked, or badly rusted or  
corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming  
loose, the wheel, wheel bolts, and  
wheel nuts should be replaced.  
If the wheel leaks air, replace it  
(except some aluminum wheels,  
Temperature A, B, C  
The temperature grades are A  
(the highest), B, and C,  
representing the tire's resistance  
to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when  
tested under controlled  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-58  
Vehicle Care  
which can sometimes be repaired).  
See your dealer if any of these  
conditions exist.  
Used Replacement Wheels  
WARNING (Continued)  
WARNING  
{
dangerous. It could affect the  
braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air  
and make you lose control. You  
could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured.  
Always use the correct wheel,  
wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
Your dealer will know the kind of  
wheel you need.  
Putting a used wheel on the  
vehicle is dangerous. You cannot  
know how it has been used or  
how far it has been driven.  
It could fail suddenly and cause a  
crash. If you have to replace a  
wheel, use a new GM original  
equipment wheel.  
Each new wheel should have the  
same load-carrying capacity,  
diameter, width, offset, and be  
mounted the same way as the one it  
replaces.  
If you need to replace any of the  
wheels, wheel bolts, wheel nuts,  
or Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS) sensors, replace them only  
with new GM original equipment  
parts. This way, you will be sure to  
have the right wheel, wheel bolts,  
wheel nuts, and TPMS sensors for  
the vehicle.  
Notice: The wrong wheel can  
also cause problems with bearing  
life, brake cooling, speedometer  
or odometer calibration,  
headlamp aim, bumper height,  
vehicle ground clearance, and tire  
or tire chain clearance to the  
body and chassis.  
Tire Chains  
WARNING  
{
Do not use tire chains. There is  
not enough clearance. Tire chains  
used on a vehicle without the  
proper amount of clearance can  
cause damage to the brakes,  
suspension or other vehicle parts.  
The area damaged by the tire  
See If a Tire Goes Flat on  
page 959 for more information.  
WARNING  
{
Using the wrong replacement  
wheels, wheel bolts, or wheel  
nuts on your vehicle can be  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-59  
be very bumpy and noisy, but you  
can still steer. Gently brake to a  
stop, well off the road if possible.  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
WARNING (Continued)  
It is unusual for a tire to blowout  
while you are driving, especially if  
you maintain your vehicle's tires  
properly. If air goes out of a tire, it is  
much more likely to leak out slowly.  
But if you should ever have a  
chains could cause you to lose  
control of the vehicle and you or  
others may be injured in a crash.  
WARNING  
{
Lifting a vehicle and getting under  
it to do maintenance or repairs is  
dangerous without the  
Use another type of traction  
device only if its manufacturer  
recommends it for use on the  
vehicle and tire size combination  
and road conditions. Follow that  
manufacturer's instructions. To  
help avoid damage to the vehicle,  
drive slowly, readjust or remove  
the device if it is contacting the  
vehicle, and do not spin the  
vehicle's wheels. If you do find  
traction devices that will fit, install  
them on the front tires.  
blowout, here are a few tips about  
what to expect and what to do:  
appropriate safety equipment and  
training. If a jack is provided with  
the vehicle, it is designed only for  
changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could  
be badly injured or killed if the  
vehicle slips off the jack. If a jack  
is provided with the vehicle, only  
use it for changing a flat tire.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire  
creates a drag that pulls the vehicle  
toward that side. Take your foot off  
the accelerator pedal and grip the  
steering wheel firmly. Steer to  
maintain lane position, and then  
gently brake to a stop well out of the  
traffic lane.  
A rear blowout, particularly on a  
curve, acts much like a skid and  
may require the same correction  
you would use in a skid. In any rear  
blowout remove your foot from the  
accelerator pedal. Get the vehicle  
under control by steering the way  
you want the vehicle to go. It may  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-60  
Vehicle Care  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire  
and wheel damage by driving slowly  
to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard  
When the vehicle has a flat tire (B),  
use the following example as a  
guide to assist you in the placement  
of wheel blocks (A).  
WARNING (Continued)  
3. Turn off the engine and do  
not restart while the vehicle  
is raised.  
Warning Flashers on page 52.  
WARNING  
{
4. Do not allow passengers to  
remain in the vehicle.  
Changing a tire can be  
To be certain the vehicle will not  
move, put blocks at the front and  
rear of the tire farthest away from  
the one being changed. That  
would be the tire on the other  
side, at the opposite end of the  
vehicle.  
dangerous. The vehicle can slip  
off the jack and roll over or fall on  
you or other people. You and they  
could be badly injured or even  
killed. Find a level place to  
change your tire. To help prevent  
the vehicle from moving:  
1. Set the parking brake firmly.  
A. Wheel Block  
B. Flat Tire  
2. Put an automatic  
transmission shift lever in  
P (Park), or shift a manual  
transmission to 1 (First) or  
R (Reverse).  
The following information explains  
how to repair or change a tire.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-61  
Removing the Flat Tire and  
Installing the Spare Tire  
Tire Changing  
Removing the Spare Tire and  
Tools  
1. Do a safety check before  
proceeding. See If a Tire Goes  
Flat on page 959 for more  
information.  
To access the spare tire and tools:  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate  
(Manual) on page 18 or  
2. For vehicles with wheel nut  
caps, turn the wheel wrench  
counterclockwise to loosen and  
remove them.  
Liftgate (Power) on page 18.  
2. Lift the load floor up.  
Do not try to remove plastic caps  
from the cover or center cap.  
4. Turn the retainer nut  
counterclockwise and remove  
the spare tire.  
3. For vehicles with a wheel cover  
or center cap, pull the cover or  
center cap away from the wheel  
to remove it. Store the wheel  
cover in the cargo area until you  
have the flat tire repaired or  
replaced.  
5. Place the spare tire next to the  
tire being changed.  
3. Remove the extension (A),  
wheel wrench (B) and jack (C).  
Place the tools next to the tire  
being changed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-62  
Vehicle Care  
6. Position the jack lift head at the  
jack location nearest the flat tire.  
The location is indicated by a  
mark on the bottom edge of the  
front and rear door plastic  
molding. The jack must not be  
used in any other position.  
4. Turn the wheel wrench  
counterclockwise to loosen all  
the wheel nuts, but do not  
remove them yet.  
Front  
5. Place the jack near the flat tire.  
Notice: Make sure that the jack  
lift head is in the correct position  
or you may damage your vehicle.  
The repairs would not be covered  
by your warranty.  
Place the jack notch (A) under  
the frame rail seam (B).  
7. Put the compact spare tire  
near you.  
Rear  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-63  
WARNING  
WARNING  
{
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is  
jacked up is dangerous. If the  
vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed.  
Never get under a vehicle when it  
is supported only by a jack.  
Lifting a vehicle and getting under  
it to do maintenance or repairs is  
dangerous without the  
appropriate safety equipment and  
training. If a jack is provided with  
the vehicle, it is designed only for  
changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could  
be badly injured or killed if the  
vehicle slips off the jack. If a jack  
is provided with the vehicle, only  
use it for changing a flat tire.  
WARNING  
{
8. Fit the jack handle extension  
onto the jack by sliding the hook  
through the end of the jack.  
Raising your vehicle with the jack  
improperly positioned can  
damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help  
avoid personal injury and vehicle  
damage, be sure to fit the jack lift  
head into the proper location  
before raising the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-64  
Vehicle Care  
9. Insert the other end of the jack  
handle into the wrench.  
10. Place the jack under the  
vehicle.  
11. Raise the vehicle by turning the  
jack handle clockwise. Raise  
the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough  
room for the road tire to clear  
the ground.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-65  
15. Place the compact spare tire  
on the wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING (Continued)  
paper towel to do this; but be sure  
to use a scraper or wire brush  
later, if needed, to get all the rust  
or dirt off. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
WARNING  
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts  
or nuts because the nuts might  
come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
on page 959  
.
16. Reinstall the wheel nuts.  
Tighten each nut by hand until  
the wheel is held against  
the hub.  
12. Remove all of the wheel nuts.  
13. Remove the flat tire.  
17. Lower the vehicle by  
turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise.  
WARNING  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the  
parts to which it is fastened, can  
make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come  
off and cause an accident. When  
changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the  
wheel attaches to the vehicle. In  
an emergency, use a cloth or a  
14. Remove any rust or dirt from  
the wheel bolts, mounting  
surfaces, and spare wheel.  
(Continued)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-66  
Vehicle Care  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit  
on your vehicle's compact spare.  
If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or  
the spare could be damaged.  
WARNING  
{
Wheel nuts that are improperly or  
incorrectly tightened can cause  
the wheels to become loose or  
come off. The wheel nuts should  
be tightened with a torque wrench  
to the proper torque specification  
after replacing. Follow the torque  
specification supplied by the  
aftermarket manufacturer when  
using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire  
and Tools  
WARNING  
{
Storing a jack, a tire, or other  
equipment in the passenger  
compartment of the vehicle could  
cause injury. In a sudden stop or  
collision, loose equipment could  
strike someone. Store all these in  
the proper place.  
18. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly in  
a crisscross sequence, as  
shown.  
Specifications on page 112 for  
original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
19. Lower the jack all the way and  
remove the jack from under the  
vehicle.  
Notice: Improperly tightened  
wheel nuts can lead to brake  
pulsation and rotor damage. To  
avoid expensive brake repairs,  
evenly tighten the wheel nuts in  
the proper sequence and to the  
proper torque specification. See  
Capacities and Specifications on  
page 112 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
20. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly  
with the wheel wrench.  
When reinstalling the wheel cover or  
center cap on the full-size tire,  
tighten all five plastic caps hand  
snug with the aid of the wheel  
wrench and tighten them with the  
wheel wrench an additional one‐  
quarter of a turn.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-67  
To store the flat tire:  
4. Pull the cable (A) through the  
door striker (D) then the center  
of the wheel (C).  
5. Hook the cable onto the outside  
portion of the liftgate hinges (B).  
1. Remove the cable package. The  
cable is stored in a plastic bag  
under the compact spare tire.  
6. Hook the other end of the cable  
onto the outside portion of the  
liftgate hinge on the other side of  
the vehicle.  
2. Remove the small center cap by  
tapping the back of the cap with  
the extension of the shaft, if the  
vehicle has aluminum wheels.  
7. Pull on the cable to make sure it  
is secure.  
3. Put the flat tire in the rear  
storage area with the valve stem  
pointing toward the rear of the  
vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-68  
Vehicle Care  
tire repaired or replaced at your  
convenience. Of course, it is best to  
replace the spare with a full-size tire  
as soon as possible. The spare tire  
will last longer and be in good  
Compact Spare Tire  
WARNING  
{
Driving with more than one  
compact spare tire at a time could  
result in loss of braking and  
handling. This could lead to a  
crash and you or others could be  
injured. Use only one compact  
spare tire at a time.  
shape in case it is needed again.  
Notice: When the compact spare  
is installed, do not take the  
vehicle through an automatic car  
wash with guide rails. The  
compact spare can get caught on  
the rails which can damage the  
tire, wheel and other parts of the  
vehicle.  
8. Make sure the metal tube is  
centered at the striker. Push the  
tube toward the front of the  
vehicle.  
If this vehicle has a compact spare  
tire it was fully inflated when the  
vehicle was new, however, it can  
lose air after a time. Check the  
inflation pressure regularly. It should  
be 420 kPa (60 psi).  
Do not use the compact spare on  
other vehicles.  
9. Close the liftgate and make sure  
it is latched properly.  
Do not mix the compact spare tire or  
wheel with other wheels or tires.  
They will not fit. Keep the spare tire  
and its wheel together.  
After installing the compact spare  
on the vehicle, stop as soon as  
possible and make sure the spare  
tire is correctly inflated. The  
compact spare is made to perform  
well at speeds up to 105 km/h  
(65 mph) for distances up to  
The compact spare is for temporary  
use only. Replace the compact  
spare tire with a full-size tire as  
soon as you can.  
Notice: Tire chains will not fit the  
compact spare. Using them can  
damage the vehicle and can  
damage the chains too. Do not  
use tire chains on the compact  
spare.  
5 000 km (3,000 miles), so you can  
finish your trip and have the full-size  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-69  
Be sure to use the following steps to  
do it safely. Ignoring these steps  
could result in costly damage to the  
vehicle that would not be covered  
by the warranty.  
Jump Starting  
WARNING  
{
Jump starting can be used on  
vehicles with rundown batteries by  
using jumper cables and another  
vehicle.  
Using an open flame near a  
battery can cause battery gas to  
explode. People have been hurt  
doing this, and some have been  
blinded. Use a flashlight if you  
need more light.  
Trying to start the vehicle by  
pushing or pulling it will not work,  
and it could damage the vehicle.  
WARNING  
{
Notice: If you leave the radio or  
other accessories on during the  
jump starting procedure, they  
could be damaged. The repairs  
would not be covered by the  
warranty. Always turn off the  
radio and other accessories when  
jump starting the vehicle.  
Batteries can hurt you. They can  
be dangerous because:  
Be sure the battery has enough  
water. You do not need to add  
water to the battery installed in  
your new vehicle. But if a battery  
has filler caps, be sure the right  
amount of fluid is there. If it is low,  
add water to take care of that  
first. If you do not, explosive gas  
could be present.  
.
They contain acid that can  
burn you.  
.
They contain gas that can  
explode or ignite.  
.
They contain enough  
Notice: If the jumper cables are  
connected or removed in the  
wrong order, electrical shorting  
may occur and damage the  
vehicle. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always connect and remove the  
jumper cables in the correct  
order, making sure that the  
cables do not touch each other or  
other metal.  
electricity to burn you.  
If you do not follow these steps  
exactly, some or all of these  
things can hurt you.  
Battery fluid contains acid that  
can burn you. Do not get it on  
you. If you accidentally get it in  
your eyes or on your skin, flush  
the place with water and get  
medical help immediately.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-70  
Vehicle Care  
1. The vehicle used to jump start  
must have 12-volt battery with a  
negative ground.  
4. Locate the positive (+) and  
negative () terminals on both  
vehicles. Some vehicles have  
remote jump starting terminals.  
5. The remote positive (+)  
terminal (A) is located on the  
underhood fuse block, on the  
driver side. Lift the red cap to  
uncover the terminal.  
Notice: If the other vehicle's  
system is not a 12-volt system  
with a negative ground, both  
vehicles can be damaged. Only  
use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump  
start your vehicle.  
The remote negative ()  
terminal (B) is a stud behind the  
metal tab stamped with GND ()  
near the driver side strut tower.  
6. The jumper cables should be in  
good working condition with no  
loose or missing insulation. The  
vehicles could be damaged if  
they are not.  
2. The vehicles should be close  
enough for the jumper cables to  
reach, but the vehicles should  
not be touching. Touching could  
cause grounding and possible  
electrical system damage.  
7. Connect the red positive (+)  
cable to the positive (+) terminal  
on the vehicle with the dead  
battery. Use a remote  
Put both vehicles in P (Park)  
and set the parking brake firmly.  
WARNING  
{
positive (+) terminal if the vehicle  
has one.  
3. Unplug accessories plugged into  
the cigarette lighter or the  
An electric fan can start up even  
when the engine is not running  
and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
accessory power outlet. Turn off  
the radio and all lamps that are  
not needed. Turn off the ignition  
on both vehicles.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-71  
8. Do not let the other end touch  
metal. Connect it to the  
positive (+) terminal of the good  
battery. Use a remote  
11. Start the vehicle with the good  
battery and run the engine.  
12. Press the unlock symbol on the  
remote keyless entry  
positive (+) terminal if the vehicle  
has one.  
transmitter to disarm the  
security system, if equipped.  
9. Connect the black negative ()  
cable to the negative () terminal  
of the good battery. Use a  
13. Try to start the vehicle that had  
the dead battery. If it will not  
start after a few tries, it needs  
service.  
remote negative () terminal if  
the vehicle has one.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are  
connected or removed in the  
wrong order, electrical shorting  
may occur and damage the  
vehicle. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always connect and remove the  
jumper cables in the correct  
order, making sure that the  
cables do not touch each other or  
other metal.  
Do not let the other end touch  
anything until the next step. The  
other end of the negative ()  
cable does not go to the dead  
battery. It goes to a heavy,  
unpainted metal engine part or  
to a remote negative () terminal  
on the vehicle with the dead  
battery.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine  
Part or Remote Negative ()  
Terminal  
B. Good Battery or Remote  
Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote  
Positive (+) Terminal  
10. Connect the other end of the  
negative () cable away from  
the dead battery, but not near  
engine parts that move.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-72  
Vehicle Care  
To disconnect the jumper cables  
from both vehicles,  
dolly towing. Dinghy towing is  
towing the vehicle with all four  
wheels on the ground. Dolly towing  
is towing the vehicle with two  
wheels on the ground and two  
wheels up on a device known as a  
dolly.  
Towing  
1. Disconnect the black  
negative () cable from the  
vehicle that had the dead  
battery.  
Towing the Vehicle  
To avoid damage, the disabled  
vehicle should be towed with all four  
wheels off the ground. Consult your  
dealer or a professional towing  
service if the disabled vehicle must  
be towed. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 126.  
2. Disconnect the black  
negative () cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
Here are some important things to  
consider before recreational vehicle  
towing:  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+)  
cable from the vehicle with the  
good battery.  
.
What is the towing capacity of  
To tow the vehicle behind  
the towing vehicle? Be sure to  
read the tow vehicle  
manufacturer's  
another vehicle for recreational  
purposes such as behind a  
motorhome, see Recreational  
Vehicle Towing following.  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+)  
cable from the other vehicle.  
recommendations.  
.
5. Return the underhood fuse block  
cover to its original position,  
if applicable.  
What is the distance that will be  
travelled? Some vehicles have  
restrictions on how far and how  
long they can tow.  
Recreational Vehicle  
Towing  
.
Recreational vehicle towing means  
towing the vehicle behind another  
vehicle such as behind a  
motorhome. The two most common  
types of recreational vehicle towing  
are known as dinghy towing and  
Is the proper towing equipment  
going to be used? See your  
dealer or trailering professional  
for additional advice and  
equipment recommendations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-73  
.
Is the vehicle ready to be  
towed? Just as preparing the  
vehicle for a long trip, make sure  
the vehicle is prepared to be  
towed.  
5. To prevent the battery from  
draining while the vehicle is  
being towed, remove fuse 32,  
the Discrete Logic Ignition  
Switch fuse, from the instrument  
panel fuse block and store it in a  
safe location. See Instrument  
Panel Fuse Block on page 937.  
Dinghy Towing  
Front-wheeldrive and  
all-wheel-drive vehicles may be  
dinghy towed from the front. These  
vehicles can also be towed by  
placing them on a platform trailer  
with all four wheels off of the  
ground. For other towing options,  
see Dolly Towingfollowing in this  
section.  
Notice: If the vehicle is towed  
without performing each of the  
steps listed under Dinghy  
Towing,the automatic  
To tow the vehicle from the front  
with all four wheels on the ground:  
transmission could be damaged.  
Be sure to follow all steps of the  
dinghy towing procedure prior to  
and after towing the vehicle.  
1. Position the vehicle that will be  
towed and secure it to the  
towing vehicle.  
For vehicles being dinghy towed,  
the vehicle should be run at the  
beginning of each day and at each  
RV fuel stop for about five minutes.  
This will ensure proper lubrication of  
transmission components.  
Notice: If 105 km/h (65 mph) is  
exceeded while towing the  
vehicle, it could be damaged.  
Never exceed 105 km/h (65 mph)  
while towing the vehicle.  
2. Turn the ignition key to ACC/  
ACCESSORY.  
3. Shift the transmission to  
N (Neutral).  
4. Turn all accessories off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-74  
Vehicle Care  
Once the destination has been  
reached:  
Notice: Do not tow a vehicle with  
the front drive wheels on the  
ground if one of the front tires is  
a compact spare tire. Towing with  
two different tire sizes on the  
front of the vehicle can cause  
severe damage to the  
Dolly Towing  
(Front-WheelDrive Vehicles)  
1. Set the parking brake.  
2. Shift the transmission to  
P (Park).  
3. Turn the ignition key to  
LOCK/OFF.  
transmission.  
Dolly Towing (All-WheelDrive  
Vehicles)  
4. Install fuse 32, the Discrete  
Logic Ignition Switch fuse. See  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block on  
All-wheeldrive vehicles should not  
be towed with two wheels on the  
ground. To properly tow these  
vehicles, they should be placed on  
a platform trailer with all four wheels  
off of the ground or dinghy towed  
from the front.  
page 937  
.
5. Start the engine and let it idle for  
more than three minutes before  
driving the vehicle.  
To tow the vehicle from the front  
with the rear wheels on the ground,  
do the following:  
Notice: Too much or too little  
fluid can damage the  
transmission. Be sure that the  
transmission fluid is at the proper  
level before towing with all four  
wheels on the ground.  
1. Put the front wheels on a dolly.  
2. Move the shift lever to P (Park).  
3. Set the parking brake.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-75  
4. Secure the vehicle to the dolly.  
Appearance Care  
5. Follow the dolly manufacturer's  
instructions for preparing the  
vehicle and dolly for towing.  
Exterior Care  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/  
Lenses  
6. Release the parking brake.  
Towing the Vehicle From  
the Rear  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a  
soft cloth and a car washing soap to  
clean exterior lamps and lenses.  
Follow instructions under Washing  
the Vehiclelater in this section.  
Notice: Towing the vehicle from  
the rear could damage it. Also,  
repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Never have  
the vehicle towed from the rear.  
Finish Care  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing  
of the vehicle by hand may be  
necessary to remove residue from  
the paint finish. Approved cleaning  
products can be obtained from your  
dealer.  
If the vehicle has a basecoat/  
clearcoat paint finish, the clearcoat  
gives more depth and gloss to the  
colored basecoat. Always use  
waxes and polishes that are  
non-abrasive and made for a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-76  
Vehicle Care  
Notice: Machine compounding or  
aggressive polishing on a  
basecoat/clearcoat paint finish  
may damage it. Use only  
non-abrasive waxes and polishes  
that are made for a basecoat/  
clearcoat paint finish on the  
vehicle.  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal  
Parts  
should not be used on plastic  
parts, do not use it on the vehicle  
or damage may occur and it  
would not be covered by the  
warranty.  
Bright metal parts should be  
cleaned regularly to keep their  
luster. Wash with water or use  
chrome polish on chrome or  
stainless steel trim, if necessary.  
Do not use cleaning agents that are  
petroleum based or that contain  
acid or abrasives, as they can  
damage the paint, metal or plastic  
on the vehicle. Approved cleaning  
products can be obtained from your  
dealer. Follow all manufacturer  
directions regarding correct product  
usage, necessary safety  
Use special care with aluminum  
trim. To avoid damaging protective  
trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap to  
clean aluminum. A coating of wax,  
rubbed to high polish, is  
Foreign materials such as calcium  
chloride and other salts, ice melting  
agents, road oil and tar, tree sap,  
bird droppings, chemicals from  
industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle's finish if they  
remain on painted surfaces. Wash  
the vehicle as soon as possible.  
If necessary, use non-abrasive  
cleaners that are marked safe for  
painted surfaces to remove foreign  
matter.  
recommended for all bright metal  
parts.  
precautions and appropriate  
disposal of any vehicle care  
product.  
Washing the Vehicle  
Rinse the vehicle well, before  
washing and after to remove all  
cleaning agents completely. If they  
are allowed to dry on the surface,  
they could stain.  
To preserve the vehicle's finish,  
keep it clean by washing it often.  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct  
sunlight and use a car  
washing soap.  
Exterior painted surfaces are  
subject to aging, weather and  
chemical fallout that can take their  
toll over a period of years. To keep  
the paint finish looking new, keep  
the vehicle garaged or covered  
whenever possible.  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean  
chamois or an all-cotton towel to  
avoid surface scratches and water  
spotting.  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain  
chemicals that can damage the  
emblems or nameplates on the  
vehicle. Check the cleaning  
product label. If it states that it  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-77  
High pressure car washes could  
cause water to enter the vehicle.  
Avoid using high pressure washes  
closer than 30 cm (12 inches) to the  
surface of the vehicle. Use of power  
washers exceeding 8,274 kPa  
(1,200 psi) can result in damage or  
removal of paint and decals.  
wheel(s). The repairs would not  
be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Use only approved  
cleaners on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
Wheels and Trim Aluminum  
or Chrome  
The vehicle may have either  
aluminum or chrome-plated wheels.  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft  
clean cloth with mild soap and  
water. Rinse with clean water. After  
rinsing thoroughly, dry with a soft  
clean towel. A wax may then be  
applied.  
The surface of these wheels is  
similar to the painted surface of the  
vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes,  
abrasive cleaners, cleaners with  
acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes  
on them because the surface could  
be damaged. Do not use chrome  
polish on aluminum wheels.  
Notice: Conveyor systems on  
some automatic car washes could  
damage the vehicle. There may  
not be enough clearance for the  
undercarriage. Check with the car  
wash manager before using the  
automatic car wash.  
Notice: Chrome wheels and  
other chrome trim may be  
damaged if the vehicle is not  
washed after driving on roads  
that have been sprayed with  
magnesium, calcium or sodium  
chloride. These chlorides are  
used on roads for conditions  
such as ice and dust. Always  
wash the vehicle's chrome with  
soap and water after exposure.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on  
aluminum wheels could damage  
the wheels. The repairs would not  
be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Use chrome polish on  
chrome wheels only.  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will  
make them last longer, seal better,  
and not stick or squeak. Apply  
silicone grease with a clean cloth.  
During very cold, damp weather  
frequent application may be  
Use chrome polish only on  
chrome-plated wheels, but avoid  
any painted surface of the wheel,  
and buff off immediately after  
application.  
Notice: Using strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes,  
cleaners, brushes, or cleaners  
that contain acid on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the  
required. See Recommended Fluids  
and Lubricants on page 107.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-78  
Vehicle Care  
Notice: Driving the vehicle  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
Original manufacturer replacement  
parts will provide the corrosion  
protection while maintaining the  
vehicle warranty.  
through an automatic car wash  
that has silicone carbide tire  
cleaning brushes, could damage  
the aluminum or chrome-plated  
wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Never drive a vehicle that has  
aluminum or chrome-plated  
wheels through an automatic car  
wash that uses silicone carbide  
tire cleaning brushes.  
.
Extreme dusty conditions  
.
Sand and salt  
.
Heat and sun  
Finish Damage  
.
Snow and ice, without proper  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep  
scratches in the finish should be  
repaired right away. Bare metal will  
corrode quickly and may develop  
into major repair expense.  
removal  
Tires  
Use a stiff brush with tire cleaner to  
clean the tires.  
Minor chips and scratches can be  
repaired with touch-up materials  
available from your dealer. Larger  
areas of finish damage can be  
corrected in your dealer's body  
and paint shop.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based  
tire dressing products on the  
vehicle may damage the paint  
finish and/or tires. When applying  
a tire dressing, always wipe off  
any overspray from all painted  
surfaces on the vehicle.  
Windshield and Wiper Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield  
with glass cleaner.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint  
free cloth or paper towel soaked  
with windshield washer fluid or a  
mild detergent. Wash the windshield  
thoroughly when cleaning the  
blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and  
a buildup of vehicle wash/wax  
treatments may cause wiper  
Underbody Maintenance  
Chemicals used for ice and snow  
removal and dust control can collect  
on the underbody. If these are not  
removed, corrosion and rust can  
develop on the underbody parts  
such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan,  
and exhaust system even though  
they have corrosion protection.  
Sheet Metal Damage  
If the vehicle is damaged and  
requires sheet metal repair or  
replacement, make sure the body  
repair shop applies anti-corrosion  
material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion  
protection.  
streaking. Replace the wiper blades  
if they are worn or damaged.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-79  
At least every spring, flush these  
materials from the underbody with  
plain water. Clean any areas  
where mud and debris can collect.  
Dirt packed in close areas of the  
frame should be loosened before  
being flushed. Your dealer or an  
underbody car washing system can  
do this.  
plastic surfaces. Stains should be  
removed quickly as extreme heat  
could cause them to set rapidly.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners  
when cleaning glass surfaces on  
the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the  
rear window defogger. When  
cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass  
cleaner.  
Lighter colored interiors may require  
more frequent cleaning.  
Newspapers and garments that can  
transfer color to home furnishings  
can also transfer color to the  
vehicle's interior.  
Cleaners can contain solvents that  
can become concentrated in the  
vehicle's interior. Before using  
cleaners, read and adhere to all  
safety instructions on the label.  
While cleaning the vehicle's interior,  
maintain adequate ventilation by  
opening the vehicle's doors and  
windows.  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
Remove dust from small buttons  
and knobs with a small brush with  
soft bristles.  
Some weather and atmospheric  
conditions can create a chemical  
fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall  
upon and attack painted surfaces on  
the vehicle. This damage can take  
two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped  
discolorations, and small, irregular  
dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Your dealer has products for  
cleaning the vehicle's interior. When  
cleaning the vehicle's interior, only  
use cleaners specifically designed  
for the surfaces that are being  
cleaned. Permanent damage can  
result from using cleaners on  
surfaces for which they were not  
intended. Apply the cleaner directly  
to the cleaning cloth to prevent  
over-spray. Remove any accidental  
over-spray from other surfaces  
immediately.  
Do not clean the interior using the  
following cleaners or techniques:  
.
Never use a knife or any other  
Interior Care  
sharp object to remove a soil  
from any interior surface.  
The vehicle's interior will continue to  
look its best if it is cleaned often.  
Dust and dirt can accumulate on the  
upholstery and cause damage to  
the carpet, fabric, leather, and  
.
Never use a stiff brush. It can  
cause damage to the vehicle's  
interior surfaces.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-80  
Vehicle Care  
.
Never apply heavy pressure or  
rub aggressively with a cleaning  
cloth. Use of heavy pressure can  
damage the interior and does  
not improve the effectiveness of  
soil removal.  
3. Start on the outside edge of the  
soil and gently rub toward the  
center. Continue cleaning, using  
a clean area of the cloth each  
time it becomes soiled.  
Fabric/Carpet  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft  
brush attachment to remove dust  
and loose dirt. A canister vacuum  
with a beater bar in the nozzle may  
only be used on floor carpet and  
carpeted floor mats. For soils,  
always try to remove them first with  
plain water or club soda. Before  
cleaning, gently remove as much of  
the soil as possible using one of the  
following techniques:  
4. Continue to gently rub the  
soiled area.  
.
Use only mild, neutral-pH soaps.  
Avoid laundry detergents or  
dishwashing soaps with  
degreasers. Using too much  
soap will leave a residue that  
leaves streaks and attracts dirt.  
For liquid cleaners, about  
20 drops per 3.78 L (1 gal) of  
water is a good guide.  
5. If the soil is not completely  
removed, use a mild soap  
solution and repeat the cleaning  
process with plain water.  
If any of the soil remains, a  
.
For liquids: gently blot the  
commercial fabric cleaner or spot  
lifter may be necessary. Test a small  
hidden area for colorfastness before  
using a commercial upholstery  
cleaner or spot lifter. If the locally  
cleaned area gives any impression  
that a ring formation may result,  
clean the entire surface.  
remaining soil with a paper  
towel. Allow the soil to absorb  
into the paper towel until no  
more can be removed.  
.
.
Do not heavily saturate the  
upholstery while cleaning.  
Damage to the vehicle's interior  
may result from the use of many  
organic solvents such as naptha,  
alcohol, etc.  
.
For solid dry soils: remove as  
much as possible and then  
vacuum.  
A paper towel can be used to blot  
excess moisture from the fabric or  
carpet after the cleaning process.  
To clean:  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white  
cloth with water or club soda.  
2. Remove excess moisture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
9-81  
Some commercial products may  
increase gloss on the instrument  
panel. The increase in gloss may  
cause annoying reflections in the  
windshield and even make it difficult  
to see through the windshield under  
certain conditions.  
Leather  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and  
Other Plastic Surfaces  
To remove dust, a soft cloth  
dampened with water can be used.  
If a more thorough cleaning is  
necessary, a soft cloth dampened  
with a mild soap solution can be  
used. Allow the leather to dry  
naturally. Do not use heat, steam,  
or spot lifters or spot removers,  
or shoe polish on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners and  
coatings that are sold to preserve  
and protect leather may  
To remove dust, a soft cloth  
dampened with water can be used.  
If a more thorough cleaning is  
necessary, a clean soft cloth  
dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove dust  
and dirt. Never use spot lifters or  
removers on plastic surfaces. Many  
commercial cleaners and coatings  
that are sold to preserve and protect  
soft plastic surfaces may  
Care of Safety Belts  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
WARNING  
{
Do not bleach or dye safety belts.  
It may severely weaken them. In  
a crash, they might not be able to  
provide adequate protection.  
Clean safety belts only with mild  
soap and lukewarm water.  
permanently change the  
permanently change the  
appearance and feel of the leather  
and are not recommended. Do not  
use silicone or wax-based products,  
or those containing organic solvents  
to clean the vehicle's interior  
because they can alter the  
appearance and feel of the interior  
and are not recommended. Do not  
use silicone or wax-based products,  
or those containing organic solvents  
to clean the vehicle's interior  
because they can alter the  
appearance by increasing the gloss  
in a non-uniform manner.  
appearance by increasing the gloss  
in a non-uniform manner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-82  
Vehicle Care  
2 NOTES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-1  
Because of all the different ways  
people use vehicles, maintenance  
needs vary. The vehicle might need  
more frequent checks and services.  
Please read the information under  
Scheduled Maintenance. To keep  
the vehicle in good condition, see  
your dealer.  
General Information  
Notice: Maintenance intervals,  
checks, inspections,  
Service and  
Maintenance  
recommended fluids, and  
lubricants are necessary to keep  
this vehicle in good working  
condition. Damage caused by  
failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
General Information  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . 10-1  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . 10-2  
The maintenance schedule is for  
vehicles that:  
Recommended Fluids,  
Lubricants, and Parts  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7  
Maintenance Replacement  
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9  
.
Carry passengers and cargo  
As the vehicle owner, you are  
responsible for the scheduled  
maintenance in this section. We  
recommend having your dealer  
perform these services. Proper  
vehicle maintenance helps to keep  
the vehicle in good working  
condition, improves fuel economy,  
and reduces vehicle emissions for  
better air quality.  
within recommended limits on  
the Tire and Loading Information  
label. See Vehicle Load Limits  
on page 824  
.
.
Are driven on reasonable road  
surfaces within legal driving  
limits.  
Maintenance Records  
Maintenance Records . . . . . . 10-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-2  
Service and Maintenance  
.
Are driven off-road in the  
recommended manner. See  
Off-Road Driving on page 88.  
Your dealer has specially trained  
service technicians, uses genuine  
replacement parts, as well as, up to  
date tools and equipment to ensure  
fast and accurate diagnostics.  
Scheduled  
Maintenance  
.
Use the recommended fuel. See  
Recommended Fuel on  
When the Change Engine Oil  
Soon Message Displays  
page 854  
.
The proper replacement parts,  
fluids, and lubricants to use are  
listed in Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 107 and  
Change engine oil and filter. See  
Engine Oil on page 910. An  
Emission Control Service.  
WARNING  
{
Performing maintenance work can  
be dangerous. Some jobs can  
cause serious injury. Perform  
maintenance work only if you  
have the required know-how and  
the proper tools and equipment.  
If in doubt, see your dealer to  
have a qualified technician do the  
work. See Doing Your Own  
Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 109. We recommend the use  
of genuine parts from your dealer.  
When the Change Engine Oil  
Soon message displays, service  
is required for the vehicle as  
soon as possible, within the next  
1 000 km/600 miles. If driving under  
the best conditions, the engine oil  
life system might not indicate the  
need for vehicle service for more  
than a year. The engine oil and filter  
must be changed at least once a  
year and the oil life system must be  
reset. Your dealer has trained  
service technicians who will perform  
this work and reset the system.  
If the engine oil life system is reset  
accidentally, service the vehicle  
within 5 000 km/3,000 miles since  
the last service. Reset the oil life  
Rotation of New Tires  
To maintain ride, handling, and  
performance of the vehicle, it is  
important that the first rotation  
service for new tires be performed  
when they have 8 000 to 13 000 km  
(5,000 to 8,000 miles). See Tire  
Rotation on page 952.  
Service Work on page 94.  
At your dealer, you can be certain  
that you will receive the highest  
level of service available.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-3  
.
Windshield washer fluid level  
check. See Washer Fluid on  
system whenever the oil is changed.  
See Engine Oil Life System on  
Maintenance II  
.
Perform all services described in  
page 921  
.
page 911  
.
Maintenance I.  
.
.
.
.
Tire inflation check. See Tire  
Pressure on page 946.  
When the Change Engine Oil Soon  
message displays, certain services,  
checks, and inspections are  
required. The services described for  
Maintenance I should be performed  
at every engine oil change. The  
services described for Maintenance  
II should be performed when:  
.
.
Steering and suspension  
inspection. Visual inspection for  
damaged, loose, or missing  
parts or signs of wear.  
Tire wear inspection. See Tire  
Inspection on page 952.  
Rotate tires. See Tire Rotation  
Engine cooling system  
inspection. Visual inspection of  
hoses, pipes, fittings, and  
clamps and replacement,  
if needed.  
on page 952  
.
Fluids visual leak check (or  
every 12 months, whichever  
occurs first). A leak in any  
system must be repaired and the  
fluid level checked.  
.
Maintenance I was performed  
the last time the engine oil was  
changed.  
.
Windshield wiper blade  
inspection for wear, cracking,  
or contamination and windshield  
and wiper blade cleaning,  
if contaminated. See Exterior  
Care on page 975. Worn or  
damaged wiper blade  
.
It has been 10 months or more  
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter  
since the Change Engine Oil  
Soon message has displayed or  
since the last service.  
inspection (vehicles driven in  
dusty conditions only). See  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on  
page 913  
.
Maintenance I  
replacement. See Wiper Blade  
Replacement on page 926.  
.
Brake system inspection (or  
every 12 months, whichever  
occurs first).  
Change engine oil and filter. See  
Engine Oil on page 910. An  
Emission Control Service.  
.
Engine coolant level check. See  
Engine Coolant on page 915.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-4  
Service and Maintenance  
.
.
Body hinges and latches, key  
lock cylinders, folding seat  
hardware, and sunroof (if  
equipped) lubrication. See  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 107. More  
frequent lubrication may be  
required when vehicle is  
exposed to a corrosive  
environment. Applying silicone  
grease on weatherstrips with a  
clean cloth makes them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick  
or squeak.  
Passenger compartment air  
filter replacement (or every  
12 months, whichever comes  
first). More frequent replacement  
may be required if vehicle is  
driven regularly under dusty  
conditions.  
Once a Year  
.
See Starter Switch Check on  
page 925  
.
.
See Automatic Transmission  
Shift Lock Control System  
Check on page 925.  
.
.
See Ignition Transmission Lock  
Check on page 925.  
Additional Required Services  
At Each Fuel Stop  
See Park Brake and P (Park)  
.
Engine oil level check. See  
Engine Oil on page 910.  
Mechanism Check on  
page 926  
.
.
Engine coolant level check. See  
Engine Coolant on page 915.  
.
Engine cooling system and  
pressure cap pressure check.  
Radiator and air conditioning  
condenser outside cleaning. See  
Cooling System on page 914.  
.
.
Restraint system component  
check. See Safety System  
Check on page 221.  
.
Windshield washer fluid level  
check. See Washer Fluid on  
page 921  
.
Automatic transmission fluid  
level check and adding fluid,  
if needed. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on  
.
.
Exhaust system and nearby heat  
shields inspection for loose or  
damaged components.  
Once a Month  
.
Tire inflation check. See Tire  
Pressure on page 946.  
page 912  
.
Accelerator pedal check for  
damage, high effort, or binding.  
Replace if needed.  
.
Tire wear inspection. See Tire  
Inspection on page 952.  
.
Engine air cleaner filter  
inspection. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 913.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-5  
.
Transfer case fluid change  
(severe service) for vehicles  
mainly driven in hilly or  
mountainous terrain, when  
frequently towing a trailer,  
or used for taxi, police,  
or delivery service.  
First Engine Oil Change After  
Every 40 000 km/25,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After  
Every 240 000 km/150,000 Miles  
.
.
Fuel system inspection for  
Engine cooling system drain,  
damage or leaks.  
flush, and refill, cooling system  
and cap pressure check, and  
cleaning of outside of radiator  
and air conditioning condenser  
(or every 5 years, whichever  
occurs first). See Cooling  
First Engine Oil Change After  
Every 80 000 km/50,000 Miles  
.
First Engine Oil Change After  
Every 160 000 km/100,000 Miles  
Engine air cleaner filter  
replacement. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 913.  
System on page 914. An  
Emission Control Service.  
.
Automatic transmission fluid  
change (normal service). See  
Automatic Transmission Fluid on  
.
Automatic transmission fluid  
.
change (severe service) for  
vehicles mainly driven in heavy  
city traffic in hot weather, in hilly  
or mountainous terrain, when  
frequently towing a trailer,  
or used for taxi, police,  
Engine accessory drive belt  
page 912  
.
inspection for fraying, excessive  
cracks, or obvious damage and  
replacement, if needed. An  
Emission Control Service.  
.
.
Transfer case fluid change  
(normal service).  
Spark plug replacement. An  
Emission Control Service.  
or delivery service. See  
Automatic Transmission  
Fluid on page 912.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-6  
Service and Maintenance  
Maintenance  
Service  
Maintenance I  
II  
Change engine oil and filter. Reset oil life system.  
Engine coolant level check.  
Windshield washer fluid level check.  
Tire inflation pressures check.  
Tire wear inspection.  
Rotate tires.  
Fluids visual leak check.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles driven in dusty conditions only).  
Brake system inspection.  
Steering and suspension inspection.  
Engine cooling system inspection.  
Windshield wiper blades inspection.  
Body components lubrication.  
Restraint system components check.  
Automatic transmission fluid level check.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles not driven in dusty conditions).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-7  
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Engine oil which meets GM Standard GM6094M and displays the  
American Petroleum Institute Certified for Gasoline Engines starburst  
symbol. To determine the proper viscosity for the vehicle's engine, see  
Engine Oil on page 910.  
Engine Oil  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL® Coolant.  
See Engine Coolant on page 915.  
Engine Coolant  
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid (GM Part No. U.S. 12377967, in  
Canada 89021320).  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
Hydraulic Brake System  
Windshield Washer  
Hydraulic Power Steering System  
(V6 engines only)  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
Automatic Transmission  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-8  
Service and Maintenance  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Transfer Case (All-Wheel Drive)  
Transfer Case Fluid (GM Part No. U.S. 88861950, in Canada 88861951).  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Key Lock Cylinders  
Hood Latch Assembly, Secondary  
Latch, Pivots, Spring Anchor, and  
Release Pawl  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol (GM Part No. U.S. 12346293, in  
Canada 992723) or lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI #2, Category  
LB or GC-LB.  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Hood, Door, and Folding Seat Hinges  
Power Liftgate Actuator Ball Joint  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 89021668, in  
Canada 89021674).  
Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM Part No. U.S. 3634770, in Canada 10953518)  
or Dielectric Silicone Grease (GM Part No. U.S. 12345579, in  
Canada 992887).  
Weatherstrip Conditioning  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-9  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your retailer.  
Part  
GM Part Number  
ACDelco Part Number  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
Engine Oil Filter  
25899727  
A3138C  
2.4L L4 Engine  
12605566  
89017524  
19130294  
PF457G  
PF48  
3.0L V6 Engine  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter Element  
Spark Plugs  
CF177  
2.4L L4 Engine  
12620540  
12622561  
41-108  
41-109  
3.0L V6 Engine  
Wiper Blades  
Driver Side 60 cm (23.6 in)  
Passenger Side 42.5 cm (16.7 in)  
Rear 32.5 cm (12.8 in)  
20794123  
20794124  
25788783  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-10  
Service and Maintenance  
Maintenance Records  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service and Maintenance  
10-11  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10-12  
Service and Maintenance  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Services Performed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Data  
11-1  
Engine Identification  
Vehicle Identification  
Technical Data  
The eighth character in the VIN is  
the engine code. This code  
identifies the vehicle's engine,  
specifications, and replacement  
parts. See Engine Specifications”  
under Capacities and Specifications  
on page 112 for the vehicle's  
engine code.  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN)  
Vehicle Identification  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
Service Parts Identification  
Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
Vehicle Data  
Capacities and  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2  
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . 11-4  
Service Parts  
Identification Label  
This label, on the inside of the glove  
box, has the following information:  
This legal identifier is in the front  
corner of the instrument panel, on  
the left side of the vehicle. It can be  
seen through the windshield from  
outside. The VIN also appears on  
the Vehicle Certification and Service  
Parts labels and certificates of title  
and registration.  
.
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN)  
.
Model designation  
.
Paint information  
.
Production options and special  
equipment  
Do not remove this label from the  
vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11-2  
Technical Data  
Vehicle Data  
Capacities and Specifications  
Application  
Capacities  
Metric  
English  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant caution label located  
under the hood. See your dealer for more  
information.  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a  
Engine Cooling System  
2.4L L4 Engine  
3.0L V6 Engine  
Engine Oil with Filter  
2.4L L4 Engine  
3.0L V6 Engine  
Fuel Tank  
7.8 L  
8.2 qt  
10.2 L  
10.8 qt  
4.7 L  
5.7 L  
5.0 qt  
6.0 qt  
2.4L L4 Engine  
3.0L V6 Engine  
71.1 L  
79.1 L  
18.8 gal  
20.9 gal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Data  
11-3  
Capacities  
English  
Application  
Metric  
Transmission Fluid (Drain and Refill)  
2.4L L4 6Speed Automatic*  
3.0L V6 6Speed Automatic*  
Wheel Nut Torque  
8.5 L  
9.0 L  
9.0 qt  
9.5 qt  
170 Y  
125 ft lb  
*See Automatic Transmission Fluid on page 912 for information on checking fluid level.  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this  
manual. Recheck fluid level after filling.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Automatic  
Spark Plug Gap  
0.9 mm (0.035 in)  
1.1 mm (0.043 in)  
2.4L L4  
3.0L V6  
W
Y
Automatic  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11-4  
Technical Data  
Engine Drive Belt Routing  
3.0L V6 Engine  
2.4L L4 Engine  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-1  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects to  
the United States  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13  
Reporting Safety Defects to  
the Canadian  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14  
Reporting Safety Defects to  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14  
Customer Information  
Customer  
Information  
Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are  
important to your dealer and to  
Chevrolet. Normally, any concerns  
with the sales transaction or the  
operation of the vehicle will be  
resolved by the dealer's sales or  
service departments. Sometimes,  
however, despite the best intentions  
of all concerned, misunderstandings  
can occur. If your concern has not  
been resolved to your satisfaction,  
the following steps should be taken:  
Customer Information  
Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
Customer Assistance  
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3  
Customer Assistance for Text  
Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . 12-4  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . 12-4  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5  
Roadside Assistance  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6  
Scheduling Service  
Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8  
Courtesy Transportation  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . 12-15  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-16  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . 12-16  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . 12-16  
Radio Frequency  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-16  
STEP ONE: Discuss your concern  
with a member of dealership  
management. Normally, concerns  
can be quickly resolved at that level.  
If the matter has already been  
reviewed with the sales, service,  
or parts manager, contact the owner  
of the dealership or the general  
manager.  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8  
Collision Damage Repair . . . 12-10  
Service Publications  
Ordering Information . . . . . . 12-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-2  
Customer Information  
STEP TWO : If after contacting a  
member of dealership management,  
it appears your concern cannot be  
resolved by the dealership without  
further help, in the U.S., call the  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance  
Center at 1-800-222-1020. In  
Canada, call General Motors of  
Canada Customer Communication  
Centre at 1-800-263-3777 (English),  
or 1-800-263-7854 (French).  
When contacting Chevrolet,  
remember that your concern will  
likely be resolved at a dealer's  
facility. That is why we suggest  
following Step One first.  
case will generally be heard within  
40 days. If you do not agree with the  
decision given in your case, you  
may reject it and proceed with any  
other venue for relief available  
to you.  
STEP THREE U.S. Owners:  
Both General Motors and your  
dealer are committed to making  
sure you are completely satisfied  
with your new vehicle. However,  
if you continue to remain unsatisfied  
after following the procedure  
outlined in Steps One and Two, you  
can file with the Better Business  
Bureau (BBB) Auto Line® Program  
to enforce your rights.  
You may contact the BBB Auto Line  
Program using the toll-free  
telephone number or write them at  
the following address:  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business  
Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
We encourage you to call the  
toll-free number in order to give your  
inquiry prompt attention. Have the  
following information available to  
give the Customer Assistance  
Representative:  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an  
out of court program administered  
by the Council of Better Business  
Bureaus to settle automotive  
disputes regarding vehicle repairs or  
the interpretation of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. Although you may  
be required to resort to this informal  
dispute resolution program prior to  
filing a court action, use of the  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
www.dr.bbb.org/goauto  
.
Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN). This is available from the  
vehicle registration or title, or the  
plate at the top left of the  
instrument panel and visible  
through the windshield.  
This program is available in all  
50 states and the District of  
Columbia. Eligibility is limited by  
vehicle age, mileage, and other  
factors. General Motors reserves  
the right to change eligibility  
limitations and/or discontinue its  
participation in this program.  
.
Dealership name and location.  
.
Vehicle delivery date and  
present mileage.  
program is free of charge and your  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-3  
STEP THREE Canadian  
For further information concerning  
eligibility in the Canadian Motor  
Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP),  
call toll-free 1-800-207-0685, or call  
the General Motors Customer  
Communication Centre,  
1-800-263-3777 (English),  
1-800-263-7854 (French),  
or write to:  
Customer Assistance  
Offices  
Chevrolet encourages customers to  
call the toll-free number for  
assistance. However, if a customer  
wishes to write or e-mail Chevrolet,  
the letter should be addressed to:  
Owners: In the event that you do  
not feel your concerns have been  
addressed after following the  
procedure outlined in Steps 1 and 2,  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
wants you to be aware of its  
participation in a no-charge  
Mediation/Arbitration Program.  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
has committed to binding arbitration  
of owner disputes involving  
United States Customer  
Assistance  
The Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication  
Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer  
Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
www.Chevrolet.com  
factory-related vehicle service  
claims. The program provides for  
the review of the facts involved by  
an impartial third party arbiter, and  
may include an informal hearing  
before the arbiter. The program is  
designed so that the entire dispute  
settlement process, from the time  
you file your complaint to the final  
decision, should be completed in  
about 70 days. We believe our  
impartial program offers advantages  
over courts in most jurisdictions  
because it is informal, quick, and  
free of charge.  
Your inquiry should be accompanied  
by the Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN).  
1-800-222-1020  
1-800-833-2438 (For Text  
Telephone devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance:  
1-800-243-8872  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-4  
Customer Information  
From Puerto Rico:  
Chevrolet by dialing:  
1-800-833-2438. (TTY users in  
Canada can dial 1-800-263-3830.)  
Mexico, Central America and  
Caribbean Islands/Countries  
(Except Puerto Rico and U.S.  
Virgin Islands) Customer  
Assistance  
1-800-496-9992 (English)  
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)  
From U.S. Virgin Islands:  
1-800-496-9994  
Online Owner Center  
Online Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.gmownercenter.com/  
chevrolet  
General Motors de Mexico,  
S. de R.L. de C.V.  
Customer Assistance Center  
Av. Ejercito Nacional # 843  
Col. Granada  
Canada Customer  
Assistance  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre,  
CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
www.gm.ca  
Information and services  
customized for your specific  
vehicle all in one convenient  
place.  
C.P. 11520, Mexico, D.F.  
01-800-466-0800  
Long Distance: 011-52-53 29 0800  
.
Digital owner manual, warranty  
information, and more  
Customer Assistance for  
Text Telephone (TTY)  
Users  
To assist customers who are deaf,  
hard of hearing, or speech-impaired  
and who use Text Telephones  
(TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY  
1-800-263-3777 (English)  
1-800-263-7854 (French)  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text  
Telephone devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance:  
1-800-268-6800  
.
Online service and maintenance  
records  
.
Find Chevrolet dealers for  
service nationwide  
.
Exclusive privileges and offers  
.
Overseas Customer  
Recall notices for your specific  
Assistance  
equipment available at its Customer  
Assistance Center. Any TTY user in  
the U.S. can communicate with  
vehicle  
OnStar® and GM Cardmember  
Services Earnings summaries  
.
Please contact the local General  
Motors Business Unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
GM Mobility  
12-5  
Other Helpful Links:  
Here are a few of the valuable tools  
and services you will have  
access to:  
Chevrolet www.chevrolet.com  
Reimbursement Program  
Chevrolet Merchandise —  
www.chevymall.com  
.
My Showroom: Find and save  
information on vehicles and  
current offers in your area.  
Help Center www.chevrolet.com/  
pages/mds/helpcenter/faq.do  
.
My Dealers: Save details such  
.
FAQ  
as address and phone number  
for each of your preferred GM  
dealers.  
.
Contact Us  
This program, available to qualified  
applicants for cost reimbursement of  
eligible aftermarket adaptive  
equipment required for your vehicle,  
such as hand controls or a  
wheelchair/scooter lift for the  
vehicle.  
My GM Canada (Canada) —  
www.gm.ca  
.
My Driveway: Access quick links  
to parts and service estimates,  
check trade-in values,  
or schedule a service  
appointment by adding the  
vehicles you own to your  
driveway profile.  
My GM Canada is a  
password-protected section of  
www.gm.ca where you can save  
information on GM vehicles, get  
personalized offers, and use handy  
tools and forms with greater ease.  
For more information on the limited  
offer visit www.gmmobility.com or  
call the GM Mobility Assistance  
Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text  
telephone (TTY) users, call  
1-800-833-9935.  
.
My Preferences: Manage your  
profile and use tools and forms  
with greater ease.  
To sign up, visit the My GM Canada  
section within www.gm.ca.  
General Motors of Canada also  
has a Mobility Program. Call  
1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) for  
details. TTY users call  
1-800-263-3830.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-6  
Customer Information  
.
.
Odometer reading, Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN), and  
delivery date of the vehicle  
claims are made too often, or the  
same type of claim is made many  
times.  
Roadside Assistance  
Program  
For U.S. purchased vehicles, call  
18002438872; (Text telephone  
(TTY): 18888892438).  
Description of the problem  
Services Provided  
Coverage  
.
Emergency Fuel Delivery:  
Delivery of enough fuel for the  
vehicle to get to the nearest  
service station.  
Services are provided up to 5 years/  
100,000 miles (160 000 km),  
whichever comes first.  
For Canadian purchased vehicles,  
call 1-800-268-6800.  
Service is available 24 hours a day,  
365 days a year.  
.
LockOut Service: Service is  
In the U.S., anyone driving the  
vehicle is covered. In Canada, a  
person driving the vehicle without  
permission from the owner is not  
covered.  
provided to unlock the vehicle if  
you are locked out. A remote  
unlock may be available if you  
have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must present  
identification before this service  
is given.  
Calling for Assistance  
When calling Roadside Assistance,  
have the following information  
ready:  
Roadside Assistance is not a part of  
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.  
Chevrolet and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to  
make any changes or discontinue  
the Roadside Assistance program at  
any time without notification.  
.
Your name, home address, and  
home telephone number  
.
Emergency Tow From a Public  
.
Telephone number of your  
Road or Highway: Tow to the  
nearest Chevrolet dealer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle  
was in a crash and cannot be  
driven. Assistance is also given  
when the vehicle is stuck in the  
sand, mud, or snow.  
location  
.
Location of the vehicle  
.
Chevrolet and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to  
limit services or payment to an  
owner or driver if they decide the  
Model, year, color, and license  
plate number of the vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-7  
.
Flat Tire Change: Service is  
provided to change a flat tire  
with the spare tire. The spare  
tire, if equipped, must be in good  
condition and properly inflated.  
It is the owner's responsibility for  
the repair or replacement of the  
tire if it is not covered by the  
warranty.  
Canada Limited requires  
pre-authorization, original  
detailed receipts, and a copy of  
the repair orders. Once  
authorization has been received,  
the Roadside Assistance advisor  
will help you make arrangements  
and explain how to receive  
payment.  
Services Specific to Canadian  
Purchased Vehicles  
.
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement  
is approximately $5 Canadian.  
Diesel fuel delivery may be  
restricted. Propane and other  
fuels are not provided through  
this service.  
.
.
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle  
Battery Jump Start: Service is  
provided to jump start a dead  
battery.  
.
Alternative Service: If  
assistance cannot be provided  
right away, the Roadside  
registration is required.  
.
Trip Routing Service: Detailed  
Assistance advisor may give you  
permission to get local  
emergency road service. You will  
receive payment, up to $100,  
after sending the original receipt  
to Roadside Assistance.  
Mechanical failures may be  
covered, however any cost for  
parts and labor for repairs not  
covered by the warranty are the  
owner responsibility.  
maps of North America are  
provided when requested either  
with the most direct route or the  
most scenic route. There is a  
limit of six requests per year.  
Additional travel information is  
also available. Allow three  
weeks for delivery.  
Services Not Included in  
Roadside Assistance  
.
Impound towing caused by  
violation of any laws.  
.
Legal fines.  
.
Mounting, dismounting or  
changing of snow tires, chains,  
or other traction devices.  
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and  
Assistance: Must be over  
250 kilometres from where  
your trip was started to  
.
Towing or services for vehicles  
driven on a non-public road or  
highway.  
qualify. General Motors of  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-8  
Customer Information  
Transportation Options  
Scheduling Service  
Appointments  
When your vehicle requires  
warranty service, contact your  
dealer and request an appointment.  
By scheduling a service  
appointment and advising your  
service consultant of your  
transportation needs, your dealer  
can help minimize your  
Courtesy Transportation  
Program  
Warranty service can generally be  
completed while you wait. However,  
if you are unable to wait, GM helps  
to minimize your inconvenience by  
providing several transportation  
options. Depending on the  
To enhance your ownership  
experience, we and our participating  
dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer support  
program for vehicles with the New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty (Base  
Warranty Coverage period in  
Canada) and extended powertrain,  
and hybrid specific warranty in both  
the U.S. and Canada.  
circumstances, your dealer can offer  
you one of the following:  
Shuttle Service  
inconvenience.  
Shuttle service is the preferred  
means of offering Courtesy  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled  
into the service department  
Several courtesy transportation  
options are available to assist in  
reducing your inconvenience when  
warranty repairs are required.  
Transportation. Dealers may provide  
you with shuttle service to get you  
to your destination with minimal  
interruption of your daily schedule.  
This includes oneway or round trip  
shuttle service within reasonable  
time and distance parameters of the  
dealer's area.  
immediately, keep driving it until it  
can be scheduled for service,  
unless, of course, the problem is  
safety-related. If it is, please call  
your dealership/retailer, let them  
know this, and ask for instructions.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a  
part of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. A separate booklet  
entitled Warranty and Owner  
Assistance Informationfurnished  
with each new vehicle provides  
detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
If the dealer requests you to bring  
the vehicle for service, you are  
urged to do so as early in the work  
day as possible to allow for the  
same day repair.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-9  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Additional Program  
Information  
Your dealer may arrange to provide  
you with a courtesy rental vehicle or  
reimburse you for a rental vehicle  
that you obtain if your vehicle is  
kept for an overnight warranty  
repair. Rental reimbursement will be  
limited and must be supported by  
original receipts. This requires that  
you sign and complete a rental  
agreement and meet state/  
provincial, local, and rental vehicle  
provider requirements.  
Requirements vary and may include  
minimum age requirements,  
insurance coverage, credit card, etc.  
You are responsible for fuel usage  
charges and may also be  
responsible for taxes, levies, usage  
fees, excessive mileage, or rental  
usage beyond the completion of the  
repair.  
If your vehicle requires overnight  
warranty repairs, and public  
All program options, such as shuttle  
service, may not be available at  
every dealer. Please contact  
your dealer for specific information  
about availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be  
administered by appropriate dealer  
personnel.  
transportation is used instead of the  
dealer's shuttle service, the expense  
must be supported by original  
receipts and can only be up to the  
maximum amount allowed by GM  
for shuttle service. In addition, for  
U.S. customers, should you arrange  
transportation through a friend or  
relative, limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be  
available. Claim amounts should  
reflect actual costs and be  
supported by original receipts. See  
your dealer for information regarding  
the allowance amounts for  
reimbursement of fuel or other  
transportation costs.  
General Motors reserves the right to  
unilaterally modify, change or  
discontinue Courtesy Transportation  
at any time and to resolve all  
questions of claim eligibility  
pursuant to the terms and  
conditions described herein at its  
sole discretion.  
It may not be possible to provide a  
like-vehicle as a courtesy rental.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-10  
Customer Information  
Recycled original equipment parts  
may also be used for repair. These  
parts are typically removed from  
vehicles that were total losses in  
prior crashes. In most cases, the  
parts being recycled are from  
undamaged sections of the vehicle.  
A recycled original equipment GM  
part, may be an acceptable choice  
to maintain your vehicle's originally  
designed appearance and safety  
performance, however, the history of  
these parts is not known. Such parts  
are not covered by your GM New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any  
related failures are not covered by  
that warranty.  
parts are not covered by your GM  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and  
any vehicle failure related to such  
parts are not covered by that  
warranty.  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a  
collision and it is damaged, have the  
damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper  
equipment and quality replacement  
parts. Poorly performed collision  
repairs diminish your vehicle's  
resale value, and safety  
Repair Facility  
GM also recommends that you  
choose a collision repair facility that  
meets your needs before you ever  
need collision repairs. Your dealer  
may have a collision repair center  
with GM-trained technicians and  
state of the art equipment, or be  
able to recommend a collision repair  
center that has GM-trained  
performance can be compromised  
in subsequent collisions.  
Collision Parts  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new  
parts made with the same materials  
and construction methods as the  
parts with which your vehicle was  
originally built. Genuine GM  
technicians and comparable  
equipment.  
Aftermarket collision parts are also  
available. These are made by  
companies other than GM and  
may not have been tested for your  
vehicle. As a result, these parts  
may fit poorly, exhibit premature  
durability/corrosion problems,  
and may not perform properly in  
subsequent collisions. Aftermarket  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Collision parts are your best choice  
to ensure that your vehicle's  
Protect your investment in your GM  
vehicle with comprehensive and  
collision insurance coverage. There  
are significant differences in the  
quality of coverage afforded by  
various insurance policy terms.  
designed appearance, durability,  
and safety are preserved. The use  
of Genuine GM parts can help  
maintain your GM New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-11  
.
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN)  
Many insurance policies provide  
reduced protection to your GM  
vehicle by limiting compensation for  
damage repairs by using  
aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not  
specify aftermarket collision parts.  
When purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you assure your  
vehicle will be repaired with GM  
original equipment collision parts.  
If such insurance coverage is not  
available from your current  
If a Crash Occurs  
If there has been an injury, call  
emergency services for help. Do not  
leave the scene of a crash until all  
matters have been taken care of.  
Move the vehicle only if its position  
puts you in danger, or you are  
instructed to move it by a police  
officer.  
.
Insurance company and policy  
number  
.
General description of the  
damage to the other vehicle  
Choose a reputable repair facility  
that uses quality replacement parts.  
See Collision Partsearlier in this  
section.  
Give only the necessary information  
to police and other parties involved  
in the crash.  
If the airbag has inflated, see What  
Will You See After an Airbag  
Inflates? on page 228.  
insurance carrier, consider switching  
to another insurance carrier.  
For emergency towing see  
Roadside Assistance Program on  
Managing the Vehicle Damage  
Repair Process  
page 126  
.
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing  
company may require you to have  
insurance that assures repairs with  
Genuine GM Original Equipment  
Manufacturer (OEM) parts or  
Genuine Manufacturer replacement  
parts. Read your lease carefully, as  
you may be charged at the end of  
your lease for poor quality repairs.  
Gather the following information:  
In the event that your vehicle  
requires damage repairs, GM  
recommends that you take an active  
role in its repair. If you have a  
pre-determined repair facility of  
choice, take your vehicle there,  
or have it towed there. Specify to  
the facility that any required  
.
Driver's name, address, phone  
number  
.
.
Driver's license number  
Owner's name, address, phone  
number  
.
.
Vehicle license plate  
replacement collision parts be  
original equipment parts, either new  
Vehicle make, model and  
model year  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-12  
Customer Information  
Genuine GM parts or recycled  
original GM parts. Remember,  
recycled parts will not be covered by  
your GM vehicle warranty.  
In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio,  
Owner Manual, and Warranty  
Booklet.  
Service Publications  
Ordering Information  
Service Manuals  
RETAIL SELL PRICE:  
Insurance pays the bill for the repair,  
but you must live with the repair.  
Depending on your policy limits,  
your insurance company may  
initially value the repair using  
aftermarket parts. Discuss this with  
your repair professional, and insist  
on Genuine GM parts. Remember if  
your vehicle is leased you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle  
$35.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Service Manuals have the diagnosis  
and repair information on engines,  
transmission, axle, suspension,  
brakes, electrical, steering,  
body, etc.  
Without Portfolio: Owner  
Manual only.  
RETAIL SELL PRICE:  
$25.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Service Bulletins  
Current and Past Model Order  
Forms  
Service Bulletins give additional  
technical service information  
needed to knowledgeably service  
General Motors cars and trucks.  
Each bulletin contains instructions  
to assist in the diagnosis and  
service of your vehicle.  
Technical Service Bulletins and  
Manuals are available for current  
and past model GM vehicles. To  
request an order form, specify year  
and model name of the vehicle.  
repaired with Genuine GM parts,  
even if your insurance coverage  
does not pay the full cost.  
If another party's insurance  
company is paying for the repairs,  
you are not obligated to accept a  
repair valuation based on that  
insurance company's collision policy  
repair limits, as you have no  
contractual limits with that company.  
In such cases, you can have control  
of the repair and parts choices as  
long as cost stays within reasonable  
limits.  
ORDER TOLL FREE:  
1-800-551-4123 Monday-Friday  
8:00 AM - 6:00 PM Eastern Time  
Owner Information  
Owner publications are written  
specifically for owners and intended  
to provide basic operational  
information about the vehicle.  
The owner manual includes the  
Maintenance Schedule for all  
models.  
For Credit Card Orders Only  
(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visit  
Helm, Inc. on the World Wide Web  
at: helminc.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-13  
Or you can write to:  
However, NHTSA cannot  
Reporting Safety  
Defects  
become involved in individual  
problems between you, your  
dealer, or General Motors.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to the United States  
Government  
If you believe that your vehicle  
has a defect which could cause  
a crash or could cause injury or  
death, you should immediately  
inform the National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying  
General Motors.  
Prices are subject to change without  
notice and without incurring  
obligation. Allow ample time for  
delivery.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call  
the Vehicle Safety Hotline  
toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY:  
1-800-424-9153); go to http://  
www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Note to Canadian Customers: All  
listed prices are quoted in U.S.  
funds. Canadian residents are to  
make checks payable in U.S. funds.  
Administrator, NHTSA  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other  
information about motor vehicle  
safety from http://  
If NHTSA receives similar  
www.safercar.gov.  
complaints, it may open an  
investigation, and if it finds that  
a safety defect exists in a group  
of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-14  
Customer Information  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to the Canadian  
Government  
If you live in Canada, and you  
believe that your vehicle has a  
safety defect, notify Transport  
Canada immediately, in addition to  
notifying General Motors of Canada  
Limited. Call them at  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to General Motors  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or  
Transport Canada) in a situation like  
this, please notify General Motors.  
Vehicle Data  
Recording and  
Privacy  
Your GM vehicle has a number of  
sophisticated computers that record  
information about the vehicles  
performance and how it is driven.  
For example, your vehicle uses  
computer modules to monitor and  
control engine and transmission  
performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment  
and deploy airbags in a crash and,  
if so equipped, to provide antilock  
braking to help the driver control the  
vehicle. These modules may store  
data to help your dealer technician  
service your vehicle. Some modules  
may also store data about how you  
operate the vehicle, such as rate of  
fuel consumption or average speed.  
These modules may also retain the  
owners personal preferences, such  
as radio pre-sets, seat positions,  
and temperature settings.  
Call 1-800-222-1020, or write:  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance  
Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
1-800-333-0510 or write to:  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777  
(English) or 1-800-263-7854  
(French), or write:  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre,  
CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Information  
12-15  
This data can help provide a better  
understanding of the circumstances  
in which crashes and injuries occur.  
GM will not access this data or  
share it with others except: with the  
consent of the vehicle owner or,  
if the vehicle is leased, with the  
consent of the lessee; in response  
to an official request of police or  
similar government office; as part of  
GM's defense of litigation through  
the discovery process; or, as  
Event Data Recorders  
This vehicle has an Event Data  
Recorder (EDR). The main purpose  
of an EDR is to record, in certain  
crash or near crash-like situations,  
such as an airbag deployment or  
hitting a road obstacle, data that will  
assist in understanding how a  
vehicle's systems performed. The  
EDR is designed to record data  
related to vehicle dynamics and  
safety systems for a short period of  
time, typically 30 seconds or less.  
The EDR in this vehicle is designed  
to record such data as:  
Important: EDR data is recorded  
by your vehicle only if a non-trivial  
crash situation occurs; no data is  
recorded by the EDR under normal  
driving conditions and no personal  
data (e.g., name, gender, age, and  
crash location) is recorded.  
However, other parties, such as law  
enforcement, could combine the  
EDR data with the type of  
required by law. Data that GM  
collects or receives may also be  
used for GM research needs or may  
be made available to others for  
research purposes, where a need is  
shown and the data is not tied to a  
specific vehicle or vehicle owner.  
personally identifying data routinely  
acquired during a crash  
investigation.  
.
How various systems in your  
To read data recorded by an EDR,  
special equipment is required, and  
access to the vehicle or the EDR is  
needed. In addition to the vehicle  
manufacturer, other parties, such as  
law enforcement, that have the  
special equipment, can read the  
information if they have access to  
the vehicle or the EDR.  
vehicle were operating  
.
Whether or not the driver and  
passenger safety belts were  
buckled/fastened  
.
How far, if at all, the driver was  
pressing the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal  
.
How fast the vehicle was  
traveling  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12-16  
Customer Information  
Radio Frequency  
OnStar®  
Radio Frequency  
Statement  
This vehicle has systems that  
operate on a radio frequency that  
comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC)  
Rules and with RSS-210/211 of  
Industry Canada.  
Identification (RFID)  
If your vehicle has OnStar and you  
subscribe to the OnStar services,  
please refer to the OnStar Terms  
and Conditions for information on  
data collection and use. See also  
OnStar® System on page 439 in  
this manual for more information.  
RFID technology is used in some  
vehicles for functions such as tire  
pressure monitoring and ignition  
system security, as well as in  
connection with conveniences such  
as key fobs for remote door locking/  
unlocking and starting, and  
in-vehicle transmitters for garage  
door openers. RFID technology in  
GM vehicles does not use or record  
personal information or link with any  
other GM system containing  
Operation is subject to the following  
two conditions:  
Navigation System  
If your vehicle has a navigation  
system, use of the system may  
result in the storage of destinations,  
addresses, telephone numbers, and  
other trip information. Refer to the  
navigation system operating manual  
for information on stored data and  
for deletion instructions.  
1. The device may not cause  
interference.  
2. The device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the  
device.  
personal information.  
Changes or modifications to any of  
these systems by other than an  
authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-1  
Airbag System (cont.)  
What Will You See After  
Antilock Brake  
A
System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20  
Appearance Care  
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-75  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-79  
Assistance Program,  
Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6  
Audio Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-19  
Audio System  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-18  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . 6-2  
Automatic Climate Control  
Accessories and  
an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . .2-28  
When Should an Airbag  
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . .2-25  
Airbags  
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29  
Add-On Electrical  
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-64  
Adding Equipment to the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . 2-35  
Adjustments  
Lumbar, Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . 9-13  
Air Filter, Passenger  
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Airbag System  
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-36  
How Does an Airbag  
Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28  
Passenger Sensing  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30  
What Makes an Airbag  
Adding Equipment to the  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35  
Passenger Status Indicator . . .4-15  
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-15  
Servicing Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34  
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22  
Alarm System  
Anti-Theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-12  
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . 8-38, 9-24  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Antenna  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . 8-35  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12  
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-37  
Shiftlock Control System  
Multi-Band . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-18  
Anti-Theft  
Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-12  
Alarm System Messages . . . . .4-32  
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25  
Auxiliary Devices . . . . . . . . 6-28, 6-31  
Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-2  
INDEX  
Bulb Replacement (cont.)  
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . .9-33  
Taillamps, Turn Signal,  
Sidemarker, Stoplamps,  
and Backup Lamps . . . . . . . . . .9-32  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-54  
Cargo  
B
Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Cautions, Danger, and  
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
CD  
DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-21  
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-58  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Check  
Engine Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16  
Ignition Transmission Lock . . .9-25  
Child Restraints  
Infants and Young  
Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39  
Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . .2-45  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37  
Securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51, 2-54  
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41  
Where to Put the Restraint . . .2-43  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-69  
Voltage and Charging  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Blade Replacement, Wiper . . . . 9-26  
Bluetooth . . . . 6-42, 6-43, 6-46, 6-58  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-38  
Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-22  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40  
System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . 8-28  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3, 9-31  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-30  
Headlamps, Front Turn  
C
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
California  
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . .8-54  
Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Camera, Rear Vision . . . . . . . . . . 8-49  
Canadian Vehicle Owners . . . . . . . . iv  
Capacities and  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2  
Carbon Monoxide  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-34  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21  
Signal, Sidemarker, and  
Parking Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-3  
Cleaning  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-44  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-24  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . 12-4  
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-3  
Text Telephone (TTY)  
Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-4  
Customer Information  
Service Publications  
Door  
Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-75  
Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-79  
Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . 7-1  
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9, 4-10  
Cluster, IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . 12-10  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . 9-68  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Compass Messages . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Coolant  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-15  
Engine Temperature  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14  
Engine Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29  
Courtesy Transportation  
Ajar Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29  
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Drive Systems  
All-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . .8-38, 9-24  
Driver Information  
Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Driving  
Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Characteristics and  
Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-58  
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . .8-20  
If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . .8-23  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . .8-24  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21  
Ordering Information . . . . . . 12-12  
Customer Satisfaction  
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . 12-10  
Danger, Warnings, and  
Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . 12-15  
Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
Devices, Auxiliary . . . . . . . 6-28, 6-31  
Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8  
Covers  
Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-4  
INDEX  
DVD  
Engine (cont.)  
Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31  
Coolant Temperature  
F
Rear Seat Entertainment  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-33  
DVD/CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Filter  
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . .9-13  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . 5-2  
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-59  
Flat Tire, Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61  
Fluid  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . .9-12  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-22  
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20  
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-21  
Fog Lamps  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . 5-3, 9-31  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Front Seats  
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-53  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-55  
Economy Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Economy Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
Filling a Portable Fuel  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-14  
Cooling System Messages . . .4-29  
Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4  
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-34  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-18  
Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
Running While Parked . . . . . . . .8-34  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-30  
Engine Oil  
Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Equipment, Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-63  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . 12-15  
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
E
ECO Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37  
Economy Mode  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-37  
Electrical Equipment,  
Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-64  
Electrical System  
Engine Compartment Fuse  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-34  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-34  
Instrument Panel Fuse  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-37  
Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-13  
Check and Service Engine  
Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16  
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . 9-6  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-15  
Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-57  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-56  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . .8-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-5  
Fuel (cont.)  
General Information  
Heater  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . .8-54  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . .4-22  
Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-54  
Requirements, California . . . . .8-54  
System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Fuel Economy Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Engine Compartment Fuse  
Service and Maintenance . . . . .10-1  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-57  
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31  
High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . 8-20  
Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . 8-41  
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
How to Wear Safety Belts  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5  
H
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . 5-2  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Headlamps  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-34  
Instrument Panel Fuse  
Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-37  
I
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .9-30  
Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Headlamps, Front Turn  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28  
Ignition Transmission Lock  
G
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Infants and Young Children,  
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Instrument Panel  
Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . 4-4  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iii, 6-1  
Gasoline  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-54  
Gauges  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13  
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13  
Warning Lights and  
Signal, Sidemarker, and  
Parking Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-30  
High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . 5-1  
Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Heated Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-6  
INDEX  
LATCH System  
Replacing Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51  
Latch, Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Liftgate  
Lights (cont.)  
J
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . 5-1  
Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . .4-14  
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-21  
Traction Control System  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-69  
K
Key and Lock Messages . . . . . . . 4-31  
Keyless Entry  
Carbon Monoxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Light  
(TCS)/StabiliTrak® . . . . . . . . . .4-21  
Traction Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20  
Locks  
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
StabiliTrak® OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20  
Lighting  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Lower Anchors and Tethers  
Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Lights  
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-15  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20  
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-24  
Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
High-Beam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
L
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . 9-40  
Lamps  
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . 5-2  
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Exterior Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-33  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . .4-16  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17  
for Children (LATCH  
SYSTEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-7  
Messages (cont.)  
M
N
Key and Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-31  
Object Detection System . . . . .4-31  
Ride Control System . . . . . . . . . .4-31  
Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32  
Service Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32  
Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33  
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-27  
Vehicle Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-34  
Mirrors  
Maintenance  
Navigation System  
Vehicle Data Recording  
Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10  
Maintenance Schedule  
Recommended Fluids and  
and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-16  
Net, Convenience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . 8-28  
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . .10-2  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . 4-16  
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37  
Mass Storage Media (MEM) . . . 6-25  
Messages  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32  
Anti-Theft Alarm System . . . . . .4-32  
Battery Voltage and  
Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28  
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29  
Engine Cooling System . . . . . . .4-29  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
O
Object Detection System  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Oil  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . 9-11  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22  
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . 2-37  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . 12-4  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Automatic Dimming  
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15  
Convex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14  
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14  
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15  
Park Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14  
Monitor System, Tire  
Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-47  
Multi-Band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-8  
INDEX  
Operation, Infotainment  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Outlets  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10  
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18  
Overview  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Overview, Infotainment  
Passenger Sensing System . . . 2-30  
Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements, California . . . . . . 9-3  
Phone  
R
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . 12-16  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-16  
Radios  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
CD/DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-21  
Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-18  
Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-14  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Rear Seat Entertainment  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . 8-49  
Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . 4-8  
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . .1-15  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Recommended Fluids and  
Bluetooth . . . . . . .  
6-42, 6-43,  
6-46, 6-58  
Power  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14  
Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10  
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . .8-29  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16  
Pregnancy, Using Safety  
Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Privacy  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . 12-16  
Program  
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . .12-8  
Proposition 65 Warning,  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3, 6-5  
P
Park  
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-32  
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-33  
Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Parking  
Assist, Ultrasonic . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-46  
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40  
Brake and P (Park)  
Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . . .9-26  
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . .8-33  
Passenger Airbag Status  
Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Passenger Compartment Air  
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7  
Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . 8-54  
Records  
California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-9  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . 9-72  
Reimbursement Program,  
Ride Control Systems  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-31  
Roadside Assistance  
Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6  
Roof  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-52  
Routing, Engine Drive Belt . . . . . 11-4  
Running the Vehicle While  
Safety Defects Reporting  
Canadian Government . . . . . . 12-14  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13  
Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . 2-21  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . 10-2  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . 12-8  
Seats  
Adjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Heated Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Lumbar Adjustment, Front . . . . . 2-5  
Power Adjustment, Front . . . . . . 2-3  
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Securing Child  
GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Replacement Parts  
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-36  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9  
Replacing Airbag System . . . . . . 2-36  
Replacing LATCH System  
Parts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Replacing Safety Belt  
System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Canadian Government . . . . . . 12-14  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-14  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13  
Retained Accessory  
Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-34  
S
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22  
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21  
How to Wear Safety Belts  
Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32  
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14  
Replacing After a Crash . . . . . .2-22  
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . .2-21  
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51, 2-54  
Security  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-12  
Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-10  
INDEX  
Service  
Accessories and  
Sidemarker  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .9-32  
Signals, Turn and  
Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Spare Tire  
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-68  
Specifications and  
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
StabiliTrak System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-43  
StabiliTrak® OFF Light . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Start Assist, Hills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-41  
Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-30  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Fluid, Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20  
Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Stoplamps and Back-Up Lamps  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .9-32  
Storage  
Mass Media (MEM) . . . . . . . . . . .6-25  
Storage Areas  
Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Center Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-23  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .v  
System  
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
Engine Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16  
Maintenance Records . . . . . . 10-10  
Maintenance, General  
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-1  
Parts Identification Label . . . . . 11-1  
Publications Ordering  
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-12  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . .12-8  
Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32  
Servicing the  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . 2-34  
Shifting  
Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-32  
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-33  
Roof Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
System Check  
Automatic Transmission  
Shiftlock Control . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
i-11  
Tires (cont.)  
Traction  
T
Pressure Monitor System . . . . .9-47  
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-52  
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-40  
Terminology and  
Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-43  
Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-56  
Wheel Alignment and Tire  
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . .9-57  
When It Is Time for New  
Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . .8-41  
Control System (TCS)/  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Taillamps  
StabiliTrak® Light . . . . . . . . . . . .4-21  
Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20  
Trailer  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .9-32  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . 12-4  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . 1-13  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13  
Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9, 4-10  
Tires  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-54  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-58  
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-61  
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-68  
Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-42  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-55  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . .9-59  
Inflation Monitor System . . . . . .9-49  
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-52  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-21  
Sway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . .8-64  
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-61  
Transmission  
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-35  
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33  
Transportation Program,  
Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8  
Turn and Lane-Change  
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Turn Signal  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-53  
Towing  
Driving Characteristics . . . . . . . .8-58  
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-63  
General Information . . . . . . . . . .8-57  
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . .9-72  
Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-61  
Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . .8-64  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-72  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .9-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i-12  
INDEX  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
Service Parts Identification  
Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
Vehicle Reminder  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Ventilation, Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Wheels  
Alignment and Tire  
U
Ultrasonic Parking Assist . . . . . . 8-46  
Uniform Tire Quality  
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-55  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57  
When It Is Time for New  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-53  
Where to Put the Child  
Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16  
Windshield  
Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . 9-26  
Wipers  
Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-56  
Using this Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
V
Vehicle  
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24  
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-27  
Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-34  
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-12  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-72  
Vehicle Care  
W
Warning Lights, Gauges,  
and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Cautions and Danger . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Rear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Binatone Automobile Accessories TTSE110 User Manual
BIXOLON Printer SRP 350 User Manual
Black Box Modem SME 4M User Manual
Blaupunkt Portable Radio Casablanca CD51 User Manual
BlueAnt Wireless Headphones SUPERTOOTH II User Manual
Bosch Appliances Power Supply VG4 A PSU0 User Manual
Bosch Appliances Range HES7052U User Manual
Califone Fish Finder 1216 USB User Manual
Carbine Universal Remote PLUS 6850 User Manual
Chicago Electric Washer 98332 User Manual